20.) Geography Part-1 (Vision-2021) - Unlocked

Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 243

VISION IAS

www.visionias.in

GEOGRAPHY
PART 1
S.N. TOPIC PAGE NO.

1. Universe and Solar System 1 -21


2. Interior of Earth 22-30

3. Continental Drift, Seafloor Spreading, Endogenic and Exogenic 31-47


Forces, Plate Tectonic, Supercontinent etc.

4. Earth Quake, Tsunami, Volcanic Activity, Landforms 48 62


-

5. Mountain Building, Island Formation, Hotspot 63-70


6. Rocks and Minerals 71 77
-

7. Landform and Evolution 78-108


8. India Physical Formation, Physiography, Drainage Structure, 109-149
Relief, Basics of Soils

9. Composition and Structure of atmosphere 150-157


10. Insolation, Earth's Heat Balance, Different Atmospheric 158 195-

Circulation, Global Winds, Cyclone

11. Precipitation and Related Phenomenon 196-211


12. Ocean Basics and Ocean Resources 212 234-

13. Coral Reefs and Indian Ocean 235-242


Copyright © by Vision IAS
All rights are reserved. No part of this document may be reproduced, stored in a retrieval system or
transmitted in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording or otherwise,
without prior permission of Vision IAS

www.visionias.in ©Vision IAS


Student Notes:

THE UNIVERSE AND SOLAR SYSTEM


Contents
1. The Universe .............................................................................................................................. 2
2. Origin of the Universe ................................................................................................................ 2
2.1. The Units of Measuring Distances in the Universe ............................................................. 3
3. Galaxy ......................................................................................................................................... 4
3.1. Our Own Galaxy: The Milky Way......................................................................................... 4
4. Stars............................................................................................................................................ 5
4.1. Birth and Evolution of a Star ............................................................................................... 5
4.1.1. Formation of a Protostar .............................................................................................. 5
4.1.2. Formation of a Star from Protostar .............................................................................. 6
4.1.3. Final Stages of a Star̛ s Life ........................................................................................... 6
4.1.4. Formation of Supernova Star and Neutron Star .......................................................... 7
5. Black Holes ................................................................................................................................. 7
6. The Solar System ........................................................................................................................ 8
6.1. Sun....................................................................................................................................... 8
6.2. Planets ................................................................................................................................. 9
6.3. Satellites (or Moons) ......................................................................................................... 11
6.4. Asteroids ........................................................................................................................... 12
6.5. Comets .............................................................................................................................. 13
6.6. Meteors ............................................................................................................................. 13
7. The Shape of the Earth ............................................................................................................. 13
7.1. Evidence of the Earth’s Sphericity ..................................................................................... 14
7.2. The Earth’s Movement ...................................................................................................... 15
7.2.1. Day and Night ............................................................................................................. 15
7.2.2. The Earth’s Revolution ............................................................................................... 15
om

7.2.3. Varying Lengths of Day and Night .............................................................................. 16


l.c
ai

7.2.4. The Altitude of the Midday Sun ................................................................................. 17


tm

7.2.5. Seasonal Changes and their Effects on Temperature ................................................. 17


ho
t@

7.2.6. Dawn and Twilight ...................................................................................................... 17


sp

7.2.7. Eclipse......................................................................................................................... 17
h.
es

8. The Geographical Grid- Latitude and Longitude ...................................................................... 18


ur

8.1. Latitude ............................................................................................................................. 18


ay
m

8.2. Longitude .......................................................................................................................... 19


8.3. Longitude and Time .......................................................................................................... 19
8.4. Standard Time and Time Zones ......................................................................................... 20
9. Geological Time Scale............................................................................................................... 20

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


1 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

1. The Universe
The vast space surrounding us is called universe. It is mostly empty space. The universe
includes everything that exists: the most distant stars, planets, satellites, as well as our own
earth and all the objects on it. Nobody knows how big the universe is or whether it has any
limits. However, it is estimated that the Universe contains 100 billion galaxies, each of which
comprises 100 billion stars. The sun which sustains all the life on our planet is only one of the
billions and billions of stars that exist in this universe, whereas the planet earth on which we
live is only a tiny speck in this vast space called universe. The earth is one of the eight planets,
all of which revolve around a central star called sun. The billions stars which exists in the
universe are not distributed uniformly in space. These stars occur in the form of clusters (or
groups) of billions of stars called galaxies. Thus, in order to study the constitution of this
universe we have to first discuss the objects like galaxies, stars, planets and satellites, etc.,
which are found in the universe.

2. Origin of the Universe


The most popular argument regarding the origin of the universe is the Big Bang Theory. It is
also called expanding universe hypothesis. Edwin Hubble, in 1920, provided evidence that the
universe is expanding. As time passes, galaxies move further and further apart. The distance
between the galaxies is found to be increasing and thereby, the universe is considered to be
expanding. Here, the expansion of universe means increase in space between the galaxies.
However, Scientists believe that though the space between the galaxies is increasing,
observations do not support the expansion of galaxies in itself.
An alternative to this was Hoyle’s concept of steady state. It considered the universe to be
roughly the same at any point of time. It did not have a beginning and did not have an end.
However, with greater evidence becoming available about the expanding universe, scientific
community at present favours argument of expanding universe.
om
l.c

Stages in Big Bang Theory


ai
tm

(i) In the beginning, all matter forming the universe existed in one place in the form of a “tiny ball”
ho

(singular atom) with an unimaginably small volume, infinite temperature and infinite
t@
sp

density.
h.
es

(ii) At the Big Bang the “tiny ball” exploded violently. This led to a huge expansion. It is now
ur
ay

generally accepted that the event of big bang took place 13.7 billion years before the present.
m

The expansion continues even to the present day. As it grew, some energy was converted into
matter. There was particularly rapid expansion within fractions of a second after the bang.
Thereafter, the expansion has slowed down. Within first three minutes from the Big Bang event,
the first atom began to form.
(iii) Within 300,000 years from the Big Bang, temperature dropped to 4,500 K and gave rise
to atomic matter. The universe became transparent.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


2 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Evidences in Support of Big Bang Theory

Evidence Interpretation

The light from other galaxies is The other galaxies are moving away from us.
red-shifted.

The further away the galaxy, the The most likely explanation is that the whole universe is expanding.
more its light is red-shifted. This supports the theory that the start of the universe could have
been from a single explosion.

Cosmic Microwave Background The relatively uniform background radiation is the remains of energy
created just after the Big Bang.

According to Nebular Hypothesis the planets were formed out of a cloud of material associated with a
youthful sun, which was slowly rotating. The theory was give by German Philosopher Immanuel Kant
om

(Though he did not use word Nebular) and later revised by Mathematician Laplace in 1796. You will
l.c

learn about Kant in Moral Thinkers (GS Paper IV).


ai
tm
ho

2.1. The Units of Measuring Distances in the Universe


t@
sp
h.


es

The extremely vast distances between the various heavenly bodies like the stars and
ur

planets can be well expressed in terms Astronomical Unit (A.U), Light year, and Parsec.
ay


m

Astronomical unit is defined as the mean distance from the earth to the sun. One AU is
equal to 1.5×108kilometres.
• Light year is the distance travelled by light in one year. It is equal to 9.46×10¹² kilometres.
• Parsec: It represents the distance at which the radius of Earth’s orbit subtends an angle of
one second of arc. One parsec equals about 3.26 light-years or 30.9 trillion kilometres.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


3 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

3. Galaxy
Galaxies are building blocks of the universe. Galaxy is a vast system of billions of stars, which
also contains a large number of gas clouds mainly of hydrogen gas (where stars are born), and
dust, isolated in space from similar system.
Classification of galaxies
Galaxies are usually classified on the basis of their shape and are of three types :
1) Spiral
2) Elliptical
3) Irregular
Some of the brightest galaxies are elliptical galaxies but spiral galaxies are usually much bigger
than others. We live on the outer edge of a spiral type of galaxy called milky way.

3.1. Our Own Galaxy: The Milky Way


• It is a spiral type of galaxy.
• It is about 100000 light years in diameter and has disk-shaped structure.
• The Milky Way galaxy is rotating slowly about its centre in the counter-clockwise
direction.
• All the stars (The sun too along with the solar system) rotate about the centre of the
Milky Way galaxy.
• The disc of stars is quite thick at the centre representing a relatively high concentration
of the stars at the centre of the galaxy.
• The sun is far away(~27000 LY) from the centre of the Milky Way galaxy.
• Since the Milky Way galaxy appears like a river of light in the night sky running from one
corner of the sky to the other, it is called A
̒ kash Ganga .̓
om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


4 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

4. Stars
Stars are the heavenly bodies like the sun that are extremely hot and have light of their own.
Stars are made up of vast clouds of hydrogen gas, some helium and dust. In all the stars
(including the sun), hydrogen atoms are continuously being converted into helium atoms and a
large amount of nuclear energy in the form of heat and light is released during this process. It is
this heat and light which makes a star shine. Thus, a star is a hydrogen nuclear energy furnace,
so big that it holds together by itself. The stars are classified according to their physical
characteristics like size, colour, brightness and temperature.
Stars are of three colours: red, white and blue. The colour of a star is determined by its surface
temperature. The stars which have comparatively low surface temperature are red, the star
having high surface temperature are white whereas those stars which have very high surface
temperature are blue on colour. Some of the important example of the stars are: Pole (or
Polaris), Sirius, Vega, Capella, Alpha centauri, Beta centauri, Proxima centauri, Spica, Regulus,
Pleiades, Aldebaram, Arcturus, Betelgeuse, and of course, the Sun.
All the stars (except the pole star) appear to move from east to west in the night sky. This can
be explained as follows: the earth itself rotates on its axis from west to east. So, when the earth
rotates on its axis from west to east, the stars appear to move in the opposite direction, from
east to west. Thus, the apparent motion of the stars in the sky is due to the rotation of the
earth on its axis. Since we are ourselves on the earth, the earth appears to be stationary to us
but the stars appear to be moving in the sky. Thus, it is due to the rotation of earth on its axis
that we see the stars changing their positions in the sky as the night progresses.

4.1. Birth and Evolution of a Star


The raw material for the formation of a star is mainly hydrogen gas and some helium gas. The
life cycle of a star begins with the gathering of hydrogen gas and helium gas present in the
galaxies to form dense clouds of these gases. The stars are then formed by the gravitational
om

collapse of these over-dense clouds of gases in the galaxy. Let us deal the various stages in the
l.c

formation of star-
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

4.1.1. Formation of a Protostar


In the beginning, the gases in the galaxies were mainly hydrogen with some helium. However,
they were at a very low temperature of about, -173°C. Since the gases were very cold, they
formed very dense clouds in the galaxies. In addition, the gas cloud was very large, so the
gravitational pull between the various gas molecules was quite large. Due to large gravitational
force, the gas cloud started contracting as a whole. Ultimately, the gas were compressed so
much that they formed a highly condensed object called a protostar. A protostar looks a like a

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


5 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

huge, dark, ball of gas. The formation of protostar is only a stage in the formation of complete
star. A protostar does not emit light. The next stage consists in the transformation of this highly
condensed object called protostar into a star which emits light.
4.1.2. Formation of a Star from Protostar
The protostar is a highly dense gaseous mass, which continues to contract further due to
tremendous gravitational force. As the protostar begins to contract further, the hydrogen
atoms present in gas cloud collide with one another more frequently. These collisions of
hydrogen atoms raise the temperature of protostar more and more. The process of
contraction of protostar continues for about a million years during which the inner
temperature in the protostar increases from a mere, -173°C in the beginning to about 107°C. At
this extremely high temperature, nuclear fusion reactions of hydrogen start taking place. In this
process, four small hydrogen nuclei fuse to produce a bigger helium nucleus and a tremendous
amount of energy is produced in the form of heat and light. The energy produced during the
fusion of hydrogen to form helium makes the protostar glow and it becomes a star. This star
shines steadily for a very, very long time.
4.1.3. Final Stages of a Star̛ s Life
In the first part of the final stage of its life, a star enters the red-giant phase where it becomes a
red-giant star. After that, depending on its mass, the red-giant star can die out by becoming a
white dwarf star, or by exploding as a supernova star, which ultimately ends in the formation
of neutron star and black holes.
(1) Red- Giant Phase. Initially, the stars contain mainly hydrogen. With the passage of time,
hydrogen gets converted into helium from the centre outwards. Now, when all the
hydrogen present in the core of the star gets converted into helium, then the fusion
reactions in the core would stop. Therefore, ultimately, the matter in the core of the
star would consist only of helium. Due to the stoppage of fusion reactions, the pressure
inside the core of the star would diminish, and the core would begin to shrink under its
om

own gravity. In the outer shell or envelope of the star, however, some hydrogen still
l.c
ai

remains, the fusion reactions would continue to liberate energy but with much reduced
tm
ho

intensity. Due to all these changes, the overall equilibrium in the star is upset and in
t@

order to readjust it, the star has to expand considerably in its exterior region(outer
sp

region). Thus the star becomes very big ( it becomes a giant), and its colour changes to
h.
es

red. At this stage, the star enters the red-giant phase and it is said to become a red-
ur
ay

giant star. Our own star, the sun, will ultimately turn into a red-giant star after about
m

5000 million year from now. The expanding outer shell of the sun will then become so
big that it will engulf the inner planets like mercury and Venus, and even the earth.
When a star reaches the red-giant phase, then its future depends on its initial mass.
Two cases arise:
(a) If the initial mass of the star is comparable to that of the sun, then the red-giant
star loses its expanding outer shell and its core shrinks to form a white dwarf star
which ultimately dies out as a dense lump of matter into the space.
(b) If the initial mass of the star is much more than of the sun, then the red-giant star
formed from its explodes in the form of a supernova star, and the core of this
exploding supernova star can shrink to form a neutron star or black hole.
(2) Formation of White Dwarf Star: If the mass of red-giant star is similar to that of the
sun, the red-giant star would lose its expanding outer shell or envelope because then
the comparatively smaller amount of hydrogen fuel present in it will be used up rapidly,
and only the core of the red-giant star will gradually shrink into an extremely dense ball
of matter due to gravitation. Because of this enormous shrinking of helium core, the

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


6 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

temperature of core would rise greatly and start another set of nuclear fusion reactions
in which helium is converted into heavier elements like carbon, and an extremely large
amount of energy will be released. When the mass of a star is similar to the mass of the
sun (which is comparatively a small mass), then all the helium is converted into carbon
in a short time and then further fusion reactions stop completely. Now, as the energy
being produced inside the star stops, the core of star contracts (shrinks) under its own
weight. And it becomes a white dwarf star.
A great Indian scientist Chandrasekhar made a detailed study of the stars which end their lives
by becoming white dwarf stars. Chandrasekhar concluded that the start having a mass less than
1.44 times the solar mass (or sun’s mass) would end up as white dwarf stars. The maximum
limit of 1.44 times the solar mass (for a star to end its life as a white dwarf) is known as
‘Chandrasekhar Limit’. If, however, a star has a mass more than 1.44 times the solar mass or
sun’s mass, then it will not die out by becoming a white dwarf star. This is because due to
greater mass, it will have more nuclear fuel in it, which will not get exhausted in a short time.
The stars having mass much more than solar mass (or sun’s mass) led to supernova explosions
and end their lives by becoming neutron stars or black holes. This point will become clearer
from the following discussion:
4.1.4. Formation of Supernova Star and Neutron Star
When a very big star is in the red-giant phase, then being big, its core contains much more
helium. This big core made up of helium continues to contract (shrink) under the action of
gravity producing higher and higher temperature. At this extremely high temperature, fusion of
helium into carbon takes place in the core and lot of energy is produced. Since the star was very
big and contained enormous nuclear fuel helium, so a tremendous amount of nuclear energy is
produced very rapidly which causes the outer shell (or envelope) of this red-giant star to
explode with a brilliant flash like a nuclear bomb. This type of ‘exploding star is called
supernova. The energy released in one second of a supernova explosion is equal to the energy
released by the sun in about 100 years. This tremendous energy would light up the sky for
om
l.c

many days. When a supernova explosion takes place, then clouds of gases in the envelope of
ai

red-giant star are liberated into the space and these gases act as raw material for the formation
tm
ho

of new stars. The heavy core left behind after the supernova explosion continues to contract
t@

and ultimately becomes a neutron star (if mass of star was 1.44 time to 3 times the Sun) or
sp
h.

Black Hole (if the mass of star was more than 3 times the sun).
es
ur

A neutron star contains matter in even denser form than found in white dwarf stars. Although a
ay
m

number of white dwarfs have been detected, but no one has yet observed a neutron star. This
may be because neutron stars are very faint. A spinning neutron star emits radio waves and is
called a pulsar.

5. Black Holes
A black hole is an object with such a strong gravitational field that even light cannot escape
from its surface. A black hole may be formed when a massive object (very big object)
undergoes uncontrolled contraction (a collapse) because of the inward pull of its own gravity.
We will now describe how the black holes are formed from neutron stars after the supernova
explosions of big stars. When a supernova explosion of a very massive star takes place, then
the gaseous matter present in the outer shell(or envelope) of the star is scattered into space
but the core of the star survives during supernova explosion. This heavy core of the supernova
star continues to contract (shrink) and becomes a neutron star. The fate of this neutron star
depends on its mass. If the neutron star is very heavy, then due to enormous gravitational
attraction, it would continue to contract indefinitely. And the vast amount of matter present in
a neutron star would be ultimately packed into a mere point object. Such an infinitely dense

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


7 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

object is called a black hole. Thus black holes are formed by the indefinite contraction of
heavy neutron stars under the action of their own gravity. The neutron stars shrink so much
and become so dense that the resulting black holes do not allow anything to escape, not even
light, from their surface. This is because the black holes have tremendous gravitational force.
Since even light cannot escape from blackholes, therefore, black holes are invisible, they
cannot be seen. The presence of a black hole can be felt only by the effect of its gravitational
field on its neighbouring objects in the sky. For example, if we see a star moving in a circle with
no other visible stars in the centre, then we can conclude that there is a black hole at the
centre. And it is the gravitational pull exerted by this black hole which is making the star goes in
a circle around it.

Dark matter1
Dark matter is a type of matter hypothesized in astronomy and cosmology to account for a large
part of the mass that appears to be missing from the universe. Dark matter cannot be seen
directly with telescopes; evidently it neither emits nor absorbs light or other electromagnetic
radiation at any significant level. Dark Matter is not exactly balck hole. The composition of the
constituents of cold dark matter is currently unknown. It could be group of black holes, dwarfs
or some new particle.

6. The Solar System


The solar system consists of the sun, the eight planets and their satellites, and thousands of
other smaller heavenly bodies such as asteroids, comets and meteors. The Solar System is at a
distance of about 27,000 light years from the centre of the Milky Way galaxy and is about 5
billion years old. The sun is at the centre of the solar system and all these bodies are revolving
around it. The gravitational pull of the sun keeps all the solar system and all the planets and
other objects revolving round it. Thus, the motion of all members of the solar system is
governed mainly by the gravitational force of the sun.
om
l.c

The solar system is dominated by the sun. The sun accounts for almost 99.9 percent of the
ai
tm

matter in the whole solar system. The sun is also the source of all the energy in the solar
ho

system.
t@
sp

6.1. Sun
h.
es
ur

The sun is the head of solar family or solar system. Compared with the millions of other stars,
ay

the sun is a medium sized star and of average brightness... Though sun is the nearest star to the
m

earth, even then it is at a distance of 150×106kilometres from the earth and light, travelling at a
great speed of 300,000 kilometres per second, takes about 8 minutes and 20 seconds to reach
us from the sun. However, light takes about 4.3 years to reach us from the next nearest star
called proxima centauri.
Sun is not a solid body. The sun is a sphere of hot gases. It consists mostly of hydrogen gas.. The
nuclear fusion reactions taking place in the centre of the sun( in which hydrogen is converted
into helium) produce a tremendous amount of energy in the form of heat and light. It is this
energy, which makes the sun shine From the Earth, we see only the surface of the sun. The
shining surface of the sun is called photosphere. The surface of the sun (photosphere) appears

1
Details of dark matter and dark energy will be discussed in Science and Technology notes.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


8 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

like a bright disc to us, it is also known as disc of the sun. It is this bright, shining disc of the sun
(or photosphere) which radiates energy and acts as a source of energy for us. The temperature
at the sun (or the temperature of the bright disc of the sun) is about 6000°C. The temperature
at the centre of the sun is about 15 million °C. The outer layer of the sun’s atmosphere made up
of thin, hot gases is called corona. The corona is visible only during a total eclipse of the sun.

6.2. Planets
Planets are solid heavenly bodies which revolve round a star (e.g. the sun) in closed elliptical
paths. A planet is made of rock and metal. It has no light of its own. A planet shines because it
reflects the light of the sun. since the planets are much nearer than the stars, they appear to be
big and do not twinkle at night. The planets move round the sun from west to east, so the
relative positions of the planets keep changing day by day. The planets are very small as
om

compared to the sun or other stars. There are 8 major planets including the earth. These
l.c

planets in the order of increasing distances from the sun are given below-
ai
tm

1. Mercury (Budha): it is nearest to the sun.


ho
t@

2. Venus ( Shukra)
sp

3. Earth (Prithvi)
h.
es

4. Mars (Mangal)
ur
ay

5. Jupiter (Brihaspati): Biggest Planet.


m

6. Saturn (Shani)
7. Uranus (Arun)
8. Neptune (Varun)

IAU new definition of planet


The definition of planet set in 2006 by the International Astronomical Union (IAU) states
that, in the Solar System, a planet is a celestial body which:
• is in orbit around the Sun,
• has sufficient mass to assume hydrostatic equilibrium (a nearly round shape), and
• Has "cleared the neighbourhood" around its orbit. For this they become the
dominant gravitational body in their orbit in the Solar System. Pluto lacks it.
Any object if meet the first two criteria but doesn’t meet the 3rd criteria is considered a
dwarf planet. Thus Pluto is a dwarf planet.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


9 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Planets and dwarf planets of our solar system (Milky Way)


The 8 planets have been divided into two groups. All the planets of a particular group have
some common features. The two groups of planets are:
1. Terrestrial Planets
2. Jovian Planets
The four nearest planets to the Sun, Mercury, Venus, Earth and Mars, are called terrestrial
planets, because their structure is similar to earth.
The common features of the terrestrial planets are:
om

1. They have a thin, rocky crust.


l.c
ai

2. They have a mantle rich in iron and magnesium.


tm

3. They have a core of heavy metals.


ho
t@

4. They have thin atmosphere.


sp

5. They have very few natural satellites (or moons) or no satellites.


h.
es
ur

They have varied terrain such as volcanoes, canyons, mountains, and craters. The planets which
ay

are outside the orbit of Mars are called Jovian planets because their structure is similar to that
m

of Jupiter. The Jovian planets are: Jupiter, Saturn, Uranus, and Neptune.
The common features of the Jovian planets are:
1. They are all gaseous bodies (made of gases)
2. They have ring system around them.
3. They have a large number of natural satellites (or moons).

Solar System Fact Sheet


(For reference only. Do not try to memorise facts.)
Sun MERC VEN EAR MO MA JUPIT SATU URAN NEPT PLUT
URY US TH ON RS ER RN US UNE O
1,988, 0.07 0.6 0.013
Mass (1024k) 500 0.33 4.87 5.97 3 42 1898 568 86.8 102 1
Diameter (k 1,392, 12,1 12,7 347 679 142,9 120,5 51,11 49,52
m) 684 4879 04 56 5 2 84 36 8 8 2390

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


10 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Density (kg/ 1,408 524 551 334 393


m3) 5427 3 4 0 3 1326 687 1271 1638 1830
Gravity (m/s
2) 3.7 8.9 9.8 1.6 3.7 23.1 9 8.7 11 0.6
Escape
Velocity (km/
s) 4.3 10.4 11.2 2.4 5 59.5 35.5 21.3 23.5 1.1
Rotation -
Period (hour 1407. 583 655. 24. -
s) 6 2.5 23.9 7 6 9.9 10.7 -17.2 16.1 153.3
Length of 4222. 280 708. 24.
Day (hours) 6 2 24 7 7 9.9 10.7 17.2 16.1 153.3
Distance
from 108. 149. 0.38 227 1433. 2872. 4495.
Sun (106 km) 57.9 2 6 4 .9 778.6 5 5 1 5870
Perihelion (1 107. 147. 0.36 206 1352. 2741. 4444.
06 km) 46 5 1 3 .6 740.5 6 3 5 4435
Aphelion (10 108. 152. 0.40 249 1514. 3003. 4545. 7304.
6 km) 69.8 9 1 6 .2 816.6 5 6 7 3
Orbital 224. 365. 10,74 30,58 59,80 90,58
Period (days) 88 7 2 27.3 687 4331 7 9 0 8
Orbital
Velocity (km/ 24.
s) 47.9 35 29.8 1 1 13.1 9.7 6.8 5.4 4.7
Orbital
Inclination (d
egrees) 7 3.4 0 5.1 1.9 1.3 2.5 0.8 1.8 17.2
Orbital 0.00 0.01 0.05 0.0
Eccentricity 0.205 7 7 5 94 0.049 0.057 0.046 0.011 0.244
Axial 177. 25.
om

Tilt (degrees) 0.01 4 23.4 6.7 2 3.1 26.7 97.8 28.3 122.5
l.c

Mean
ai
tm

Temperature
ho

(C) 167 464 15 -20 -65 -110 -140 -195 -200 -225
t@

Surface
sp

Pressure (bar 0.0 Unkn Unkn Unkn Unkn


h.
es

s) 0 92 1 0 1 own own own own 0


ur
ay

Number of
m

Moons 0 0 1 0 2 67 62 27 14 5
Ring System? No No No No No Yes Yes Yes Yes No
Global
Magnetic Unkn
Field? Yes No Yes No No Yes Yes Yes Yes own
(Source: http://nssdc.gsfc.nasa.gov/planetary/factsheet/)

6.3. Satellites (or Moons)


A satellite (or moon) is a solid heavenly body that revolves round a planet. The moon revolves
round the earth, so moon is a satellite of the earth.. Except Mercury and Venus all other planets
of solar system have satellites. The satellites have no light of their own. They shine because
they reflect the light of the sun. It should be noted that though we commonly call earth’s
natural satellite as moon, the satellites of all other planets can also be called their moons.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


11 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Earth’s moon key points:


• The moon is a natural satellite of the earth.
• Moon revolves round the earth on a definite, regular path- the moon’s orbit.
• Gravitational attraction of the earth holds the moon in its orbits.
• The moon is about one-fourth the size of the earth in diameter and weight is about
one-eighth that of the earth.
• Moon has no air or water. Its surface is covered with hard and loose dirt, craters and
mountains.
• On the moon, days are extremely hot and nights are very cold.
• Because the moon is nearer to the earth, it appears to be much bigger than the stars.
• The moon has no light of its own, it is light from the sun which is reflected by the
moon’s surface.
Origin of Moon
In 1838, Sir George Darwin suggested that initially, the earth and the moon formed a single
rapidly rotating body. The whole mass became a dumb-bell-shaped body and eventually it
broke. It was also suggested that the material forming the moon was separated from what we
have at present the depression occupied by the Pacific Ocean.
However, the present scientists do not accept either of the explanations. It is now generally
believed that the formation of moon, as a satellite of the earth, is an outcome of ‘giant impact’
or what is described as “the big splat”. A body of the size of one to three times that of mars
collided into the earth sometime shortly after the earth was formed. It blasted a large part of
the earth into space. This portion of blasted material then continued to orbit the earth and
eventually formed into the present moon about 4.44 billion years ago.
Other Objects in the sky: In addition to the stars, planets and satellite, there are three other
objects which we can occasionally see in the sky during night. These are asteroids, comets and
meteors. We will discuss all of them one by one.
om
l.c

6.4. Asteroids
ai
tm
ho

Asteroids are very small planets of rock and metal which revolve round the sun mainly between
t@

the orbits of mars and Jupiter. Actually, asteroids are a belt of a kind of debris, which somehow
sp

failed to assemble into a planet and keep revolving between the orbits of mars and Jupiter.
h.
es

There may be as many as 100,000 asteroids. The biggest asteroid called ‘ceres’ has a diameter
ur
ay

of about 800 kilometres whereas the smallest asteroid is as small as pebble. Some experts
m

believe that asteroids are the pieces of a planet that went close to Jupiter and was broken up by
its gravitational pull. Others think that they are part of a ring of separate pieces of matter
formed at the same time as the planets.
Sometimes an asteroid can collide with earth. Though the collision of an asteroid with the earth
happens very rarely, even then a careful watch is kept on the motion of asteroids by the
astronomers. This is because the collision of an asteroid with the earth can cause a lot of
damage to life and property on the earth. In fact, the extinction of dinosaurs the earth which
occurred about 65 million years ago, is believed to have been caused by the collisions of some
asteroids with the earth.
When an asteroid collides with the earth, then a huge crater is formed on the surface of the
earth. Many such collisions of the asteroids must have occurred in the past during the entire
history of the earth which may have caused craters of different sizes on its surface. However,
the natural process of soil erosion like wind and rain, tend to fill up these craters in due course
of time. Only a few such craters survived on the surface of the earth so far. The ‘Lonar Lake’ in
Maharashtra is one such crater formed by the collision of an asteroid with the earth.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


12 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

6.5. Comets
According to new definition, Neptune is the outermost planet of the solar system. However, it’s
orbit does not mark the boundary of the solar system. The solar system extends much beyond
at the edge of the solar system, there are billions of very small objects called ‘comets’ these
comets were formed very early from the same gas cloud from which other members of the
collar system were made. These comets are so far off that normally they cannot be seen. They
keep on revolving around the Sun, unknown to the world.
Sometimes, however, the normal path of a comet is disturbed and the comet starts moving
towards the sun. As the comet approaches the sun, it develops a long, glowing tail and
becomes visible only when it approaches the sun because the sun’s rays make its gas glow
which spreads out to form a tail millions of kilometres long. And it presents a spectacular sight.
Thus, a comet is a collection of gas and dust, which appears as a bright ball of light in the sky
with a long glowing tail. The tail of a comet always points away from the sun. Comets revolve
around the sun like planets. The period of revolution of comets around the sun is, however,
very large. For example, Halley’s Comet has a period of about 76 years. Halley's Comet last
appeared in the inner Solar System in 1986 and will next appear in mid-2061.
Just like asteroids, comets are also of great interest to scientists. This is because they are made
of the same material from which the whole solar system was made. The study of the tail of the
comets has shown the existence of molecules of carbon, oxygen, hydrogen and nitrogen such as
CO, CH4 and HCN on it. Since these simple molecules help to form complex molecules
necessary for the origin of life, some scientist have suggested that the seeds of life on the earth
were brought by comets from the outer space. Comets do not last forever. Each time a comet
passes the sun, it loses some of its gas and ultimately only the dust particles are left in space.
When these particle enter into the earth’s atmosphere, they burn up due to heat produced by
air resistance and produce a shower of meteors or shooting stars.

6.6. Meteors
om
l.c

Many times we see a streak of light in the sky during night which disappears within seconds. It
ai
tm

is called a meteor or shooting star. Meteors are the heavenly bodies from the sky which we see
ho

as a bright streak of light that flashes for a moment across the sky. The meteors are also called
t@

shooting stars. Some meteors are the dust particles left behind by comets and others are the
sp
h.

pieces of asteroid which have collided. When a meteor enters into the atmosphere of earth
es
ur

with high speed, a lot of heat is produced due to the resistance of air. This heat burns the
ay

meteor and the burning meteor is seen in the form of a streak of light shooting down the sky,
m

and it falls on the earth in the form of dust.


If a meteor is big, a part of it may reach the earth’s surface without being burned up in air. This
fragment is called a meteorite. Thus, a meteor which does not burn completely on entering
the earth’s atmosphere and lands on earth is known as a meteorite. Meteorites are a sort of
stones from the sky. By studying the composition of meteorites we can get valuable
information about the nature of the material from which the solar system was formed. It should
be noted that the number of meteorites striking the moon’s surface is quite large whereas very
few meteorites reach the earth’s surface. This is due to the fact moon has no atmosphere to
burn the falling meteorites by producing the frictional heat.

7. The Shape of the Earth


In ancient times, people believed that the shape of the Earth was flat and it had steep edges.
Today we know that the Earth is almost spherical. However, it is not a perfect sphere, rather it
an oblate spheroid, bulging slightly at the equator and flattened slightly at the poles. The

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


13 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

difference between the equatorial diameter and the polar diameter is less than 44 km. The
diameter of the Earth is 12,756 km at the equator, whereas it is 12,712 km between the poles.
This is due to the centrifugal force caused by the Earth’s rotation around its axis. This difference
is insignificant and thus for all practical purposes the Earth is taken as spherical in shape.
The view that the Earth is spherical in shape was first forwarded by the famous Greek
philosopher, Phagoras, in the sixth century BC. But people did not believe him. Later, Aristotle,
Varahamihira, Aryabhata and Copernicus also opined that the Earth is spherical in shape.

7.1. Evidence of the Earth’s Sphericity


There are many ways to prove that earth is spherical. The following are some of them.
1. The Sun and the other planets in the Solar System are all spherical in shape.
2. If the Earth was flat, then all the places on the Earth would have had sunrise and sunset
exactly at the same time.
3. If we watch a ship approaching the land, first we see the smoke of the ship (as the
entire ship lies below the line of sight) and gradually the entire ship, as it comes up over
the horizon. If the Earth was flat, we would have been able to see the whole ship at a
time.
4. A circular shadow observed during the lunar eclipse can only be cast by a spherical
body.
5. If you look around from any place, whether a mountain, a level plain, or top of a very
tall building, the horizon will always appear circular. This is possible only in case of a
spherical body.
6. Magellan’s circumnavigation in 1520 proved that the Earth is spherical in shape.
7. Engineers when driving poles of equal length at regular intervals on the ground have
found that they do not give a perfect horizontal level. The centre pole normally projects
slightly above the poles at either end because of the curvature of the earth.
8. Nowadays, when you can see the Earth in its true perspective from the outer space, the
om
l.c

fact that the shape of the Earth is spherical needs no further proof.
ai
tm

Goldilocks zone
ho
t@

A habitable zone, also called a Goldilocks zone, is the region around a star where orbiting
sp

planets similar to the Earth can support liquid water. It is neither too hot, nor too cold.
h.
es
ur

Scientists hunting for life in the Solar System and around other stars believe liquid water is an
ay

important ingredient necessary for life.


m

In September 2010 astronomers using the Keck telescope announced they had found an
exoplanet, Gliese 581g2, about three times the size of Earth in the habitable zone of its star.
The Earth is a unique planet because it sustains life. Here are some more details:
1. The Earth lies between the orbits of Venus and Mars and the average distance from the
Sun is about 148 million km. This gives it the optimum location with reference to the
distance from the Sun. It is neither too hot like Venus nor too cold like Mars and the
outer planets. The average temperature is about 17°C on the side facing the Sun.
2. The Earth has a favourable environment and presents optimum conditions for the
origin, growth and survival of various life forms. If the heat received from the Sun

2
UPSC asked question on Gliese 581g

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


14 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

(insolation) increases or decreases by about 10 per cent, then a very large part of the
Earth would become unsuitable for living organisms.
3. The rotation of the Earth around its axis, helps in keeping the extremes of temperatures
between day and night well within tolerable limits.
4. The presence of adequate quantities of water in the oceans, seas, gulfs, rivers, lakes,
etc., is a unique feature of our planet. Water occupies about 71 per cent of the total
surface area of the Earth. These water bodies provide Ideal conditions for the origin
and evolution of various life forms. The water cycle maintains the continuous flow of
water on Earth.
5. The atmosphere acts as a shield and protects our planet from the harmful ultra-violet
rays coming from the Sun. The atmosphere also absorbs terrestrial radiation from the
Earth’s surface and thus keeps the Earth comparatively warmer during the night time
and also during the winter season.
6. The presence of oxygen in the atmosphere has made life possible on Earth, as it is
essential for respiration and survival of all living organisms.

7.2. The Earth’s Movement


Origin of Life on Earth
Modern scientists refer to the origin of life as a kind of chemical reaction, which first generated
complex organic molecules and assembled them. This assemblage was such that they could
duplicate themselves converting inanimate matter into living substance. The record of life that
existed on this planet in different periods is found in rocks in the form of fossils. The microscopic
structures closely related to the present form of blue algae have been found in geological formations
that are much older than these were some 3,000 million years ago. It can be assumed that life began
to evolve sometime 3,800 million years ago. The summary of evolution of life from unicellular
bacteria to the modern man is given in the Geological Time Scale on last page.
In the Solar System, the Earth has a special relationship with the Sun and the Moon. The Earth
om

revolves around the Sun, and the Moon revolves around the Earth. The Earth also rotates on its
l.c

axis.
ai
tm
ho

These motions of the Earth cause days and nights, seasons, tides, eclipses, etc.
t@

7.2.1. Day and Night


sp
h.
es

When the earth rotates on its own axis, only one portion of the earth’s surface comes into the
ur
ay

rays of the sun and experiences daylight. The other portion which is away from the sun’ rays will
m

be in darkness. As the earth rotates from west to east, every part of the earth’s surface will be
brought under the sun at some time or other, a part of the earth’s surface that emerges from
darkness into the sun’s rays experiences sunrise. Later, when it is gradually obscures from the
sun is in fact, stationary and it is the earth which rotates. The illusion is exactly the same as
when we travel in a fast- moving train. The trees and houses around us appear to move and we
feel that the train is stationary.
7.2.2. The Earth’s Revolution
When the earth revolves round the sun, it spins on an elliptical orbit and one complete
revolution takes 365⅟4 days or a year. As it is not possible to show a quarter of a day in the
calendar, a normal year is taken to be 365 days, and an extra day is added every four years as a
Leap Year.
The Earth rotates once in about 24 hours with respect to the sun and once every 23 hours 56
minutes and 4 seconds with respect to the stars. This is the reason why the stars rise four
minutes early every next day. Earth's rotation is slowing slightly with time; thus, a day was

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


15 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

shorter in the past. This is due to the tidal effects the Moon has on Earth's rotation. Atomic
clocks show that a modern day is longer by about 1.7 milliseconds than a century ago. Leap
seconds are used to synchronise atomic clock.
7.2.3. Varying Lengths of Day and Night
The axis of the earth is inclined to the plane of the ecliptic (the plane in which the earth orbits
round the sun) at an angle of 66⅟2°, giving rise to different seasons and varying lengths of day
and night. If the axis were perpendicular to this plane, all parts of the globe would have equal
days and night at all times of the year, but we know this is not so. In the hemisphere in winter
as we go northwards, the hours of darkness steadily increase. At the Arctic Circle (66⅟2°) the
sun never ‘rise’ and there is darkness for the whole day in mid- winter on 22 December. Beyond
the Arctic Circle the number of days with complete darkness increases, until we reach the North
Pole (90°N) when half the year will have darkness. In the summer (June) conditions are exactly
reversed. Daylight increases as we go polewards. At the Arctic Circle, the sun never ‘sets’ at
mid-summer (21 June) and there is a complete 24-hour period of continuous daylight. In
summer, the region north of the Arctic Circle is popularly referred to as “Land of the Mid-Night
Sun’. At the North Pole, there will be six months of continuous daylight.
In the southern hemisphere, the same process takes place, except that the conditions are
reversed. When it is summer in the northern hemisphere, the southern conditions will
experience winter. Mid- summer at the North Pole will be mid-winter at the South Pole.
om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

Revolution of Earth

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


16 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

7.2.4. The Altitude of the Midday Sun


In the course of a year, the earth’s revolution round the sun with its axis inclined at 66⅟2 to the
plane of the ecliptic changes the apparent altitude of the midday sun. The sun is vertically
overhead at the equator on two days each year. These are usually 21 March and 21 September
though the date changes because a year is not exactly 365 days. These two days are termed
equinoxes meaning ‘ equal nights’ because on these two days all parts of the world have equal
days and nights. After the March equinox the sun appears to move north and is vertically
overhead at the Tropic of Cancer (23⅟2°N) on about 21 June. This is known as the June or
summer solstice when the northern hemisphere will have its longest day and shortest night. By
about 22 December, the sun will be overhead at the Tropic of Capricorn (23⅟2°S). This is the
winter solstice when the southern hemisphere will have its longest day and shortest night. The
Tropics thus marks the limits of the overhead sun, for beyond these, the sun is never overhead
at any time of the year. Such regions are marked by distinct seasonal changes- spring, summer,
autumn and winter. Beyond the Arctic Circle(66⅟2°N) and the Antarctic Circle (66⅟2°S)where
darkness lasts for 6 months and daylight is continuous for the remaining half of the year, it is
always cold; for even during the short summer the sun is never high in the sky. Within the
tropics, as the midday sun varies very little from its vertical position at noon daily, the four
seasons are almost equal all the year round.
7.2.5. Seasonal Changes and their Effects on Temperature
Summer is usually associated with much heat and brightness and winter with cold and
darkness. Why should this be so? In summer, the sun is higher in the sky than in winter. When
the sun is overhead its rays fall almost vertically on the earth, concentrating its heat on a small
area; temperature therefore rises and summer are always warm. In winter the oblique rays of
the sun, come through the atmosphere less directly and have much of their heat absorbed by
atmospheric impurities and water vapour. The sun’s rays fall faintly and spread over a great
area. There is thus little heat, and temperatures remain low.
om

In addition, days are longer than nights in summer and more heat is receives over the longer
l.c

daylight duration. Nights are shorter and less heat is lost. There is a net gain in total heat
ai
tm

received and temperature rise in summer. Shorter days and longer nights in winter account for
ho

the reverse effects.


t@
sp

7.2.6. Dawn and Twilight


h.
es
ur

The brief period between sunrise and full daylight is called dawn and that between sunset and
ay
m

complete darkness is termed twilight. This is caused by the fact that during the period the dawn
and twilight the earth receives diffused or refracted light from the sun whilst it is still below the
horizon. Since the sun rises and sets in a vertical path at the equator the period during which
refracted light is received is short. But in temperate latitudes, the sun rises and sets in an
oblique path and the period of refracted light is longer. It is much longer still at the poles, so
that the winter darkness is really only twilight most of the time.
7.2.7. Eclipse
An eclipse occurs when the Sun, the Earth and the Moon are in a straight line in the plane of
ecliptic. When the Earth obstructs the rays of the Sun from reaching the face of the Moon, the
Moon gets eclipsed. When the Moon hides the face of the Sun, then it is an eclipse of the Sun.
At anytime the Sun is able to light only half of the Earth’s surface which is facing the Sun. The
other half, which is turned away from the Sun is in darkness.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


17 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

7.2.7.1. Lunar Eclipse


A lunar eclipse will occur, only when the Sun, the Earth and the Moon are in a straight line, and
the Earth lies between the Sun and the Moon. This is possible on a Full Moon day. But a lunar
eclipse does not occur on every Full Moon day, as these three bodies have to be in the plane of
ecliptic.
(a) If the Moon is exactly in the plane of ecliptic, a total lunar eclipse will occur.
(b) If the Moon is close to the plane of ecliptic, a partial lunar eclipse will occur.
(c) If the Moon is far above or far below the plane of ecliptic, no eclipse will occur.
7.2.7.2. Solar Eclipse
A solar eclipse will occur only when the Sun, the Earth and the Moon are in a straight line, and
the Moon lies between the Sun and the Earth. This is possible on a New Moon day. But the
solar eclipse does not occur on every New Moon day, as these three bodies have to be in the
plane of ecliptic.
(a) If the Moon is exactly in the plane of ecliptic, a total solar eclipse will occur.
(b) If the Moon is close to the plane of ecliptic, a partial solar eclipse will occur.
(c) If the Moon is far above or far below the plane of ecliptic, no eclipse will occur.
The Diamond Ring Effect is a visual phenomenon that occurs during
a total solar eclipse. It is seen from earth when standing in the
umbra of the moon’s shadow, and occurs as a part of Baily’s Beads.
Baily’s Beads are glimmers of the sun’s brilliant surface (the
photosphere) which shine as dots of light around the disc of the
lunar shadow. When only one “bead” remains, momentarily, the
view of the eclipse resembles a diamond ring. The ring is produced
as the sun’s less bright corona layer and other upper atmospheric
structures remain dimly visible as a solid ring while a dazzling dot of
om

the photosphere shines at the edge.


l.c
ai
tm

8. The Geographical Grid- Latitude and Longitude


ho
t@

The earth’s surface is so vast that unless a mathematical method can be used, it is impossible to
sp
h.

locate any place on it. For this reason, imaginary lines have been drawn on the globe. One set
es
ur

running east and west, parallel to the equator, are called lines of latitude. The other set runs
ay

north and south passing through the poles and are called lines of longitude. The intersection of
m

latitude and longitude pin-points any place on the earth’s surface. For example Delhi is 28°37’N
and 77°10’E.

8.1. Latitude
Latitude is the angular distance of a point on the earth’s surface, measured in degrees from the
centre of the earth. It is parallel to a line, the equator, which lies midway between the poles.
These lines are therefore called parallels of latitude, and on a globe are actually circles,
becoming smaller polewards. The equator represents 0° and the North and South Poles are
90°N and 90°S. Between these points lines of latitude are drawn at intervals of 1°. For precise
location on a map, each degree is sub-divided into 60 minutes and each minute into 60
seconds. The most important lines of latitude are the equator, the tropic of Cancer (23⅟2°N.),
the tropic of Capricorn (23⅟2°S.), the Arctic Circle (66⅟2°N.) and the Antarctic Circle (66⅟2°S.). As
the earth is slightly flattened at the poles, the linear distance of a degree of latitude at the pole
is a little longer than that at the equator. For example at the equator (0°) it is 68.704 miles, at
45° it is 60.054 miles and at the poles it is 69.407 miles. The average is taken as 69 miles. This is

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


18 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

a useful figure and can be used for calculating distances to any place. Bombay is 18.55°N; it is
therefore 18.55*69 or 1280 miles from the equator.

Latitude and Longitude

8.2. Longitude
Longitude is an angular distance, measured in degrees along the equator east or west of the
Prime (or First) Meridian. On the globe longitude is shown as a series of semi-circles that run
from pole to pole passing through the equator. Such lines are also called meridians. Unlike the
equator which is centrally placed between the poles, any meridian could have been taken to
begin the numbering of longitude. It was finally decided in 1884, by international agreement, to
choose as the zero meridian the one which passes through the Royal Astronomical Observatory
at Greenwich, near London. This is the Prime Meridian (0°) from which all other meridians
radiate eastwards and westwards up to 180°. Since the earth is spherical and has a
circumference calculated at 25,000 miles, in liner distance each of the 360 degrees of longitude
om
l.c

is 25,000/360 or 69.1 miles. As the parallels of latitude become shorter polewards, so the
ai

meridians of longitude, which converge at the poles, enclose a narrower space. The degree of
tm
ho

longitude therefore decreases in length. It is longest at the equator where it measures 69.172
t@

miles. At 25° it is 62.73 miles, at 45° it is 49 miles, at 75° 18 miles and at the pole 0 mile. There
sp
h.

is so much difference in the length of degrees of longitude outside the tropics, that they are not
es

used for calculating distances as in the case of latitude. But they have one very important
ur
ay

function; they determine local time in relation to G.M.T or Greenwich Mean Time, which is
m

sometimes referred to as World Time.

8.3. Longitude and Time


Local time: Since the Earth makes one complete revolution of 360° in one day or 24 hours, it
passes through 15° in one hour or 1° in 4 minutes. The earth rotates from west to east, so every
15° we go eastward, local time is advanced by 1 hour. Conversely, if we go westwards, local time
is retarded by 1 hour. We may thus conclude that places east of Greenwich see the dun earlier
and gain time, whereas places west of Greenwich see the sun later and lose time. If we know
G.M.T., to find local time, we merely have to add or subtract the difference in the number of
hours from the given longitude, as illustrated below. A simple memory aid for this will be East-
Gain-Add (E.G.A.) and West-Lose-Subtract (W.L.S.). You could coin your own rhymes for the
abbreviations. Hence when it is noon, in London (Longitude 0°5W.), the local time for Chennai
(80°E.) will be 5 hours 20 minutes ahead of London or 5.20 p.m. but the local time for New York
(74°W.) will be 4 hours 56 minutes behind London or 7.04 a.m.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


19 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

8.4. Standard Time and Time Zones


If each town were to keep the time of its own meridian, there would be much difference in local
time between one town and the other. 10 a.m. in Georgetown, Penang would be 10.10 in Kota-
Bharu (a difference of 2½° in longitude). In larger countries such as Canada U.S.A., China, India,
and Russia the confusion arising from the differences alone would drive the people mad.
Travellers going from one end of the country to the other would have to keep their
appointments. This is impracticable and very inconvenient.
To avoid all these difficulties, a system of standard time is observed by all countries. Most
countries adopt their standard time from the central meridian of their countries. The Indian
Government has accepted the meridian of 82.5° east for the standard time which is 5hrs. 30
minutes ahead of Greenwich Mean Time. The whole world has in fact been divided into 24
Standard Time Zones, each of which differs from the next by 15° in longitude or one hour in
Time. Most countries adhere to this division but due to the peculiar shapes and locations of
some countries, reasonable deviations from the Standard Time Zones cannot be avoided.
Larger countries like U.S.A. (9), Canada (6) and Russia (9) which have a great east-west stretch
have adopted 9, 6 and 9 time zones respectively for practical purposes.

om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

Daylight saving time (DST) is a change in the standard time with the purpose of getting better
use of the daylight. Typically, clocks are adjusted forward one hour near the start of spring and
are adjusted backward in the autumn. Although it has only been used in the past hundred
years, the idea of DST was first conceived many years before.

9. Geological Time Scale


The earth is believed to be 4.5 billion years old. The 4.5 billion year long history of the earth is
divided into four era - Pre-Cambrian, Palaeozoic, Mesozoic and Calnozoic. Pre-Cambrian has
been the longest era in the earth’s history and it continued from the origin of earth to about
600 million year ago from today. The eras are divided into periods, and the periods are divided
in to epochs. A brief account of the geological history of the earth is given in the following
table:

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


20 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Eons Era Period Epoch Age/Years Life/ Major Events


Before Present

Quaternary Holocene 0 - 10,000 Modern Man


Pleistocene 10,000 - 2 million Homo Sapiens

Tertiary Pliocene 2 - 5 million Early Human Ancestor


Cainozoic (From 65 Miocene 5 - 24 million Ape: Flowering Plants
million years to the Oligocene 24 - 37 Ma and Trees, Anthropoid
present times) Eocene 37 - 58 Million Ape Rabbits and Hare
Palaeocene 57 - 65 Million Small Mammals : Rats –
Mice
Mesozoic Cretaceous 65 - 144 Million Extinction of Dinosaurs
65 - 245 Jurassic 144 - 208 Million Age of Dinosaurs
Million Triassic 208 - 245 Million Frogs and turtles
Mammals
Palaeozoic Permian 245 - 286 Million Reptile dominate-replace
245 - 570 Carboniferous 286 - 360 Million amphibians
Million Devonian 360 - 408 Million First Reptiles:
Silurian 408 - 438 Million Vertebrates: Coal beds
Ordovician 438 - 505 Million Amphibians, First trace of
Cambrian 505 - 570 Million life on land: Plants, First
Fish
No terrestrial Life:
Marine Invertebrate
Proterozoic Pre- Cambrian 570 - 2,500 Million Soft-bodied arthropods
Archean 570 Million 2,500 - 3,800 Million Blue green Algae:
Hadean - 4,800 3,800 - 4,800 Million Unicellular bacteria
Million Oceans and Continents
form – Ocean and
Atmosphere are rich in
Carbon dioxide

Origin of 5,000 - 5,000 Million Origin of the sun


Stars 13,700 12,000 Million Origin of the universe
Supernova Million 13,700 Million
om

Big Bang
l.c
ai
tm

Questions:
ho
t@

1. Gliese 581g (UPSC 2011/2 Marks)


sp
h.

2. What does the solar system consists of? Discuss the motion of the entire solar system as a
es

whole and also the motion of most of the bodies forming the solar system. (UPSC 2003/
ur
ay

15 Marks)
m

3. What is the difference between a comet and a meteor? (UPSC 1997/3 Marks)
4. Why does a lunar eclipse occur only on a full moon? (UPSC 1996/3 Marks)
5. What is a leap second? (UPSC 1992/3 Marks)
6. What is ‘Chandrashekhar limit’? (UPSC 1985/3 Marks)
7. Astronomers have, of late, been discussing ‘black hole.’ What is a ‘black hole’?(UPSC
1979/3 Marks)
8. What is the ‘diamond ring effect’ observed during a total solar eclipse? How is it caused?
(UPSC 1979/3 Marks)

Copyright © by Vision IAS


All rights are reserved. No part of this document may be reproduced, stored in a retrieval system or
transmitted in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording or
otherwise, without prior permission of Vision IAS.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


21 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

INTERIOR OF EARTH
Contents
1. Introduction ............................................................................................................................. 23

2. Sources of Information............................................................................................................. 23

2.1. Direct Sources ................................................................................................................... 23

2.2. Indirect Sources................................................................................................................. 23

2.2.1. Temperature ............................................................................................................... 23

2.2.2. Density ....................................................................................................................... 24

2.2.3. Pressure...................................................................................................................... 24

2.2.4. Gravitation force ........................................................................................................ 25

2.2.5. Magnetic surveys ....................................................................................................... 25

2.2.6. Meteorites.................................................................................................................. 25

2.2.7. The Moon ................................................................................................................... 25

2.2.8. Evidence from Theories.............................................................................................. 25


om

2.2.9. Earthquake Waves ...................................................................................................... 26


l.c
ai
tm

3. Structure of the Earth’s Interior ............................................................................................... 27


ho
t@

3.1. The Crust ........................................................................................................................... 28


sp
h.
es

3.2. The Mantle ........................................................................................................................ 28


ur
ay
m

3.3. The Core ............................................................................................................................ 29

4. Crust and Mantle vs. Lithosphere and Asthenosphere ............................................................ 30

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


22 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

1. Introduction
Human life is largely influenced by the physiography of the region. Therefore, it is necessary
that one gets acquainted with the forces that influence landscape development. Also to
understand why the earth shakes or how a tsunami wave is generated, it is necessary that we
know certain details of the interior of the earth.

2. Sources of Information
Most of the information about the Earth’s interior is based on inferences drawn from different
sources – both direct and indirect.

2.1. Direct Sources


Our knowledge about the structure and interior of the earth from direct observation is very
limited. No instrument has been invented so far which can see through the interior of the earth
directly. The deepest depth of an oil well drilled so far is 8 kilometers. The deepest mine of the
world is Robinson Deep in South Africa. Its depth is less than 4 kilometer.
Besides mining, scientists have taken up a number of projects to penetrate deeper depths to
explore the conditions in the crustal portions. Scientists world over are working on two major
projects such as “Deep Ocean Drilling Project” and “Integrated Ocean Drilling Project”. The
deepest drill at Kola, in Arctic Ocean, has so far reached a depth of 12 km. This and many deep
drilling projects have provided large volume of information through the analysis of materials
collected at different depths.
Volcanoes are yet another major source of direct information – they tell us about the
composition and characteristics of the materials found inside the Earth. However, it is difficult
to ascertain the depth of the source of such material.

2.2. Indirect Sources


om

The centre of the earth downward is 6,371 kilometers away from the surface of the earth. In
l.c
ai

comparison to this distance the depth of a deep well or a mine is insignificant. It is therefore,
tm
ho

necessary to take help of indirect scientific evidences to know about the interior of the earth.
t@

These sources include temperature, pressure and density of earth, behaviour of seismic waves
sp

(the waves generated by Earthquakes), Meteors, the Moon etc. These sources may be classified
h.
es

into three groups


ur
ay

(a) Artificial sources such as temperature, pressure and density.


m

(b) Evidences from the theories of origin of earth


(c) Natural Sources e.g. volcanic eruption, earthquakes, meteors and seismology.

2.2.1. Temperature
Temperature goes on increasing with the increase in depth inside the earth. This is clearly
proved while going down a mine or deep wells. The volcanic eruptions or hot water springs also
confirm this fact that temperature increasing towards the interior of the earth. On an average,
there is a rise of 1oC temperature for every 32 meters of depth. This rapid increase in
temperature continues to great depth there after the temperature increases slowly.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


23 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Fig 1: Temperature profile of the inner Earth


The main reasons for the increase in heat and temperature in the interior of the earth are the
following:
1. Radioactive disintegration within rocks which liberates heat
2. Internal and external forces (gravitational pull, weight of overlying rocks etc.)
3. Chemical reactions
It is tempting to think that under the conditions of this enormous temperature in the interior of
the earth nothing can be found in solid state. Under such conditions all existing rocks should be
either in liquid or gaseous state. But it is not so. Along with the increase in temperature with
depth, pressure too increases in the interior of the earth. This pressure is lacs of times more
than the pressure exercised by atmospheric layers on the surface of the water in oceans. For
this reason due to enormous pressure, liquid state rocks of the core have the properties of
om

solids. It is possible that these rocks might be in plastic state. It is why these rocks have
l.c

elasticity. Due to the pressure of overlying layers on the earth’s interior these rocks do look
ai
tm

solid upto 2900 kilometers’ depth. Sometimes due to lessening of overlying pressure, the rocks
ho
t@

in the interior melt down and the fluid comes to the surface or is in the process of finding its
sp

way to the surface of the earth. A volcanic eruption is one such example.
h.
es

2.2.2. Density
ur
ay
m

In accordance with the Newton’s laws of gravity the earth’s density has been calculated to be
5.5 (gms per cubic centimeter). However, it is surprising that the rocks near the surface of the
earth have an average density of 2.7 only (gms per cubic centimeter). This density is less than
half the average density of the earth as a whole. From this, it is clear that the density too
increases with the increase in depth. The earth’s internal part is composed of very dense rocks;
their density must be in the range of 8-10 (gms per cubic centimeter). The density of the central
part of the core is still more.
Higher density could be due to heavy metals like Nichel and Iron at the centre as well as due to
pressure of overlying layers.
2.2.3. Pressure
Just like temperature and density and pressure too increase with increase in depth inside the
earth. Some earth scientists believe that due to the weight of the overlying layers the pressure
goes on increasing with depth and others think that materials of the interior of the earth are
heavier since birth of the earth. The happenings due to change in pressure inside the earth
affect the physical features on the surface of the earth.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


24 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

2.2.4. Gravitation force


The gravitation force (g) is not the same at different latitudes on the surface. It is greater near
the poles and less at the equator. This is because of the distance from the centre at the equator
being greater than that at the poles. The gravity values also differ according to the mass of
material. The uneven distribution of mass of material within the earth influences this value.
The reading of the gravity at different places is influenced by many other factors. These
readings differ from the expected values. Such a difference is called gravity anomaly. Gravity
anomalies give us information about the distribution of mass of the material in the crust of the
earth. Gravity anomalies also inform us about the distribution of molten material in the crust
of the earth.
2.2.5. Magnetic surveys
The earth also acts like a huge magnet. The rapid spinning of earth creates electric currents in
its centre (molten outer core) that creates a magnetic field around the earth. The magnetic
field is strongest at the magnetic north and south poles. The magnetic north and south poles do
not coincide with geographic north and south poles. In fact, the earth’s magnetic field keeps on
changing. Magnetic surveys provide information about the distribution of magnetic materials in
the crustal portion, and thus, provide information about the distribution of materials in this
part.
2.2.6. Meteorites
The space debris, while entering the atmospheric layers of earth are burnt due to the friction
of air. Only the heavier objects whose outer layers have been burnt fall to the earth. Man has
discovered many such meteorites and after examining them obtained evidences about the
interior of the earth. The meteorites which have been examined are of two types: (i) Rock; and
(ii) Metals.
The metallic meteorites chiefly contain heavy materials like iron and nickel. The meteorites too
om

have originated during the formation of solar system. It is, therefore, very much in order to
l.c

believe that both the meteorites and the earth are made of similar materials.
ai
tm

2.2.7. The Moon


ho
t@
sp

The first information about the earth’s interior had been obtained through the study of the
h.

moon. There are several ways of determining the moon’s orbit around earth. Among these one
es
ur

of the important factors is earth’s mass. Remember, there is close relationship between the
ay

mass and earth’s gravitation. The movements of the moon and its distance from earth provide
m

the basis for determining the mass of the earth by earth scientists.
2.2.8. Evidence from Theories
The earth was mostly in a volatile state during its primordial stage. Due to gradual increase in
density the temperature inside has increased. As a result the material inside started getting
separated depending on their densities. This allowed heavier materials (like iron) to sink
towards the centre of the earth and the lighter ones to move towards the surface. With passage
of time it cooled further and solidified and condensed into a smaller size. This later led to the
development of the outer surface in the form of a crust. During the formation of the moon, due
to the giant impact, the earth was further heated up. It is through the process of differentiation
that the earth forming material got separated into different layers. Starting from the surface to
the central parts, we have layers like the crust, mantle, outer core and inner core. From the
crust to the core, the density of the material increases. We shall discuss in detail the properties
of each of this layer in the next chapter.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


25 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

2.2.9. Earthquake Waves


Earthquakes1 are caused by the movements in the interior of the earth. These movements
cause waves inside the earth just as waves are generated on the surface of water in a lake when
a stone is thrown into it. Incidentally, majority of the earthquakes originate in the upper mantle.
The earthquake waves are measured on the seismograph. The study of earthquake waves helps
earth-scientists to get a lot of information about the types of rocks and layered composition in
the interior of the earth.
Earthquake waves are basically of two types — body waves and surface waves. Body waves are
generated due to the release of energy at the focus (origin of earthquake) and move in all
directions travelling through the body of the earth. Hence, the name body waves. The body
waves interact with the surface rocks and generate new set of waves called surface waves.
These waves move along the surface. The velocity of waves changes as they travel through
materials with different densities. The denser the material, the higher is the velocity. Their
direction also changes as they reflect or refract when coming across materials with different
densities.
There are two types of body waves: P-waves and S-waves. Important surface waves are Rayleigh
waves and L-waves (named after A. E. H. Love).
Body Waves Surface Waves
‘S’- Waves’ or Secondary
‘P’- Waves’ or Primary waves L-waves
waves
I. These are ‘Longitudinal Waves’. I. These are transverse I. These are transverse
II. Under their influence particles are waves. waves.
displaced in backward-forward II. Under their impact II. Their propagation is limited
direction. (compression waves.) particles swing side by to the surface of the earth
III. Their velocity is the fastest. side (shear waves). only.
IV. Their average velocity is 6-15 III. Their velocity is lower III. Their velocity through solid
om

kilometers per second. than the primary waves. particles or rocks is about
l.c

V. Different densities of rocks have IV. These waves cannot 3.5 kilometers per second.
ai

different velocities. pass through liquids. IV. They cause the greatest
tm
ho

VI. They can travel through all They travel through damage and destruction of
t@

mediums – solids, liquids and solids only. property during the


sp

gases. earthquake.
h.
es
ur
ay
m

Fig 2: Particle motion in seismic waves Fig 3: Arrival time of seismic waves

1
Note: Earthquakes, Richter scale, epicenter, hypocenter etc. will be discussed in another chapter.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


26 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Fig4: Shadow Zones Fig 5: Earthquake

3. Structure of the Earth’s Interior


The earthquake waves undergo changes at definite intervals during their propagation through
the interior of the earth. They also undergo the action of reflection and refraction. Places on
earth where seismic waves are not recorded are called “shadow zones”. S-waves are not
recorded beyond 103o angular distance from focus which indicate that outer core of earth is in
molten or semi-molten in which S-waves cannot propagate. As P-waves are not recorded
between angular distances of 103o to 142o, it indicates that the core has different density, state
and composition.
From the analysis of the behavior of these waves it is clear that the interior of the earth has a
layered structure of different densities.
With the help of earthquake waves, we can get the information about the exact location of the
layers, their depth, thickness and other physical and chemical properties. Based on the passage
of these waves through different types of rocks and their behavior we can conclude that the
om

earth’s interior has three main layers. These three layers are: (i) Crust, (ii) Mantle and (iii) Core.
l.c
ai

This arrangement can be compared to that of a boiled egg.


tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

Fig 6

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


27 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

3.1. The Crust


It is the earth’s uppermost layer. Crust is solid, rigid and very thin compared with the other two.
Like the shell of an egg, the Earth's crust is brittle and can break. The thickness of the crust is
not same everywhere.
Oceanic crust is thinner as compared to the continental crust. The mean thickness of oceanic
crust is 5 km whereas that of the continental is around 30 km. The continental crust is thicker in
the areas of major mountain systems. It is as much as 70 km thick in the Himalayan region.
Its two main parts are:
1. The uppermost thin layer– It is composed of such rocks which contain a large
proportion of silica and aluminum. It is called SIAL (SI = Silica, AL = Aluminum). The
continents are mostly composed of sial. It average density is 2.7 and thickness is of
about 28 kilometers.
2. The lower layer of the crust is made of comparatively heavier rocks. Silica and
magnesium are the major constituents in it. This part is therefore, known as SIMA (SI –
Silicon, MA = Magnesium). The oceanic floor is also made of this rock strata. Its average
thickness is 6-7 kilometers and density of about 3.0.
The thickness of SIAL and SIMA put together does not exceed 70 kilometers. Its volume is 1% of
the total volume of the earth. In comparison to 6378 km radius of the earth, the thickness of 70
kilometers is insignificant. However, this cannot be over looked. This shallow crust is the ground
of the nature’s wonderful activities.
om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay

Fig 7: Earth Crust


m

3.2. The Mantle


Its thickness is about 2900 Km. It volume is 83% of the whole earth. Near the lower limit of the
crust the velocity of P-waves increases from about 6.4 kilometers per second to 8 km per
second. This change in velocity of P-waves indicates the surface discontinuity between the
crust and the mantle. It is popularly known as Moho or the Mohorovicic discontinuity (after the
name of its discoverer).
The mantle is made up of dense and heavy materials such as oxygen, iron and magnesium. The
average density of the materials in the mantle varies between 3.5 g per cubic cm and 5.5 g per
cubic cm. The temperature of this layer ranges between 900°C and 2200° C. The temperature is
quite high and the hot rocks form magma in this layer. The pressure of the overlying layers,
keeps the lower part of the crust and the upper part of the mantle in an almost solid state. If
cracks appear in the crust, the pressure is released and the molten matter from inside the Earth
tries to reach the surface through volcanic eruptions.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


28 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

The upper portion of the mantle is called asthenosphere. The word astheno means weak. It is
considered to be extending upto 400 km. It is the main source of magma that finds its way to
the surface during volcanic eruptions.
The mantle plays an important role in all the happenings in the interior of the earth. It also
gives rise to Convection Currents. These currents supply energy for happenings like continental
drift, earthquake, volcanoes, etc.

Fig 8: The Discontinuities

3.3. The Core


It extends from 2900 Km depth upto the centre of the earth (6378 km). It is the interior most
part of the earth. It begins from Gutenberg Discontinuity. The mantle is demarcated from the
core by Gutenberg Discontinuity. The core is divided into two parts: (i) The Outer Core, (ii) The
Inner Core.
The outer core is possibly in wholly liquid or semi-liquid state. The transverse or S-waves of
earthquakes, seem to disappear at the Gutenberg Discontinuity. The outer core extends from
the depth of 2900 km, upto 5150 km. It has an average density of 10. The inner core is believed
om

to be solid. It extends from the depth of 5150 km upto the centre of the earth (6378 km). The
l.c

velocity of P waves increases at the boundary of outer and inner core. Its density is between 12-
ai
tm

13. To volume of the entire core is 16% of earth as a whole. The mass of the core is 32% of the
ho

earth’s mass. The major part of the core is made up of heavy metals like iron and nickel. This
t@
sp

zone is therefore known as Nife (Ni = Nickel, Fe = Ferrous). It is also known as Barysphere
h.

(which means heavy metallic rocks).


es
ur
ay

Table 3.1
m

Name of the Layer Chemical Composition Depth Density Physical Property


A. Crust Crustal material 5-70 Km. Solid State
1. Upper SIAL contains lighter elements like Si,
2. Lower SIMA O, Al, Ca, K, Na, etc... Feldspars
(Anorthite, Albite,
2.75 – 2.90
Orthoclase) are common
minerals in the crust
(CaAL2Si2O8, NaALSi3O8,
KALSi3O8).
B. Mantle is made up of Si and O, like the 35-2900 Some properties of
3. upper mantle (From crust, but it contains km. solid, some plastic.
Moho to 410 km) more Fe and Mg. Thus, Olivine Near the melting point
4. transition zone (410– (Fe2SiO4-Mg2SiO4) and pyroxene 3.4-5.6 their behavior is like
660 km), (MgSiO3-FeSiO3) solids heavy
5. lower mantle (660– are abundant in the mantle
2891 km)

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


29 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

C. Metallic Core of NIFE 2900 – 5.10 – Liquid or in plastic


Barysphere (Nickel + Ferrous or Iron) 5150 km 13.00 state Rigid because of
6. Outer Metallic Core Barysphere tremendous overlying
7. Inner Metallic Core (Heavy Metallic rocks) 5150 – pressure
6378 km

4. Crust and Mantle vs. Lithosphere and Asthenosphere


Lithosphere, asthenosphere, and mesosphere represent changes in the mechanical properties
of the Earth. Crust, Mantle and Core refer to changes in the chemical composition of the Earth.
The lithosphere (litho: rock; sphere: layer) is the strong, upper 100 km of the Earth. The
lithosphere is the tectonic plate (we talk about it in plate tectonics). The asthenosphere
(asthenos: weak) is the weak and easily deformed layer of the Earth that acts as a “lubricant”
for the tectonic plates to slide over. The asthenosphere extends from 100 km depth to 660 km
beneath the Earth's surface. Beneath the asthenosphere is the mesosphere, another strong
layer.

om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

Copyright © by Vision IAS


All rights are reserved. No part of this document may be reproduced, stored in a retrieval system or
transmitted in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording or
otherwise, without prior permission of Vision IAS.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


30 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

CONTINENTAL DRIFT AND PLATE TECTONICS


Contents
1. Supercontinent ......................................................................................................................... 32
1.1. Supercontinent Cycle ........................................................................................................ 32
1.2. Pangaea ............................................................................................................................. 33
2. Continental Drift....................................................................................................................... 33
2.1. Continental Drift Theory of Alfred Wegener .........................................................................
2.1.1. Evidences in Support of the Theory ........................................................................... 34
2.1.2. Forces for Drifting ...................................................................................................... 35
2.1.3. Criticism of Wegener’s Theory ................................................................................... 35
3. Post-Drift Studies ..................................................................................................................... 35
3.1. Convection Current Theory ............................................................................................... 36
3.2. Mapping of Ocean Floor ................................................................................................... 36
3.3. Sea Floor Spreading........................................................................................................... 36
4. Plate Tectonics.......................................................................................................................... 37
4.1. Major and Minor Plates .................................................................................................... 37
4.2. Movement of Plates .......................................................................................................... 38
4.2.1. Movement of The Indian Plate................................................................................... 39
4.3. Types of Boundaries .......................................................................................................... 39
4.3.1. Divergent Boundaries ................................................................................................. 40
4.3.2. Convergent Boundaries .............................................................................................. 40
4.3.3. Transform Boundaries ................................................................................................ 40
4.4. Forces for the Plate Movement......................................................................................... 40
4.5. Objections to Plate Tectonics Theory ................................................................................ 40
5. Endogenic and Exogenic Forces ............................................................................................... 41
5.1. Geomorphic Processes and Agents ................................................................................... 41
om

5.2. Endogenic Processes ......................................................................................................... 41


l.c
ai

5.2.1. Diastrophism .............................................................................................................. 41


tm

5.2.2. Volcanism ................................................................................................................... 42


ho
t@

5.3. Exogenic Processes............................................................................................................ 42


sp

5.3.1. Weathering................................................................................................................. 43
h.
es

5.3.2. Mass Movement ........................................................................................................ 45


ur

5.3.3. Erosion and Deposition .............................................................................................. 46


ay
m

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


31 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

EARTH OF THE DISTANT PAST WAS A VERY DIFFERENT PLANET THAN THE ONE WE
KNOW TODAY

1. Supercontinent
If you could travel through time to arrive at the Earth of a billion years ago, you would have a
hard time navigating. A strange giant continent and a single planetary ocean would replace the
familiar continents and oceans of today’s world. A supercontinent is the assembly of most or all
the Earth’s continental blocks to form a single large landmass. There is no unanimity among
tectonicists on a single definition of supercontinent. Hoffman (1999) used the term
“supercontinent” to mean “a clustering of nearly all continents”. According to this definition,
Pangaea is a supercontinent while Gondwana is not. There are other scholars who consider
Gondwanaland a supercontinent of pre-Cambrian period.
In the past, there existed many supercontinents at different time. The positions of continents
have been accurately determined back to the early Jurassic period. However, beyond 200
million years, continental positions are much less certain. Following is the list of
supercontinents.
Supercontinent name Age
Ur (Vaalbara) ~3.6-2.8 Billion years ago
Kenorland ~2.7-2.1 Billion years ago
Proto Pangaea-Paleopangaea ~2.7-0.6 Billion years ago
Columbia ~1.8-1.5 Billion years ago
Rodinia ~1.25-0.75 Billion years ago
Pannotia ~600 Million years ago
Pangaea ~300 Million years ago
Table 1 – Supercontinents through geologic history

1.1. Supercontinent Cycle


om
l.c
ai

Supercontinent does not last forever. A supercontinent cycle is the breakup of one
tm
ho

supercontinent and the development of another. Pangaea , last supercontinent, was formed by
t@

the continental fragments dispersed during the breakup of Pannotia during the latter half of the
sp

Paleozoic Era (figure 1).


h.
es
ur
ay
m

(a) Pannotia split (b) Assembled Pangaea 200 million years ago

Figure 1 - Supercontinents

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


32 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

1.2. Pangaea
Like its predecessor Pannotia, the giant continent of Pangaea also became victim to the Earth’s
internal heat. According to Alfred Wegener, Pangaea which was surrounded on all sides by
extensive water mass called Panthalasa, began to split around 200 million years ago. Pangaea
broke into two large continental masses Laurasia and Gondwanaland forming the northern and
southern components respectively. Subsequently, Laurasia and Gondwanaland continued to
break into various smaller continents that exist today.

2. Continental Drift
Abraham Ortelius, a Dutch map maker, was the first one to propose the possibility of the two
Americas, Europe and Africa to be once joined together as early as 1596. Antonio Snider drew a
map showing the three continents together in 1858, but this was so much opposed to the
scientific view then prevailing that nobody took notice of it. In 1910, F.B. Taylor of America
invoked the hypothesis of horizontal displacement of continents or continental drift with a view
to explaining the distribution of mountain ranges.

2.1. Continental Drift Theory of Alfred Wegener


It was Alfred Wegener – a German meteorologist - who put forth a comprehensive argument in
the form of “the continental drift theory” in 1912. Wegener was a climatologist who wanted to
explain the change of climates in the geological past. There are several geological evidences to
show that there have been important and large scale changes in the climates of the world in the
geological past. He came to the conclusion that either the climatic zones have moved or if they
have not, then there has been movement of the landmasses. The distribution of Climatic belts
of the world is governed primarily by the Sun. It, therefore, appear to be more probable that
the landmasses have changed their position.
According to Wegener, all the continents formed a single continental mass, a mega ocean
om

surrounded by the same. The super continent was named PANGAEA, a Greek word which
l.c

meant all earth. The mega-ocean was called PANTHALASSA, meaning all water as shown in
ai
tm

figure 1a. Wegner also imagined that in the carboniferous period the South pole was near the
ho

South African coast and the north pole lay in the Pacific ocean.
t@
sp

Wegener argued that, around 200 million years ago, the Pangaea began to split. The initial two
h.
es

blocks – Gondwanaland and Laurasia – started drifting away and in between a shallow sea
ur

emerged by filling up the water from Panthalasa. It was known as Tethys Sea. The present shape
ay
m

and relative position of the continents is the result of fragmentation of Pangaea by rifting and
the drifting apart of the broken parts (figure 2). He called this drifting away of continents as
Polflucht or the flight from the poles. He took help of theory of Isostasy in which the
continental blocks, made of SIAL, are floating over the ocean floor, made of SIMA.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


33 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.

Figure 2 – Pangaea
es
ur
ay

2.1.1. Evidences in Support of the Theory


m

A variety of evidences were offered in support of the continental drift theory. These are
summarized as:
(a) The matching of continents (“jig-Saw-fit”) – The shorelines of Africa and South America
facing each other have a remarkable and unmistakable match. It may be noted that
map produced using a computer programme to find the best fit of the Atlantic margin
was presented by Bullard in 1964. It proved to be quite perfect. The match was tried at
1,000 fathom line instead of the present shoreline.
(b) Rocks of Same Age Across the Oceans - The belt of ancient rocks of 2,000 million years
from Brazil coast matches with those from western Africa. The earliest marine deposits
along the coastline of South America and Africa are of the Jurassic age. This suggests
that the ocean did not exist prior to that time. Similarly, Appalachian mountains of
North America which come right up to the coast and then continue their trend across
the North Atlantic Ocean in the old Hercynian fold mountains of South-West Ireland,
Wales and Central Europe.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


34 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

(c) Tillite - It is the sedimentary rock formed out of deposits of glaciers. The Gondawana
system of sediments from India is known to have its counter parts in six different
landmasses of the Southern Hemisphere. At the base the system has thick tillite
indicating extensive and prolonged glaciation. Counter parts of this succession are
found in Africa, Falkland Island, Madagascar, Antarctica and Australia besides India. It
clearly demonstrates that these landmasses had remarkably similar histories.
(d) Placer Deposits - The occurrence of rich placer deposits of gold in the Ghana coast and
the absolute absence of source rock in the region is an amazing fact. The gold bearing
veins are in Brazil and it is obvious that the gold deposits of the Ghana are derived from
the Brazil plateau when the two continents lay side by side.
(e) Distribution of Fossils - The observations that Lemurs occur in India, Madagascar and
Africa led some to consider a contiguous landmass “Lemuria” linking these three
landmasses. Mesosaurus was a small reptile adapted to shallow brackish water. The
skeletons of these are found only in two localities: the Southern Cape province of South
Africa and Iraver formations of Brazil. The two localities presently are 4,800 km apart
with an ocean in between them. Such presence of identical plants and animals is
possible only when they lived on a common landmass.
2.1.2. Forces for Drifting
Wegener suggested that the movement responsible for the drifting of the continents was
caused by pole-fleeing force and tidal force. The polar-fleeing force relates to the rotation of
the earth. This was, according to Wegener, the cause for movement of continents towards
equator ward. Tidal force – due to the attraction of the Moon and the Sun – was the main
reason given by Wegener for the westward movement of the Americas. Wegener believed that
these forces would become effective when applied over many million years.
2.1.3. Criticism of Wegener’s Theory
It is clear that Wegener had amassed an imposing array of evidences in support of his theory
om

and some of this evidence was undeniably convincing. But so much of theory was based on
l.c

speculation and inadequate evidence that it provoked a lot of criticism and controversy.
ai
tm
ho

(a) The greatest criticism has been the force of continental drift proposed by him. Tidal
t@

force need to be ten thousand million times stronger than at present to move the
sp

continents.
h.
es

(b) Wegener proposed that Rockies and Andies mountain chain are formed during the
ur
ay

westward drift of Americas. But if the SIAL (continents) is floating over SIMA (ocean
m

floor), then the SIMA could not offer so much resistance as to cause folds and build
mountain system.
(c) The jig-saw-fit of the opposing coasts of Atlantic Ocean was not so complete.
(d) Though there was similarity in the structural and stratigraphical features of the two
coasts of the Atlantic, it would not be quite correct to conclude that one was an
extension of the other and that they were joined together.

3. Post-Drift Studies
A number of discoveries during the post-war period added new information to geological
literature. Most of the evidences for the continental drift theory of Alfred Wegener were
collected from the continental areas. New literature collected from the ocean floor mapping
provided new dimensions for the study of distribution of oceans and continents.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


35 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

3.1. Convection Current Theory


While explaining the processes of mountain building, Arthur Holmes put forward his theory of
convection current in 1928-29. According to Holmes, convection currents exist in the mantle
portion of

Figure 3 – Convection currents in the mantle portion of the Earth


the Earth as shown in figure 3. The cause of the origin of these currents is the presence of
radioactive elements which causes thermal differences in the mantle portion. Holmes argued
that there exists a system of such currents in the entire mantle portion. This was an attempt to
provide an explanation to the issue of force, on the basis of which contemporary scientists
discarded the continental drift theory.

3.2. Mapping of Ocean Floor


Post-war period saw surge in the detailed research of the ocean configuration. It revealed that
ocean floor is not just a vast plain but is full of features such as mid-oceanic ridge, trenches,
Abyssal plains etc. The mid-oceanic ridges were found to be most active in terms of volcanic
eruptions. The age of rocks from Oceanic floor is nowhere more than 200 million years as
compared to billions of year sold rocks from continental region and hence, oceanic rocks are
om

much younger than the continental areas. Another interesting fact was that the rocks located
l.c

equi-distant from the crest were found to have remarkable similarities in terms of their
ai
tm

constituents, age, magnetic properties etc.


ho
t@

3.3. Sea Floor Spreading


sp
h.

The hypothesis of sea-floor spreading was first put forward by Harry Hess in 1961. Post-drift
es
ur

studies had been able to establish the facts which were not available at the time of Wegener.
ay
m

These may be summarized as:


(a) The ocean crust rocks are much younger than the continental rocks. The age of rocks in
the oceanic crust is nowhere more than 200 million years old compare to continental
rocks out of which some are as old as 3,200 million years.
(b) The sediments on the ocean floor are unexpectedly very thin and thickness of the
sediments increases with the distance from the ridge. They were only 6 to 7 km thick,
whereas below the continental surfaces this thickness was 30 to 40 kms.
(c) Mid-oceanic ridge was not found only in Atlantic Ocean, but ridges were present in all
the oceans. These ridges contain large scale evidences of faulting and volcanicity and
are bringing huge amounts of lava to the surface.
(d) The rocks equidistant on either sides of the crest of mid-oceanic ridges show
remarkable similarities in terms of period of formation, chemical compositions and
magnetic properties. Rocks closer to the mid-oceanic ridges are of normal polarity and
are the youngest. The age of the rocks increases as one moves away from the crest.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


36 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

On the basis of above facts the realization dawned that the ocean floor possibly is the youngest
and most active part of the earth’s surface. In 1961, Harry Hess argued that the ocean floor was
mobile and

Figure 4 – Sea-floor spreading


constant eruption at the crest of oceanic ridges causes the rupture of the oceanic crust and the
new lava wedges into it, pushing the oceanic crust on either side as shown in figure 4. The
ocean floor, thus spreads. But this spreading does not cause the shrinking of the other. Hess
argued about the sinking of the crust which was spread in the trench system and does it gets
consumed. On analysis, it was found that 2 cm/year is adequate for separation of South
America from Africa in about 200 million years.

4. Plate Tectonics
Since the advent of the concept of sea floor spreading, the interest in the problem of
distribution of oceans and continents was revived. The hypothesis of plate tectonics is an
om

extended and more comprehensive version of the theory of sea-floor spreading. This is a great
l.c
ai

unifying concept which “draws sea-floor spreading, continental drift, crustal structures and
tm
ho

world pattern of seismic and volcanic activity together as aspects of one coherent picture.”
t@
sp

The term plate was first used by Tuzo Wilson in his definition of transform faults in 1965, but
h.

the hypothesis of plate tectonics was first outlined by W.J. Morgan in 1967. More or less
es
ur

concurrently but independently D.P. Mackenzie and Parker had arrived at similar conclusions. It
ay

first came to be known by the name of New Global Tectonics but after sometime the term Plate
m

Tectonics gained currency. Basic assumptions of plate tectonics are as follows:


1. There is spreading of sea floor and new oceanic crust is being continually created at the
active mid-oceanic ridges and destroyed at trenches.
2. The area of the earth’s surface is fixed. It means, the amount of crust consumed almost
equals the amount of new crust created.
3. The new crust that is formed becomes part and parcel of a plate.

4.1. Major and Minor Plates


A tectonic plate (also called lithospheric plate) is a massive, irregularly-shaped slab of solid rock.
Plates are generally composed of both continental and oceanic lithosphere. This is an important
difference between plate tectonics and continental drift theories. The lithosphere includes the
crust and the top mantle with its thickness range varying between 5-100 km in oceanic parts
and about 200 km in the continental areas. The plates are the inert aseismic regions bounded
by narrow mobile belts which are characterized by Seismic and volcanic activity or by orogenic

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


37 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

belts. Plates’ configuration is not related to the distribution of land and water. Plates can split or
get welded with adjoining plate.
The theory of plate tectonics proposes that the earth’s lithosphere is divided into seven major
and some minor plates. The major plates are as follows:
(a) Antarctic plate - Antarctica and the surrounding ocean
(b) North American plate – North America continent along with Western Atlantic floor
separated from the South American plate along the Caribbean islands
(c) South American plate – South America continent along with western Atlantic floor
(d) Pacific plate – covers almost entire pacific ocean
(e) India-Australia-New Zealand plate – Australian continent along with Indian sub-
continent and Indian Ocean.
(f) African plate – Africa continent along with eastern Atlantic floor
(g) Eurasian plate – Eurasia along with eastern Atlantic floor

om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur

Figure 5 – Major and Minor plates of the world


ay
m

Minor plates are small in areas. They are also moving in different directions like major plates.
Some important minor plates are listed below:
(a) Cocos plate – Between Central America and Pacific plate
(b) Nazca plate – Between South America and Pacific plate
(c) Arabian plate – Mostly the Saudi Arabian landmass
(d) Philippine plate – Between the Asiatic and Pacific plate
(e) Caroline plate – Between the Philippine and Indian plate (North of New Guinea)
(f) Fuji plate– North-east of Australia.

4.2. Movement of Plates


These tectonic plates float on and travel independently over the asthenosphere, which lies over
the mantle. Much of the earth's seismic activities occur at the boundaries of these plates. It is a
relatively slow movement, driven by thermal convection currents and other geological activities
originating deep within the earth's mantle. Plates have moved horizontally over the
asthenosphere as rigid units.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


38 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

The movement of a plate is defined by the position of its pole of rotation and its angle of
rotation about the rotation axis; its rate of movement varying with distance from the pole of
rotation, being nil at the pole and reaching a maximum at the equator relative to the pole of
rotation. The strips of normal and reverse magnetic field that parallel the mid-oceanic ridges
help scientists determine the rates of plate movement. These rates vary considerably.
The arctic ridge has the slowest rate(less than 2 cm per year), and the East Pacific Rise near
Easter Island in the South Pacific has the fastest rate (more than 15 cm per year). The eastern
part (Australia) is moving northward at the rate of 5.6 cm per year while the western part
(India) is moving only at the rate of 3.7 cm per year due to impediment by Himalayas. This
differential movement is resulting in the compression of the plate near its center at Sumatra
and a potential division into Indian and Australian Plates. The rate of spreading at the Mid-
Atlantic Ridge near Iceland is relatively slow, about 2 cm per year.
4.2.1. Movement of The Indian Plate
The Indian plate includes Peninsular India and the Australian continental portions. India was a
large island situated off the Australian coast, in a vast ocean. The Tethys sea separated it from
the Asian

om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

Figure 6 – Movement of the Indian Plate


continent. India is believed to have started her northward journey about 200 million years ago.
India collided with Asia about 40-50 million years ago causing formation of Himalayas. The
subduction zone along the Himalayas forms the northern plate boundary in the form of
continent— continent convergence. Scientists believe that the process is still continuing and the
height of the Himalayas is rising even to this date.

4.3. Types of Boundaries


Plate boundaries are very important and significant structural features. Nearly all seismic,
volcanic and tectonic activities are confined to the plate margins. Boundaries are very distinct
and easy to identify. They are associated with newly formed mountain systems, oceanic ridges
and trenches. Plates are moving continuously and have relative direction of movement. Based
on the direction of movement three types of plate boundaries can, easily, be identified (figure
7).

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


39 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Figure 7 – Types of plate boundaries


4.3.1. Divergent Boundaries
Where new crust is generated as the plates pull away from each other. The sites where the
plates move away from each other are called spreading sites. The best-known example of
divergent boundaries is the Mid-Atlantic Ridge. At this, the American Plate(s) is/are separated
from the Eurasian and African Plates at rate of around 2 cm per year.
4.3.2. Convergent Boundaries
Where the crust is destroyed as one plate dived under another at an angle of approximately
450. The location, where sinking of a plate occurs, is called a subduction zone. There are three
ways in which convergence can occur. These are: (i) between an oceanic and continental plate;
(ii) between two oceanic plates; and (iii) between two continental plates.
4.3.3. Transform Boundaries
Where the crust is neither produced nor destroyed as the plates slide horizontally past each
other. Transform faults are the planes of separation generally perpendicular to the mid-oceanic
ridges. As the eruptions do not take all along the entire crest at the same time, there is a
om

differential movement of a portion of the plate away from the axis of the earth. Also, the
l.c

rotation of the earth has its effect on the separated blocks of the plate portions.
ai
tm
ho

4.4. Forces for the Plate Movement


t@
sp

At the time of Wegener, it was believed that the earth was a solid, motionless body. However,
h.
es

sea floor spreading and tectonic plate theories emphasized that both the surface of the earth
ur

and the interior are dynamic. Generally, it is accepted that tectonic plates are able to move
ay
m

because of the relative density of oceanic lithosphere and the relative weakness of the
asthenosphere. The convection currents (proposed by Arthur Holmes) get diverted or
converged on approaching the crust layer. Heat within the earth comes from two main sources:
radioactive decay and residual heat.

4.5. Objections to Plate Tectonics Theory


Although plate tectonics has been a powerful principle to explain distribution of continents and
oceans, there are several problems to which it has not been able to offer a satisfactory solution.
(a) The length of the spreading ridge is far greater than the subduction zone.
(b) Plate tectonics is unable to explain why subduction is limited to the Pacific coasts while
spreading is found in all the Oceans.
(c) It has failed to provide a satisfactory explanation for mountain building. Mountain
ranges such as eastern highlands of Australia etc which cannot be related to plate
tectonics.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


40 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

(d) It is not definite that each plate behaves like a unit, and some people have proposed an
increase in the number of plates.

5. Endogenic and Exogenic Forces


The earth’s crust is dynamic which has moved and moves vertically and horizontally. It is being
continuously subjected to external forces induced basically by sunlight as well as by internal
forces caused by events occurring inside the earth. The external forces are known as exogenic
forces and the internal forces are known as endogenic forces. The variations in the relief over
the earth surface remain as long as the opposing actions of exogenic and endogenic forces
continue. The net resultant of these forces shape the landforms across the earth’s surface. We
can divide landforms into two basic categories – initial landforms and sequential. The initial
landforms are produced by endogenic forces. These initial landforms are modified and shaped
by the exogenic forces with simultaneous application of endogenic forces.

5.1. Geomorphic Processes and Agents


Geomorphology is the study of nature and origin of landforms. One of the approaches for such
study is deductive reasoning which depended largely on the geomorphic processes. The
endogenic and exogenic forces causing physical stresses and chemical actions on earth
materials and bringing about changes in the configuration of the surface of the earth are known
as geomorphic processes. The action of exogenic forces result in wearing down (degradation) of
relief and filling up (aggradation) of basins, on the surface of the earth. On the other hand, the
endogenic forces continuously elevate or build up parts of the earth’s surface.
On the other hand, geomorphic agent is any exogenic element of nature like wind, waves,
water, ice, ocean currents, etc. capable of acquiring and transporting earth material. When
these elements of nature become mobile due to gradients, they remove the materials and
transport them over slopes and deposit them at lower level.
A process is a force applied on the earth material affecting the same. An agent is a mobile
om

medium which removes, transports and deposits earth materials. Unless stated separately,
l.c
ai

geomorphic processes especially exogenic and geomorphic agents are one and the same.
tm
ho

5.2. Endogenic Processes


t@
sp
h.

The energy emanating from within the earth is the main force behind endogenic geomorphic
es

processes. This energy is mostly generated by radioactivity, rotational and tidal friction and
ur
ay

primordial heat from the origin of the earth. This energy due to geothermal gradients and heat
m

flow from within induces diastrophism and volcanism in the lithosphere. Due to variations in
geothermal gradients and heat flow from within, crustal thickness and strength, the action of
endogenic forces are not uniform and hence the tectonically controlled original crustal surface
is uneven. Diastrophism and Volcanism are included in endogenic geomorphic processes. These
may be summarized as:
5.2.1. Diastrophism
All processes that move, elevate or build up portions of the earth’s crust come under
diastrophism. These forces operate slowly and their effects are visible only after thousands of
years. The diastrophic forces include both the vertical and horizontal movements. They include:
(a) Orogenic processes involve mountain building through severe folding, faulting,
thrusting, often as a result of plate tectonics. It includes forces of compression and
tension which are tangential to the earth’s surface in contrast to radial forces under
epeirogenesis. Under compression forces, sediments within geosynclines are buckled
and deformed into long, linear mountain chains (Himalayas). Under the operation of

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


41 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

intense tensional forces, the rock strata are fractured. The line along which
displacement of the fractured rock strata takes place is called the fault line (Narmada
rift valley).
(b) Epeirogenic processes involve upliftment or depression of the Earth’s crust at a
continental scale which moves the crustal rocks enmasse in a vertical or radial
direction. It is a continental building process. Epeirogenic movement can be permanent
or transient. The movement is caused by a set of forces acting along the Earth radius,
such as those contributing to isostasy and faulting. For ex - Epeirogenic movement has
caused the southern Rocky Mountain region to be uplifted from 1300 to 2000m in the
past.
(c) Earthquake1 involves a shock or series of shocks due to sudden movement of crustal
rocks within the crust or mantle. Earthquakes are generally associated with boundaries
of tectonic plates. There are instances where earthquakes have occurred well inside the
tectonic plate. The release of energy occurs along the fault. A fault is a sharp break in
the crustal rocks. Tendency of rocks to move apart at some point of time overcomes the
friction. This causes release of energy and the energy waves in all directions.
(d) Plate tectonics involves horizontal movements of crustal plates.

5.2.2. Volcanism
Volcanism includes the movement of molten rock (magma) onto or toward the earth’s surface
and also formation of many intrusive and extrusive volcanic forms. The layer below the solid
crust is mantle which contains a weaker zone called asthenosphere. It is from this that the
molten rock material finds their way to the surface. The material in the upper mantle portion is
called magma. The magma is conveyed to the surface essentially along tube-like conduits and
the extrusion of lava builds distinctive conical or dome shaped landforms.
om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

5.3. Exogenic Processes


The exogenic processes derive their energy from atmosphere determined by the ultimate
energy from the sun and also the gradients created by tectonic factors. They are essentially
processes of land destruction.

1
earthquakes involving local relatively minor movements.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


42 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Figure 8 – Denudational process and their driving forces


The basic reason of these processes is development of stresses in the body of the earth
materials. It is this stress that breaks rocks and other earth materials. The shear stresses result
in angular displacement or slippage. Stress can be produced by gravitation pull, climatic factors
– thermal gradients, pressure gradients, amount and intensity of precipitation, humidity etc.
The density, type and distribution of vegetation also exert influence on exogenic processes. The
exogenic geomorphic processes vary from one climatic region to another. These vary within a
climatic region also due to location variation in climatic elements.
All the exogenic geomorphic processes are covered under a general term, called denudation
which means to strip off. Denudation consists of two kinds of processes – static and mobile.
Weathering is a static process while mass movement, erosion and transportation are mobile
processes (figure 8).
om

5.3.1. Weathering
l.c
ai

Weathering may be described as the mechanical disintegration or chemical decomposition of


tm

rocks in situ by different geomorphic agents at or near the surface of the earth. It changes hard
ho
t@

massive rock into finer material. It is the first phase in the denudation process which prepares
sp

rock materials for transportation by the agents of erosion and mass movement.
h.
es
ur

The main factors responsible for weathering are geological – rock structure, climatic,
ay

topographic and vegetative. These factors result into activities such as thermal expansion,
m

exfoliation, rock solutions, salt and ice crystallization etc. There are three types of weathering
which are described below in detail.
I. Chemical Weathering Process
No rock-forming mineral is absolutely chemically inert; some are more readily altered than
others. A variety of chemical actions such as carbonation, hydration, oxidation and reduction
act on the rocks to decompose and dissolve them. Water, air (Oxygen and carbon dioxide) along
with heat must be present to speed up all chemical reactions. Biological activities such as
decomposition of plants and animals increase acidity and other elements in the crust which
enhances chemical weathering.
• Hydration: is a process by which certain types of mineral expand as they take up water and
expand, causing additional stresses in the rock due to increase in the volume of mineral
itself. For instance, calcium sulphate absorbs water and turns to gypsum. Decomposed
products of rock-forming minerals are also subjected to hydration, thereby accelerating the
disintegration of the rock. This process of hydration is reversible and continued repetition

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


43 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

causes fatigue in the rock which eventually may lead to cracking of overlaying materials and
finally disintegration.
• Oxidation and reduction: oxidation is the addition of oxygen to form oxides or hydroxides
while reduction is the reverse of oxidation. Oxidation occurs when mineral has access to
atmosphere or oxygenated water. To put it simply, they rust. Red color of iron turns to
brown upon oxidation.
• Solution: few minerals such as rock salt are significantly soluble in water. Such rock-forming
minerals are easily leached out without leaving any residue in rainy climates and
accumulate in dry regions. Minerals like calcium carbonate present in limestones are
soluble in water containing carbonic acid. Carbon dioxide produced by decaying organic
matter along with soil water greatly aids in this reaction.
• Carbonation: many minerals are soluble in rainwater, which contains carbon dioxide and
acts as a weak carbonic acid. This is particularly important in the decomposition of
limestones; the rain water converts the calcium carbonate into calcium bicarbonate, which
is soluble and can be taken away in the groundwater.
These weathering process are inter-related. Hydration, oxidation, carbonation etc. go hand-in-
hand and hasten the weathering process.
II. Physical Weathering Process
Physical weathering is the mechanical disintegration of rock-forming minerals by different
geomorphic agents. The main factors responsible for it are (i) temperature change, (ii) the
crystallization of water or other crystal growth, (iii) pressure-release mechanism, (iv)
mechanical action of plants and animals. These factors act slow but can cause great damage to
the rocks because of continued stress or fatigue developed in the rock.
• Expansion by unloading – pressure release (unloading) mechanism causes disintegration of
rock. It is because of continued erosion by various geomorphic agents. Fractures develop
roughly parallel to the surface. This process has been termed exfoliation. Exfoliated sheets
om

may measure thousands of meters.


l.c

• Temperature change and expansion – thermal expansion of rock is the cause of rock
ai
tm

cracking and disintegration. If you travel to arid-tropics, it is possible that you may hear
ho
t@

sounds like rifle shots which are actually cracking of the rock as they contract. The theory is
sp

that rocks are poor conductors of heat. Due to strong diurnal heating, the outer layers of
h.
es

the rock warm up considerably, but do not transmit heat to the inner layers. During night
ur

when temperature falls, same layer gets contracted. This should lead to the setting up of
ay
m

stresses in the rock, causing fracturing parallel to the surface


• Salt weathering – a number of salts such as Sodium Chloride, Calcium sulphate may enter
rocks in dissolved form. On drying and crystallization they expand and set up a disruptive
effect. Expansion of these salts depends on temperature and their own thermal properties.
Force exerted by crystallization is sometimes more than the tensile strength off rocks, thus
causes splitting. Areas with alternating wetting and drying conditions favour salt
weathering.
• Frost action and crystal growth – frost action is one of the most important weathering
processes in cold climates. When water fills the pores, cracks and crevices in rocks and then
freezes, it expands and exerts a bursting pressure. The rocks are fractured, cracked. In this
process, rate of freezing is important. Freezing also penetrates to a greater depth when the
ground is bare rather than forest covered.
These processes – chemical and mechanical – are not stand alone activities. Different processes
acted upon same rock and produced net resultant weathered material together. For instance,
both chemical and mechanical weathering processes further weaken the joints, the layers

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


44 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

thereby peeling off in sheets. It is probably best to conclude that chemical weathering and
pressure release ally with temperature changes to produce rock disintegration. It is likely that
hydration process may also be involved when crystallization takes place. Another instance is of
hydration where hydration itself is a mechanical effect, but it occurs intimately with hydrolysis
in such a manner that it is difficult to draw any hard and fast line here between mechanical and
chemical weathering. Actions of plants, human and animal affect both chemical and mechanical
weathering.
III. Biological Activity
It includes the role of plants and animal in promotion of both physical and chemical
weathering. Burrowing and wedging by organisms like earthworms, termites, rodents etc., help
in exposing the new surfaces to chemical attack and assist in the penetration of moisture and
air. Human beings by disturbing vegetation, ploughing and cultivating soils, also help in mixing
and creating new contacts between air, water and minerals in the earth materials. Tree roots
can occasionally be shown to have forced apart adjacent blocks of rock. Decaying plant and
animal matter help in the production of humic, carbonic and other acids which enhance decay
and solubility of some elements.
5.3.2. Mass Movement
Mass movement or mass wasting is the term used for the movement of material down a slope
under the influence of gravity. Thus it excludes those in which material is carried directly by a
transporting medium such as running water, wind or ice. That means mass movement does not
come under erosion though there is a shift of materials from one place to another. The
movement of mass may range from slow to rapid, affecting shallow to deep columns of
materials and include creep, flow, slide and fall. Weathering is not a pre-requisite for mass
movement though it aids mass movement.
Mass wasting is viewed as a transitional phenomenon between weathering which is defined as
occurring in situ and erosion which requires as one element transport by some agent. Mass
om

wasting combines elements of both weathering and erosion.


l.c
ai
tm

Factors favouring mass movement are: (i) weathering; (ii) rock composition; (iii) texture and
ho

structure of material; (iv) slope gradient; (v) extent of lubrication. Several activities precede
t@
sp

mass movements. They are : (i) removal of support from below to materials above through
h.

natural or artificial means; (ii) increase in gradient and height of slopes; (iii) overloading through
es
ur

addition of materials naturally or by artificial filling; (iv) overloading due to heavy rainfall,
ay

saturation and lubrication of slope materials; (v) removal of material or load from over the
m

original slope surfaces; (vi) occurrence of earthquakes, explosions or machinery; (vii) excessive
natural seepage; (viii) heavy drawdown of water from lakes, reservoirs and rivers leading to
slow outflow of water from under the slopes or river banks; (ix) indiscriminate removal of
natural vegetation.

Figure 9 - Relationships among different types of mass movements

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


45 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Heave (heaving up of soils due to frost growth and other causes), flow and slide are the three
types of mass movements (figure 9). Mass movements can be grouped under three major
classes:
• Slow movements – the slow downhill movement of debris and soil on moderate slope is
described as creep. Depending upon the type of material involved, several types of creep
viz., soil creep, talus creep, rock creep, rock-glacier creep etc., can be identified. Leaning
fence post, accumulation of earth on the upslope side of stone walls, etc. are example of
creep. Also included in this group is solifluction which involves slow downslope flowing soil
mass or fine grained rock debris saturated or lubricated with water. This process is quite
common in moist temperate areas where surface melting of deeply frozen ground and long
continued rain respectively, occur frequently. The permanently frozen ground prevents the
downward percolation of water in summer, producing a highly saturated and mobile soil
layer. Also, there is absence of deep-rooted vegetation to bind the soil. Solifluction can
occur on slopes of 30 or less.
• Rapid movement – these depend on there being sufficient water to saturate
comprehensively the soil mass. These movements are mostly prevalent in humid climatic
regions and occur over gentle to steep slopes. Earthflow is movement of water-saturated
clayey or silty earth materials down hillsides. When slopes are steeper, even the bedrock
especially of soft sedimentary rocks like shale or deeply weathered igneous rock may slide
downslope. Another type in this category is mudflow. In the absence of vegetation cover
and with heavy rainfall, thick layers of weathered materials get saturated with water and
either slowly or rapidly flows down along definite channels. It looks like a stream of mud
within a valley. Mudflows occur frequently on the slopes of erupting or recently erupted
volcanoes. A third type is the debris avalanche, which is more characteristic of humid
regions. Avalanche can be much faster than the mudflow.
• Landslides – In these, as the velocity does not continually decrease downwards, there must
be one or more shear surfaces on which movement takes place. Where the shear surface is
om

approximately planar, the strict meaning of the term slide is appropriate. However, another
l.c

common type of landslide takes place on arcuate shear planes, and these are called
ai
tm

rotational slips. It results into slumping of debris with backward rotation. Most landslides
ho

usually occur fairly rapidly, often after excess groundwater following heavy rain has reduced
t@

soil strength. Over steep slopes, rock sliding is very fast and destructive.
sp
h.

5.3.3. Erosion and Deposition


es
ur
ay

The erosion can be defined as “application of the kinetic energy associated with the agent to
m

the surface of the land along which it moves”. Erosion is a term referring to those processes of
Denudation which wear away the land surface by the mechanical action of the debris which is
being acquired and transported by various agents of erosion. The agents by themselves are also
capable of erosion. Abrasion by rock debris carried by these geomorphic agents also aid greatly
in erosion. For erosion to occur the agent must be capable of exerting a force on the surface
greater than its shear strength.
When massive rocks break into smaller fragments through weathering and any other process,
erosional geomorphic agents like running water, groundwater, glaciers, wind and waves remove
and transport it to other places depending upon the dynamics of each of these agents.
Weathering aids erosion but it is not a pre-condition for erosion to take place.
Deposition is a consequence of erosion. The erosional agents loose their velocity and hence
energy on gentler slopes and the materials carried by them start to settle themselves. The
coarser materials get deposited first and finer ones later. Alluvial fans at the foothills, alluvial
plains, delta etc. are few examples of deposition landforms.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


46 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

UPSC Questions

1. What do you understand by the theory of continental drift? Discuss the prominent
evidences in its support.(UPSC 2013/5 Marks)
2. Sea-floor spreading. (UPSC 2010/5 Marks).

om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

Copyright © by Vision IAS


All rights are reserved. No part of this document may be reproduced, stored in a retrieval system or
transmitted in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording or
otherwise, without prior permission of Vision IAS.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


47 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

CONTINENT DRIFT, SEAFLOOR SPREADING, ENDOGENIC


AND EXOGENIC FORCES AND BASICS OF PLATE TECTONICS,
SOME IDEAS ABOUT SUPERCONTINENTS ETC.
Contents
1. Earthquakes.............................................................................................................................. 49
1.1. Types of Earthquakes ........................................................................................................ 49
1.2. Seismic Waves ................................................................................................................... 50
1.3. Depth of Earthquakes........................................................................................................ 50
1.4. Measurement of Earthquakes ........................................................................................... 50
1.4.1. Magnitude Scale......................................................................................................... 50
1.4.2. Intensity Scale ............................................................................................................ 50
1.4.3. Classification of Earthquakes ..................................................................................... 51
1.5. Distribution of Earthquakes .............................................................................................. 51
1.5.1. Seismic Belts of the world .......................................................................................... 51
1.5.2. Seismic Zones of India ................................................................................................ 52
1.6. Effects of Earthquakes ....................................................................................................... 53
2. Tsunami .................................................................................................................................... 53
2.1. Causes ............................................................................................................................... 54
2.2. Propagation ....................................................................................................................... 54
2.3. Consequences ................................................................................................................... 55
2.4. Early Warning and Mitigation ........................................................................................... 55
3. Volcanoes ................................................................................................................................. 56
3.1. Vulcanicity ......................................................................................................................... 56
3.1.1. Causes of Vulcanism ................................................................................................... 56
3.2. Components of a Volcano ................................................................................................. 56
3.2.1. Types of lavas ............................................................................................................. 57
om
l.c

3.3. Types of volcanoes ............................................................................................................ 57


ai

3.4. Volcanic Landforms ........................................................................................................... 58


tm
ho

3.4.1. Extrusive Landforms ................................................................................................... 58


t@

3.4.2. Intrusive Landforms ................................................................................................... 59


sp
h.

3.5. Distribution of Volcanoes .................................................................................................. 60


es

3.6. Effects of volcanic eruptions ............................................................................................. 61


ur
ay

3.7. Geysers .............................................................................................................................. 61


m

3.8. Hot Springs ........................................................................................................................ 62


3.9. Fumaroles.......................................................................................................................... 62

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


48 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

1. Earthquakes
An earthquake in simple words is shaking of the earth. It is caused due to release of energy,
which generates waves that travel in all directions.
The release of energy occurs along a fault. A fault is a sharp break in the crustal rocks. Rocks
along a fault tend to move in opposite directions. As the overlying rock strata press them, the
friction locks them together. However, their tendency to move apart at some point of time
overcomes the friction. As a result, the blocks get deformed and eventually, they slide past one
another abruptly. This causes dissipation of energy, and the energy waves travel in all
directions.
The point where the energy is released is called the focus of an earthquake, alternatively, it is
called the hypocentre. The energy waves travelling in different directions reach the surface. The
point on the surface, nearest to the focus, is called epicentre. It is the first one to experience
the waves. It is a point directly above the focus.

om
l.c
ai

Figure 1: Hypocentre and Epicentre


tm
ho

1.1. Types of Earthquakes


t@
sp

1. Tectonic Earthquakes: These are generated due to sliding of rocks along a fault plane. This
h.
es

movement causes imbalance in the crustal rocks which results in earthquakes of varying
ur
ay

magnitude, depending upon the nature of dislocation in the rock strata.


m

2. Volcanic Earthquakes: Volcanic activity is considered to be one of the main causes of


earthquakes. In fact, volcanic activity and seismic events are so intimately related to each
other that they become cause and effect for each other. Each volcanic eruption is followed
by an earthquake and many of the severe earthquakes can cause volcanic eruptions.
The explosive violent gases during the process of volcanic activity try to escape upward and
hence they push the crustal surface from below with great force. This leads to severe
tremors of high magnitude, which depend upon the intensity of volcanic eruptions.
3. Collapse Earthquakes: In areas of intense mining activity, sometimes the roofs of
underground mines collapse causing minor tremors.
4. Explosion Earthquakes: Ground shaking may also occur due to the explosion of chemical or
nuclear devices.
5. The earthquakes that occur in the areas of large reservoirs are referred to as reservoir
induced earthquakes.
Above may also be referred as various causes of earthquakes with one and two being the
natural causes of earthquakes while three, four and five represent anthropogenic or man-
made causes of earthquakes.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


49 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

1.2. Seismic Waves


The waves generated by an earthquake are called the 'seismic waves' or ‘earthquake waves’.
These are recorded by an instrument called the seismograph or the seismometer. For further
understanding of earthquake waves, refer to the portion of the notes on ‘Interior of Earth’.

1.3. Depth of Earthquakes


Earthquake focus depth is an important factor in shaping the characteristics of the waves and
the damage they inflict. The focal depth can be deep (from 300 to 700 km), intermediate (60 to
300 km) or shallow (less than 60 km). Deep focus earthquakes are rarely destructive because
the wave amplitude is greatly attenuated by the time it reaches the surface. Shallow focus
earthquakes are more common and are extremely damaging because of their close proximity to
the surface

1.4. Measurement of Earthquakes


The earthquake events are scaled either according to the magnitude or intensity of the shock.
1.4.1. Magnitude Scale
Magnitude is the amount of energy released and is based on the direct measurement of the
size of seismic waves. The magnitude scale is known as the Richter Scale.
The Richter magnitude scale was developed in 1935 by Charles F. Richter as a mathematical
device to compare the size of earthquakes. The magnitude of an earthquake is determined
from the logarithm of the amplitude of waves recorded by seismographs. Because of the
logarithmic basis of the scale, each whole number increase in magnitude represents a ten fold
increase in measured amplitude; as an estimate of energy, each whole number step in the
magnitude scale corresponds to the release of about 31 times more energy than the amount
associated with the preceding whole number value.
om

1.4.2. Intensity Scale


l.c
ai

Intensity of an earthquake is measured in terms of its effects on human life. The intensity of an
tm
ho

earthquake at a specific location depends on a number of factors. Some of them are:


t@

• the total amount of energy released,


sp
h.

• the distance from the epicentre,


es
ur

• the types of rocks and the degree of consolidation.


ay
m

The Mercalli intensity scale is a scale used for measuring the intensity of an earthquake. The
scale quantifies the effects of an earthquake on the Earth's surface, humans, objects of nature,
and man-made structures on a scale of I through XII, with I denoting ‘not felt’, and XII ‘total
destruction’. Data is gathered from individuals who have experienced the quake, and an
intensity value will be given to their location.
Characteristic Mercalli Scale Richter Scale
Measures The effects caused by The energy released by the earthquake
earthquake
Measuring Observation Seismograph
Tool
Calculation Quantified from Base-10 logarithmic scale obtained by calculating
observation of effect on logarithm of the amplitude of waves.
earth’s surface, human,
objects and man-made
structures

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


50 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Scale I (not felt) to XII (total From 2.0 to 10.0+ (never recorded). A 3.0
destruction) earthquake is 10 times stronger than a 2.0
earthquake.
Consistency Varies depending on Varies at different distances from the epicentre,
distance from but one value is given for the earthquake as a
epicentre. whole.
Table 1: Comparison between Richter and Mercalli Scale
1.4.3. Classification of Earthquakes
Category Magnitude on Richter Scale
Slight Upto 4.9
Moderate 5.0 to 6.9
Great 7.0 to 7.9
Very Great 8.0 and more
Table 2: classification of earthquakes based on magnitude

1.5. Distribution of Earthquakes


Most earthquakes in the world are associated with the following:
• the zones of young fold mountains,
• the zones of faulting and fracturing,
• the zones representing the junctions of continental and oceanic margins,
• the zones of active volcanoes, and
• along the different plate boundaries.
1.5.1. Seismic Belts of the world
The main seismic belts are as under:
om

1. Circum-Pacific Belt: The Belt includes the coastal margins of North America, South America
l.c
ai

and East Asia. These are as represent the eastern and western margins of the Pacific Ocean
tm
ho

respectively, and account for about 65 per cent of the total earthquakes of the world.
t@

The western marginal zones are represented by the Rockies and the Andes mountain
sp

chains. These are also the zones of convergent plate boundaries where the Pacific oceanic
h.
es

plate is subducted below the American plates.


ur
ay

The eastern marginal zones are represented by the island arcs of Kamchatka, Sakhalin,
m

Japan and Philippines. The earthquakes are caused due to collision of the Pacific and the
Asiatic plates and the consequent volcanic activity. Japan records about 1500 seismic
shocks every year.
2. Mid-Continental Belt: The Mid-Continental Belt includes the Alpine mountains and their off
shoots in Europe, Mediterranean Sea, northern Africa, eastern Africa and the Himalayas.
The Mid-Continental Belt extends through Sulaiman and Kirthar zones in the west, the
Himalayas in the north and Myanmar in the east. This belt represents the weaker zone of
Fold Mountains. About 21 per cent of the total seismic events are recorded in this belt.
3. Mid-Atlantic Ridge Belt: The Mid-Atlantic Ridge Belt includes the Mid-Atlantic ridge and
several islands near the ridge. It records moderate earthquakes which are caused due to
the moving of plates in the opposite directions. Thus the seafloor spreading and the fissure
type of volcanic eruptions cause earthquakes of moderate intensity in this region.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


51 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Figure 2: Distribution of Earthquake belts


1.5.2. Seismic Zones of India
The Indian sub-continent is highly prone to multiple natural disasters including earthquakes,
which is one of the most destructive natural hazards with the potentiality of inflicting huge loss
to lives and property. Earthquakes pose a real threat to India with 59% of its geographical area
vulnerable to seismic disturbance of varying intensities including the capital city of the country.
The varying geology at different locations in the country implies that the likelihood of damaging
earthquakes taking place at different locations is different. Thus, a seismic zone map is required
so that buildings and other structures located in different regions can be designed to withstand
different level of ground shaking. The current zone map divides India into four zones – II, III, IV
and V.
om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

Figure 3: Seismic Zones of India

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


52 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

The following table gives the distribution of various regions of the country into various seismic
zones:
Zone Damage risk Region
Zone V Very high damage The entire North-east, including the seven sister states, the Kutch
risk zone district, parts of Himachal and Jammu & Kashmir, and the Andaman
and Nicobar islands.
Zone IV High damage risk Parts of the Northern belt starting from Jammu and Kashmir to
zone Himachal Pradesh. Also including Delhi and parts of Haryana. The
Koyna region of Maharashtra is also in this zone.
Zone III Moderate damage A large part of the country stretching from the North including some
risk zone parts of Rajasthan to the South through the Konkan coast, and also
the Eastern parts of the country.
Zone II Low damage risk These two zones are contiguous, covering parts of Karnataka,
zone Andhra Pradesh, Orissa, Madhya Pradesh, and Rajasthan, known as
low risk earthquake zones.
Table 4: Region falling in various zones of the country

1.6. Effects of Earthquakes


The direct and indirect effects of an earthquake includes:
1. Deformed Ground Surface: The earthquake tremors and the resultant vibrations, result in
the deformation of the ground surface, due to the rise and subsidence of the ground
surface and faulting activity. The alluvium filled areas of the flood plains may get fractured
at several places.
2. Damage to man-made structures: Man-made structures such as buildings, roads, rails,
factories, dams, bridges, etc., get severely damaged.
3. Damage to towns and cities: The towns and cities are the worst affected due to a high
density of buildings and population. Under the impact of tremors, large buildings collapse
and men and women get buried under the debris. Ground water pipes are damaged and
om

thus water supply is totally disrupted.


l.c

4. Loss of human and animal life: The destructive power of an earthquake depends upon the
ai
tm

loss it can cause in terms of loss of life arid property. The Bhuj earthquake of India in 2001
ho

(8.1 on the Richter Scale) caused over one lakh human casualties.
t@
sp

5. Devastating fires: The strong vibrations caused by an earthquake can cause fire in houses,
h.

mines and factories due to the bursting of gas cylinders, contact with live electric wires,
es
ur

churning of blast furnaces, displacement of other electric and fire related appliances.
ay
m

6. Landslides: The tremors in hilly and mountainous areas can cause instability of
unconsolidated rock materials. This ultimately leads to landslides, which damage
settlements and transport systems.
7. Flash floods: Very strong seismic events result in the collapse of dams and cause severe
flash floods. Floods are also caused when the debris produced by tremors blocks the flow of
water in the rivers. Sometimes the main course of the river is changed due to the blockage.
8. Tsunamis: When the seismic waves travel through sea water, high sea waves are generated,
which can cause great loss to life and property, especially in the coastal areas.

2. Tsunami
Tsunami is a Japanese word which means ‘harbour wave’. It is a series of traveling ocean waves
of extremely long length generated by disturbances associated primarily with earthquakes
occurring below or near the ocean floor. Underwater volcanic eruptions and landslides can also
generate tsunamis. Tsunamis are a threat to life and property to anyone living near the
ocean. Large tsunamis have been known to rise over 100 feet, while tsunamis 10 to 20 feet high
can be very destructive and cause many deaths and injuries.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


53 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

2.1. Causes
Tsunamis generally are caused by earthquakes. Not all earthquakes generate tsunamis. To
generate tsunamis, earthquakes must occur underneath or near the ocean, be large and create
movements in the sea floor. All oceanic regions of the world can experience tsunamis, but in
the Pacific Ocean there is a much more frequent occurrence of large, destructive tsunamis
because of the many large earthquakes along the margins of the Pacific Ocean.

Figure 4: Generation of Tsunami


Other less common causes of earthquakes are submarine landslides, submarine volcanic
eruptions and very rarely a large meteorite impact in the ocean.

2.2. Propagation
om

In the open ocean a tsunami is less than a few feet high at the surface, but its wave height
l.c
ai

increases rapidly in shallow water. Tsunamis wave energy extends from the surface to the
tm

bottom in the deepest waters. As the tsunami attacks the coastline, the wave energy is
ho
t@

compressed into a much shorter distance creating destructive, life-threatening waves.


sp
h.

Where the ocean is over 20,000 feet deep, unnoticed tsunami waves can travel at the speed of
es

a commercial jet plane, nearly 600 miles per hour. They can move from one side of the Pacific
ur
ay

Ocean to the other in less than a day. This great speed makes it important to be aware of the
m

tsunami as soon as it is generated. Scientists can predict when a tsunami will arrive since the
speed of the waves varies with the square root of the water depth. Tsunamis travel much
slower in shallower coastal waters where their wave heights begin to increase dramatically.

Figure 5: Rise in Tsunami amplitude near the coast

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


54 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Offshore and coastal features can determine the size and impact of tsunami waves. Reefs, bays,
entrances to rivers, under sea features and the slop of the beach all help to modify the tsunami
as it attacks the coastline. When the tsunami reaches the coast and moves inland, the water
level can rise many feet. In extreme cases, water level has risen to more than 50 feet for
tsunamis of distant origin and over 100 feet for tsunami waves generated near the earthquake's
epicentre.

2.3. Consequences
The consequences vary from loss of livelihood for fishermen to unknown damages to coral reefs
and flora and fauna. It may take years for the coral reefs to get back the balance and mangrove
stands and coastal tree plantations get destroyed or severely affected.
With so much sea water coming inland, salination is another effect that not only makes the soil
less fertile to support vegetation but also increases vulnerability to erosion, the impacts of
climate change and food insecurity. For humans, on the other hand, fisheries, housing and
infrastructure are the worst affected.

2.4. Early Warning and Mitigation


Major tsunami warning centres are:
1. Pacific Tsunami Warning Center (PTWC): The Tsunami Warning System (TWS) in the Pacific,
comprised of 26 participating international Member States, has the functions of monitoring
seismological and tidal stations throughout the Pacific Basin to evaluate potentially tsunami
genic earthquakes and disseminating tsunami warning information. The Pacific Tsunami
Warning Center is the operational center of the Pacific TWS. Located near Honolulu, Hawaii,
PTWC provides tsunami warning information to national authorities in the Pacific Basin.
2. The Alaska Tsunami Warning Center (ATWC): in Palmer, Alaska, serves as the regional
Tsunami Warning Center for Alaska, British Columbia, Washington, Oregon, and California.
3. Indian Tsunami Early Warning System (ITEWS): The Indian Tsunami Early Warning System
om

has the responsibility to provide tsunami advisories to Indian Mainland and the Island
l.c
ai

regions. Acting as one of the Regional Tsunami Advisory service Providers (RTSPs) for the
tm

Indian Ocean Region, ITEWS also provide tsunami advisories to the Indian Ocean Rim
ho
t@

countries along with Australia and Indonesia.


sp
h.

In order to confirm whether the earthquake has actually triggered a tsunami, it is essential to
es

measure the change in water level as near to the fault zone with high accuracy. There are two
ur
ay

basic types of sea level gages: coastal tide gages and open ocean buoys.
m

Tide gages are generally located at the land-sea interface, usually in locations somewhat
protected from the heavy seas that are occasionally created by storm systems. Tide gages that
initially detect tsunami waves provide little advance warning at the actual location of the gage,
but can provide coastal residents where the waves have not yet reached an indication that a
tsunami does exist, its speed, and its approximate strength.
Open ocean tsunami buoy systems equipped with bottom pressure sensors are now a reliable
technology that can provide advance warning to coastal areas that will be first impacted by a
tsunami, before the waves reach them and near by tide gages. Open Ocean buoys often provide
a better forecast of the tsunami strength than tide gages at distant locations.
Apart from technology, we can also use natural barriers to mitigate the effect of tsunamis.
Coral reefs act as natural breakwaters, providing a physical barrier that reduces the force of a
wave before it reaches the shore, while mangrove forests act as natural shock absorbers, also
soaking up destructive wave energy and buffering against coastal erosion.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


55 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

3. Volcanoes
The word volcano is derived from the name of ‘Vulcano’, a volcanic island in the Aeolian
Islands of Italy whose name in turn originates from ‘Vulcan’, the name of a god of fire in Roman
mythology.
Volcano is a vent or an opening through which heated materials consisting of water, gases,
liquid lava and rock fragments are erupted from the highly heated interior to the surface of the
Earth. The layer below the solid crust of earth is mantle. It has higher density than that of the
crust. The mantle contains a weaker zone called asthenosphere. It is from this that the molten
rock materials find their way to the surface. The material in the upper mantle portion is called
magma. Once it starts moving towards the crust or it reaches the surface, it is referred to as
lava.
‘Volcanology’ or ‘vulcanology’ is the term given to the study of volcanoes, and the scientists
who study them are called the ‘volcanologists’ or ‘vulcanologists’.

3.1. Vulcanicity
Vulcanicity includes all those processes in which molten rock material or magma rises to the
crust to solidify as crystalline or semi-crystalline rocks. Some scientists use ‘vulcanism’ as a
synonym for vulcanicity.
Vulcanicity has two components; one of them operates below the crustal surface and the other
above the crust, i.e. the endogenetic mechanism and the exogenous mechanism. The
endogenetic mechanism includes the creation of hot and liquid magma and gases in the mantle
and the crust, their expansion and upward ascent, their intrusion and cooling and solidification
in various forms below the crustal surface. The exogenous mechanism includes the process of
the appearance of lava, volcanic dust and ashes, fragmental materials, mud, smoke, etc., in
different forms on the earth’s surface.
om

3.1.1. Causes of Vulcanism


l.c
ai

The mechanism of vulcanism and the volcanic activity are associated with several processes,
tm
ho

such as:
t@

1. A gradual increase of temperature with increasing depth at the rate of 1 degree Celsius for
sp
h.

every 32 m.
es
ur

2. Magma is formed due to the lowering of melting point, which in turn is caused by the
ay

reduction in pressure of the overlying material.


m

3. Gases and vapour are formed due to heating of water, which reaches underground through
percolation.
4. The ascent of magma forced by vast volume of gases and water vapour.
5. The occurrence of volcanic eruption.

3.2. Components of a Volcano


The volcanoes of explosive type have a volcanic cone, which is formed when the erupted
material accumulates around the vent. The vent is an opening of circular or nearly circular
shape at the centre of the cone. The vent is connected to the interior of the earth by a narrow
pipe. The volcanic materials erupt through this pipe. A funnel-shaped hollow at the top of the
cone is called the crater.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


56 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Figure 6: Components of a volcano


3.2.1. Types of lavas
There are two main types of lavas:
1. Basic Lavas: These are the hottest lavas and are highly fluid. They are dark coloured like
basalt, rich in iron and magnesium but poor in silica. They flow quietly and are not very
explosive. They affect extensive areas, spreading out as thin sheets over great distances
om

before they solidify. The resultant volcano is gently sloping with a wide diameter and forms
l.c
ai

a flattened shield or dome.


tm
ho

2. Acid Lavas: These lavas are highly viscous with a high melting point. They are light coloured,
t@

of low density and have a high percentage of silica. They flow slowly and seldom travel far
sp

before solidifying. The resultant volcano is therefore steep-sided. The rapid cooling of lava
h.
es

in the vent obstructs the flow of the outpouring lava, resulting in loud explosions throwing
ur
ay

out many volcanic bombs or pyroclasts.


m

Note: Pyroclasts are any volcanic fragment that was hurled through the air by volcanic activity.

3.3. Types of volcanoes


There is a wide variation in the mode of volcanic eruption and their periodicity. Accordingly the
volcanoes can be classified on the basis of the mode of eruption and their periodicity of
eruption.
Classification on the basis of mode of eruption: The volcanoes are classified into two groups on
the basis of their mode of eruption:
1. Violent or Explosive type: The eruption of violent or explosive type is so rapid that huge
quantities of volcanic materials are ejected thousands of metres in the sky. On falling, these
materials accumulate around the volcanic vent and form volcanic cones. Such volcanoes are
very destructive. They are generally associated with acidic lavas.
2. Effusive or Fissure type: The eruption of the fissure type of volcanoes-occurs along a long
fracture, fault or fissure. Magma ejects slowly and the resultant lava spreads on the surface.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


57 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

The speed of the lava flow depends on the nature and volume of magma, slope of the
ground and the temperature conditions.
Classification on the basis of periodicity of eruption: The volcanoes are divided into three
types on the basis of the periodicity of their eruption:
1. Active Volcanoes: Volcanoes are said to be active when they frequently erupt or at least
when they have erupted within recent time. Etna and Stromboli are typical examples.
2. Dormant Volcanoes: Volcanoes that have been known to erupt and show signs of possible
eruption in future are described as dormant. Mt. Vesuvius is the best example.
3. Extinct Volcanoes: Volcanoes that have not erupted at all in historic times but retain the
features of volcanoes are termed extinct. Ship rock in Netherlands is one such example.
All volcanoes pass through active, dormant and extinct stages but it is impossible to be
thoroughly sure when a volcano has become extinct.

3.4. Volcanic Landforms


Various landforms are created due to the cooling and solidification of magma (below the Earth's
surface) and lava (on the Earth's surface). Some relief features are formed due to the
accumulation of volcanic materials. The volcanic landforms are grouped into two broad
categories: Extrusive landforms and Intrusive landforms.
3.4.1. Extrusive Landforms
Extrusive landforms are determined by the nature and composition of the lava. Major extrusive
landforms are as under:
1. Cinder or ash cones are formed due to the accumulation of loose particles around the vent.
Its size increases due to the continuous accumulation of volcanic material minus lava. The
larger particles are arranged near the crater and the finer particles are deposited at the
outer margins of the cone. The lava flows are so viscous that they solidify after a short
distance.
om
l.c

2. Composite cones are the highest and are formed by the accumulation of various layers of
ai

volcanic material. They have alternate layers of lava and fragmented material, wherein lava
tm
ho

acts as the cementing material. These are mainly associated with cooler and more viscous
t@

lava and the volcanoes associated with them are called composite volcanoes.
sp
h.

3. Shield Volcanoes are built almost entirely of fluid lava flows. They are named for their large
es

size and low profile, resembling a warrior's shield lying on the ground. Barring the basalt
ur
ay

flows, the shield volcanoes are the largest of all the volcanoes on the earth. These
m

volcanoes are mostly made up of basalt, a type of lava that is very fluid when erupted. For
this reason, these volcanoes are not steep.
4. Craters are depressions formed at the mouth of the volcanic vent, which is usually funnel-
shaped. Some volcanoes may have greatly enlarged depressions called calderas. These are
the result of violent eruptions accompanied by the subsidence of much of the volcano into
the magma beneath. Water may collect in the crater or the caldera forming crater or
caldera lakes.
5. Flood Basalt Provinces are formed when volcanoes outpour highly fluid lava that flows for
long distances. Some parts of the world are covered by thousands of sq. km of thick basalt
lava flows. There can be a series of flows with some flows attaining thickness of more than
50 m. Individual flows may extend for hundreds of km. The Deccan Traps from India,
presently covering most of the Maharashtra plateau, are a much larger flood basalt
province.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


58 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Figure 7: Volcanoes based on extrusive landforms


3.4.2. Intrusive Landforms
The lava that cools within the crustal portion assumes different forms called intrusive forms.
Some of these forms are:
om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

Figure 8: Various intrusive landforms formed in volcanic regions


1. Batholiths are long, irregular, undulating and dome-shaped features. They are a large body
of magmatic material that cools in the deeper depth of the crust and develops in the form
of large domes. They appear on the surface only after the denudational processes remove
the overlying materials. They cover large areas, and at times, assume depth that may be
several km. These are granitic bodies. Batholiths are the cooled portion of magma
chambers.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


59 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

2. Laccoliths are formed due to the intrusion of magma along the bedding planes of horizontal
sedimentary rocks. They are usually mushroom or dome shaped.
3. Phacoliths are formed due to the intrusion of acidic magma along the anticlines and
synclines in the region of fold mountains.
4. Lapoliths are formed when magma solidifies in shallow basins into a saucer shape.
5. Sills and Sheets are intrusive igneous rocks usually parallel to the bedding planes of
sedimentary rocks. Depending on the thickness of deposits, thinner ones are called sheets
while thick horizontal deposits are called sills.
6. Dykes are wall-like formation of solidified magma. These are vertical to the bed of
sedimentary rocks. The thickness ranges from a few centimetres to several hundred metres,
but the length can be several kilometres.

3.5. Distribution of Volcanoes


The volcanoes are mostly associated with the weaker zones of the Earth's crust which are also
zones of seismic activities like the earthquakes. The weaker zones are mostly found in the areas
of fold mountains. They are also associated with the meeting zones of oceans and continents,
or with the mountain building activity.
Most of the world's active volcanoes are associated with the plate boundaries. About 15 per
cent of the volcanoes are associated with the divergent plate boundaries and about 80 per cent
with the convergent plate boundaries. Some volcanoes are also found in the intra-plate regions.
The main volcanic belts are as under:
1. Circum-Pacific Belt: It includes the volcanoes of the eastern and western coastal areas of
the Pacific Ocean. This belt is also known as the Ring of Fire of the Pacific Ocean.
It begins from Erebus mountains of Antarctica and runs northwards through Andes of South
America and Rockies of North America to reach Alaska. From there, it turns eastwards along
the coast of Asia to include the volcanoes of Sakhalin and Kamchatka, Japan and Philippines
om

respectively. This belt finally merges with the Mid-continental Belt in Indonesia.
l.c
ai

Most of the high volcanic cones and volcanic mountains are found in the Circum-Pacific
tm
ho

Belt. Cotopaxi in Andes (5896 m) is the highest volcanic mountain in the world. The other
t@

famous volcanoes are Fujiyama (Japan), Shasta, Rainier, Mt St Helena (USA).


sp
h.

2. Mid-Continental Belt: It includes the volcanoes of the Alpine mountains and the
es
ur

Mediterranean Sea. The volcanic eruptions are caused due to the convergence and collision
ay
m

of the Eurasian Plates and the African and Indian Plates. Some of the famous volcanoes of
the Mediterranean Sea such as the Stromboli, Vesuvius, Etna, etc., are in this belt. This belt
is not continuous and has several volcanic free zones such as the Alps and the Himalayas.
The important volcanoes in the fault zone of eastern Africa are Kilimanjaro, Meru, Elgon,
Rungwe, etc.
3. Mid-Atlantic Belt: It includes the volcanoes along the mid-Atlantic ridge which is the
divergent plate zone. They are mainly of the fissure eruption type. Iceland, is the most
active volcanic area.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


60 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Figure 9: Distribution of volcanoes

3.6. Effects of volcanic eruptions


Volcanic eruption causes heavy damage to human life and property. Some of them are as
under:
• Large volumes of hot lava moving at a fast speed can bury man-made buildings, kill people
and animals, destroy agricultural farms and pastures, burn and destroy forests.
• The fall out of large quantities of fragmented materials, dust, ash, smoke, etc., creates
om

health hazards due to poisonous gases emitted during eruption. It also causes acid rain.
l.c

• If the explosive eruption has occurred suddenly, the human beings get no time to escape to
ai
tm

safer places. Heavy rains mixed with volcanic dust and ash cause enormous mud-flow on
ho
t@

the steep slopes of the cones.


sp

• Earthquakes caused due to explosive eruptions can generate destructive tsunamis, seismic
h.
es

waves, etc. These can cause loss of life and property in the affected coastal regions.
ur

• The volcanic eruptions can change the heat balance of the Earth and the atmosphere,
ay
m

causing climatic changes.


But there are many positive effects also. Some of them are:
• Lava can give rise to fertile soils. Most of the precious stones are formed due to volcanic
activity.
• Geysers and springs are tourist attraction and are also important from the medical point of
view due to the chemicals dissolved in them.
• Some crater lakes are source of rivers and often offer scenic attraction for tourists.
• Most of the volcanic rocks when exposed on the surface are a storehouse of metals and
minerals.

3.7. Geysers
Geysers are fountains of hot water and superheated steam that may spout up to a height of 150
feet from the earth beneath. The phenomena are associated with a thermal or volcanic region
in which the water below is being heated beyond boiling point. The jet of water is usually
emitted with an explosion, and is often triggered by gases seeping out of the heated rocks.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


61 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Almost all the world’s geysers are confined to three major areas: Iceland, New Zealand and
Yellowstone park of U.S.A.

3.8. Hot Springs


Hot springs or thermal springs are more common, and may be found in any part of the earth
where water sinks deep enough beneath the surface to be heated by the interior forces. The
water rises to the surface without any explosion. Such springs contain dissolved minerals which
have medical value.
Iceland has thousands of hot springs. Hot springs are common in many parts of India, especially
in the hilly and mountainous parts. Some of them are in Manikaran (Kulu), Tattapani (Shimla),
Jwalamukhi (Kangra), Rajgir (Patna), Sitakund (Munger) and in Yamunotri and Gangotri.

3.9. Fumaroles
A fumarole is a vent in the Earth's surface which emits gases and water vapour. Sometimes the
emission is continuous, but in majority of cases emission occurs after intervals. It is widely
believed that gases and water vapour are generated due to cooling and contraction of magma
after the eruption. Fumaroles are the last signs of the activeness of a volcano.

om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

Copyright © by Vision IAS


All rights are reserved. No part of this document may be reproduced, stored in a retrieval system or
transmitted in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording or
otherwise, without prior permission of Vision IAS.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


62 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

MOUNTAIN BUILDING ISLAND FORMATIONS


AND HOTSPOTS
Contents
1. Mountains ................................................................................................................................ 64

1.1. Types of Mountains ........................................................................................................... 64

1.1.1. Fold Mountains .......................................................................................................... 64

1.1.2. Block Mountains......................................................................................................... 66

1.1.3. Volcanic Mountains .................................................................................................... 66

1.1.4. Residual Mountains.................................................................................................... 67

2. Islands ...................................................................................................................................... 67

2.1. Continental Islands ............................................................................................................ 67

2.2. Oceanic Islands.................................................................................................................. 68

3. Hotspots ................................................................................................................................... 70
om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

Copyright © by Vision IAS


All rights are reserved. No part of this document may be reproduced, stored in a retrieval system or
transmitted in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording or
otherwise, without prior permission of Vision IAS.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


63 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

1. Mountains
Since the dawn of geological time, no less than nine orogenic or mountain building movements
have taken place, folding and fracturing the earth's crust. Some of them occurred in Pre-
Cambrian times about 600-3,500 million years ago. The three more recent orogenies are the
Caledonian, Hercynian and Alpine. The Caledonian about 320million years ago raised the
mountains of Scandinavia and Scotland, and is represented in North America. These ancient
mountains have been worn down and no longer exhibit the striking forms that they must once
have had.
In a later period, during the Hercynian earth movements, about 240 million years ago, were
formed such ranges as the Ural Mountains, the Pennines and Welsh Highlands in Britain, the
Harz Mountains in Germany and the Appalachians in America. These mountains have also been
reduced in size by the various sculpturing forces.
The last of the major orogenic movements of the earth, the Alpine, occurred about 30 million
years ago. Young fold mountain ranges were formed on a gigantic scale. Being the most recently
formed, these ranges, such as the Alps, Himalayas, Andes and Rockies are the loftiest and the
most imposing. Their peaks are sometimes several miles high.

1.1. Types of Mountains


Based on their mode of formation, four main types of mountains can be distinguished:
1.1.1. Fold Mountains
These mountains are the most widespread and also the most important. They are caused by
large-scale earth movements, when stresses are set up in the earth's crust. Such stresses may
be due to:
• the increased load of the overlying rocks,
• flow movements in the mantle,
om


l.c

magmatic intrusions into the crust, or


ai

• the expansion or contraction of some part of the earth.


tm
ho

When such stresses are initiated, the rocks are subjected to compressive forces that produce
t@
sp

wrinkling or folding along the lines of weakness. As illustrated in Fig.1 and 2, folding effectively
h.

shortens the earth's crust, creating from the original level surface a series of 'waves'.
es
ur
ay
m

Fig.1 Earth’s crust before folding Fig.2 Earth’s crust after folding
The upfolded waves are called anticlines and the troughs or downfolds are called synclines.
Due to the complexity of the compressional forces, thefolds may develop much more
complicated forms. When the crest of a fold is pushed too far, an overfold is formed (Fig.3). If it
is pushed still further, it becomes a recumbent fold. In extreme cases, fractures may occur in the

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


64 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

crust, so that the upper part of the recumbent fold slides forward over the lower part along a
thrust plane forming an over thrust fold. The over-riding portion of the thrust fold is termed a
nappe.

Fig. 3 Types of Folding


Since the rock strata have been elevated to great heights, sometimes measurable in miles, fold
mountains maybe called mountains of elevation. The fold mountains are also closely associated
with volcanic activity. They contain many active volcanoes, especially in the Circum-Pacific fold
mountain system. They also contain rich mineral resources such as tin, copper, gold and
petroleum.
Characteristics
• Fold mountains are the youngest mountains on the surface of the Earth.
• Young folded mountains represent the highest mountains on the earth. They also have the
highest mountain summits. Mt. Everest is the most typical example (8848m).
• Fold mountains have been formed due to the folding of sedimentary rocks formed due to
the deposition and consolidation of sediments in water bodies mainly in the oceanic
om

environment.
l.c

• The sedimentary rocks of the fold mountains were deposited in shallow seas. The greater
ai
tm

thickness of sediments is possible due to the continuous sedimentation and subsidence.


ho

• The length of the fold mountains is much more than their width. The east-west extent of
t@

the Himalayas is about 2400 km, but their north-south width is only 400 km. Thus the fold
sp
h.

mountains must have been formed in long, narrow and shallow seas.
es


ur

Fold mountains are generally arc-shaped, having a concave slope on one side and convex
ay

on the other.
m

• Fold mountains are found along the margins of the continents facing ocean such as the
Andes and the Rockies. If we consider the former Tethys Sea, then the Himalayas are also
located along the margins of the continent.
• Fold mountains are mostly located in two directions. In the north-south direction lie the
Rockies and the Andes, while in the west-east direction lie the Himalayas and the Alps.
Human activity surrounding fold mountains
• Winter sports such as skiing in resorts.
• Climbing and hiking in the summer months.
• Agriculture - takes place mainly on south facing slopes and includes cereals, sugar beet,
vines and fruits.
• Forestry - coniferous forests for fuel and building.
• Communications - roads and railways follow valleys.
• Hydroelectric power (HEP) - steep slopes and glacial melt water are ideal for generating
HEP. Hydroelectric accounts for 60 per cent of Switzerland's electricity production.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


65 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

1.1.2. Block Mountains


When the earth's crust bends, folding occurs, but when it cracks, faulting takes place. Faulting
may be caused by tension or compression, forces which lengthen or shorten the earth's crust,
causing a section of it to subside or to rise above the surrounding level.
Earth movements generate tensional forces that tend to pull the crust apart (fig. 4), and faults
are developed. If the block enclosed by the faults remains as it is or rises, and the land on either
side subsides, the upstanding block becomes the horst or block mountain. The faulted edges
are very steep, with scarp slopes and the summit is almost level, e.g. the Hunsruck Mountains,
the Vosges and Black Forest of the Rhineland.
Tension may also cause the central portion to be let down between two adjacent fault blocks
forming a graben or rift valley, which will have steep walls. The East African Rift Valley system is
3,000 miles long, stretching from East Africa through the Red Sea to Syria.
Compressional forces set up by earth movements may produce a thrust or reverse fault and
shorten the crust. A block may be raised or lowered in relation to surrounding areas. Fig.5
illustrates a rift valley formed in this way. In general large-scale block mountains and rift valleys
are due to tension rather than compression.

om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

Fig. 4 Block Mountains formed by tensional forces Fig.5 Rift Valley formed by compressive forces

1.1.3. Volcanic Mountains


These are built up from material ejected from fissures in the earth's crust. The materials include
molten lava, volcanic bombs, cinders, ashes, dust and liquid mud. They fall around the vent in
successive layers, building up a characteristic volcanic cone (Fig. 6). Volcanic mountains are
often called mountains of accumulation. They are common in the Circum-Pacific belt and
include such volcanic peaks as Mt. Fuji (Japan), Mt. Mayon (Philippines), Mt. Merapi (Sumatra),
Mt. Agung (Bali) and Mt. Catopaxi (Ecuador).

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


66 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Fig. 6 Volcanic Mountains


1.1.4. Residual Mountains
These are mountains evolved by denudation. Where the general level of the land has been
lowered by the agents of denudation some very resistant areas may remain and these form
residual mountains, e.g. Mt. Manodnock in U.S.A. Residual mountains may also evolve from
plateaux which have been dissected by rivers into hills and valleys like. In these type of
mountains, the ridges and peaks are all very similar in height.
om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es

Fig. 7 Residual Mountains


ur
ay

2. Islands
m

An island is a piece of land surrounded on all sides by water. It may occur individually or in a
group, in open oceans or seas. Smaller ones of only local significance are found even in lakes
and rivers. Generally speaking all islands may be grouped, based on their mode of formation,
under the following two broad types.

2.1. Continental Islands


These islands were formerly part of the mainland and are now detached from the continent.
They may be separated by a shallow lagoon or a deep channel. Their separation could be due to
subsidence of some part of the land or to arise in sea level, so that the lowland links are
submerged by the sea.
Their former connection with the neighbouring mainland can be traced from the similar
physical structure, flora and fauna that exist on both sides of the channel. In the course of time,
modification by men and other natural forces may give rise to different surface features.
Continental islands can be further classified as under:

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


67 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

1. Individual Islands: These lie just outside the continent, very much associated with the
characteristic features of the mainland of which they were once part. Some of the
outstanding examples are New foundland, separated from the mainland by the Strait of
Belle Isle; Madagascar, by the Mozambique Channel.
2. Archipelagoes or island groups: These comprise groups of islands of varying sizes and
shapes, e.g. the British Isles, the Balearic Islands of the Mediterranean and also those of the
Aegean Sea.
3. Festoons or island arcs: The islands form an archipelago in the shape of a loop around the
edge or the mainland, marking the continuation of mountain ranges which can be traced on
the continent. Most of these island arcs are formed as one oceanic tectonic
plate subducts another one and, in most cases, produces magma at a depth below the
overriding plate, e.g. Andaman and Nicobar Islands, the East Indies, the Aleutian Islands,
RyukyuIs lands, Kurile Islands and other island arcs of the Pacific coasts.

2.2. Oceanic Islands


These islands are normally small and are located in the midst of oceans. They have no
connection with the mainland which may be hundreds or thousands of miles away. They have a
flora and fauna unrelated to those of the continents. Due to their remoteness from the major
trading centres of the world, most of the oceanic islands are very sparsely populated. Some of
them provide useful stops for aeroplanes and ocean steamers that ply between continents
across vast stretches of water.
Oceanic Islands can be further classified as under:
1. Volcanic islands: Many of the islands in the oceans are in fact the topmost parts of the
cones of volcanoes that rise from the ocean bed. Most of them are extinct, but there are
also some active ones. The best known volcanic peak of the Pacific Ocean is Mauna Loa in
Hawaii Other volcanic islands have emerged from the submarine ridges of the oceans.
The volcanic islands are scattered in most of the earth's oceans.
om

• In the Pacific Ocean, they occur in several groups such as Hawaii, the Galapagos Islands
l.c
ai

(Ecuador) and the South Sea islands.


tm

• In the Atlantic are the Azores (Portugal), Ascension, St. Helena1, Madeira (Portugal) and
ho
t@

the Canary Islands (Spain).


sp

• In the Indian Ocean, there are Mauritius and Reunion (French Island in Indian Ocean).
h.
es

• In the Antarctic Ocean are the South Sandwich Islands and Bouvet Island.
ur
ay

2. Coral islands: Unlike the volcanic islands, the coral islands are very much lower and emerge
m

just above the water surface. These islands, built up by coral animals of various species, are
found both near the shores of the mainland and in the midst of oceans. Coral islands
include:
• Marshall Islands, Gilbert (Kiribati) and Tuvalu (formerly Ellice Islands) of the Pacific.
• Bermuda (British Overseas Territory) in the Atlantic.
Laccadives and Maldives of the Indian Ocean.

1
Saint Helena, Ascension and Tristan da Cunha is a British Overseas Territory in the southern Atlantic
Ocean consisting of the island of Saint Helena, Ascension Island and the island group called Tristan da
Cunha.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


68 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Artificial Island
An artificial island is a man-made island, created by expanding existing islets, building on
existing reefs or making them from scratch, off the coastline. Man has been building such
islands for hundreds of years. The Flevopolder in the Netherlands is the largest artificial island
in the world.
In News (The Hindu June 2012): Israeli politicians are floating an idea to expand their seaside
country — artificial islands.
Palm Islands
The Palm Islands are two artificial islands in Dubai, United Arab Emirates in the shape of palm
trees. The islands are the Palm Jumeirah and the Palm Jebel Ali.

Climate change has hit islands hard with some in danger of disappearing completely as sea
levels rise. The world’s first underwater cabinet meeting organised by the Maldivian president
on 17 October 2009 was a symbolic cry for help over rising sea levels that threaten the tropical
archipelago’s existence

om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

Fig: Palm Islands


Importance of Islands
• Earth’s 175,000 islands are home to more than 600 million inhabitants
• Islands and their oceans represent one-sixth of earth’s total area
• Islands support many of the most unique and isolated natural systems including:
o more than half the world’s marine biodiversity
o 7 of the world’s 10 coral reef hotspots
o 10 of the 34 richest areas of biodiversity in the world
• 64% of recorded extinctions are on islands
• Over two-thirds of the world’s countries include islands.
• Island ecosystems provide food, fresh water, wood, fibre, medicines, fuel, tools and other
important raw materials, in addition to aesthetic, spiritual, educational and recreational
values. In fact, the livelihood and economic stability of the islands depend on its
biodiversity.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


69 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

3. Hotspots2
A hot spot is a very hot region deep within the Earth. It is usually responsible
for volcanic activity. They may be unanimously hot, and provide a great deal of molten magma.
Hot spots do not always create volcanoes that spew rivers of lava. Sometimes, the magma heats
up groundwater under the Earth’s surface, which causes water and steam to erupt like a
volcano. These eruptions are called geysers.
There are 40 to 50 hot spots around the world, including near the Galapagos Islands (Ecuador)
and Iceland. Hot spots can create entire chains of islands, like the U.S. state of Hawaii. Hawaii is
on the Pacific plate, an enormous section of the Earth in the Pacific Ocean that is constantly
moving, but very, very slowly. Although the plate is always moving, the hot spot underneath it
stays still. The hot spot spewed magma that eventually became a chain of islands that rose over
the surface of the water. These islands were created one right after the other as the plate
moved, almost like an island factory.
Scientists use hot spots to track the movement of the Earth’s plates.

om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

2
Biodiversity hotspot, a region of significant biodiversity is different thing.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


70 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

ROCKS AND MINERALS


Contents
1. Introduction ............................................................................................................................. 72

2. Minerals ................................................................................................................................... 72

2.1. Some Major Minerals and Their Characteristics ............................................................... 72

3. Rocks ........................................................................................................................................ 73

3.1. Major Types of Rocks ........................................................................................................ 73

3.1.1. Igneous Rocks ............................................................................................................. 73

3.1.2. Sedimentary Rocks ..................................................................................................... 74

3.1.3. Metamorphic Rocks ................................................................................................... 75

4. Rock Cycle................................................................................................................................. 76
l.c
om
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


71 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

1. Introduction
Rocks and minerals make up the Earth’s crust. Crust or the lithosphere is the thin outermost
layer of the Earth.
The hard resistant materials of the crust are called rocks. But in scientific terms, rocks include
not only the hard materials such as granite, sandstone and marble, but also soft and loose
materials such as chalk, clay, sand, salt and coal.

2. Minerals
Minerals are those substances which occur naturally in rocks. These are non-living solid
substances which have a definite chemical composition.
Minerals are often classified as metallic and non metallic. The surface of the metallic minerals is
generally slippe and glossy. Gold, copper and lead are metallic minerals. They are melted to
obtain metals. The surface of the non metallic minerals is dull. They cannot reflect the sun-rays.
Gypsum, quartz and mica are non-metallic minerals. Metals cannot be obtained from these
minerals.
Rocks and minerals account for about 99 per cent of the materials found in the outer layer of
the lithosphere. Some rocks have useful minerals, which provide us with metals and chemicals.
Out of about 2000 different minerals, only 12 are known as the rock-forming minerals. Oxygen
and silicon account for about 75 per cent of the Earth’s crust by weight. These elements are
essential for plant and animal life on the Earth.

PHYSICAL CHARACTERISTICS OF MINERALS: Minerals have distinct physical properties that can
be used to correctly identify a mineral. These are
• Crystal structure: arrangement of atoms inside mineral
• Hardness: on the Mohs scale, a ten-point scale running from the softest, talc to the
om
l.c

hardest, diamond.
ai

• Lustre: appearance in light


tm
ho

• Colour
t@

• Streak: colour of a mineral when it has been ground to a fine powder. Often tested by
sp
h.

rubbing the specimen on an unglazed plate.


es

• Cleavage: how mineral splits along various planes


ur
ay

• Fracture: how it breaks against its natural cleavage planes


m

• Specific gravity: density compared with water

2.1. Some Major Minerals and Their Characteristics


Minerals Composition Importance Other facts
Feldspar Common fieldspar silicon Used in ceramics and Half of the
and oxygen. Specificglass making earth’s crust is
fieldspar sodium, potassium, composed of
calcium, aluminium . feldspar
Quartz Consists of silica. Prominent components Hard mineral
of Sand and Granite and virtually insoluble
used in Radio and Radar in water.
Pyroxene Pyroxene consists of commonly found in Pyroxene forms
calcium, aluminum, meteorites 10 per cent of the
magnesium, iron and silica. earth’s crust.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


72 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Amphibole Aluminum, calcium, silica, used in asbestos industry They form 7 per
iron, magnesium are the Hornblende is another cent of the
major elements of form of amphiboles earth’s crust
amphiboles.
Mica It comprises of potassium, used in electrical It forms 4 percent of
aluminium, magnesium, instruments the earth's crust.
iron, silica etc It is commonly found
igneous and
metamorphic rocks.
Olivine Magnesium, iron and silica Used in jewellery Found in basaltic
are major elements of rocks.
olivine.

3. Rocks
Rocks are generally a mixture of two or more minerals and do not possess a definite chemical
composition.

3.1. Major Types of Rocks


On the basis of their mode of formation, rocks can be classified into the following three types:
1. Igneous rocks
2. Sedimentary rocks
3. Metamorphic rocks
3.1.1. Igneous Rocks
The word igneous is derived from the Latin word ‘ignis’ meaning fire. These rocks are of thermal
origin and are associated with volcanic eruptions. These rocks have been formed due to
solidification of hot and molten material called magma.
om
l.c

It is believed that at the time of its birth the Earth was in a molten state. The igneous rocks
ai

were the first to be formed as a result of the solidification of the outer layer of the Earth. Thus,
tm
ho

igneous rocks are also known as the primary rocks. They can be divided into two types—
t@

intrusive1 igneous rocks and extrusive igneous rocks.


sp
h.

Igneous rocks that cool below the surface of the Earth are called intrusive igneous rocks. The
es
ur

rate of cooling is slow inside the Earth. Thus the crystals formed on cooling are large. Two
ay
m

common examples of intrusive rocks are dolerite and granite.


Igneous rocks that cool on the surface of the Earth are called extrusive igneous rocks. These
rocks are also known as volcanic rocks. Due to rapid cooling, the crystals are fine grained such
as in basalt.
On the basis of their composition the igneous rocks are also classified as acidic Igneous Rocks
and Basic igneous rocks. In Acidic Igneous rocks silica content in rocks is more than 65 per
cent. These rocks are light colored and have less density. These are also known as ‘Silicic rocks’.
Granite and rhyolite are examples of these rocks. In Basic Igneous rocks the silica content is
less than 65 per cent. They are composed predominantly of ferromagnesian minerals (rich in
iron and magnesium). They are dark coloured and dense. Gabbro and basalt are basic rocks.

1
Igneous rock bodies will be discussed in chapter on volcanoes.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


73 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Characteristics of igneous rocks


• They are compact and massive and do not possess rounded particles.
• They do not occur in distinct beds or stratas.
• They are generally granular and crystalline.
• They are hard and impermeable.
• They are less affected by chemical weathering.
• They do not contain any fossils or traces of animals or plants.
• Most of the igneous rocks consist of silicate minerals.
• The valuable minerals such as iron, gold, silver, aluminium, etc., are found in them.
Economic Importance of Igneous Rocks
• They are a reservoir of minerals.
• Majority of metallic minerals are found in igneous rocks.
• Economically important minerals are found in these rocks-Magnetic iron, nickel, copper,
lead, zinc, chromite, manganese, tin.
• Rare minerals like gold, diamonds, platinum are also found in these rocks.
• Basalt and granite are used for construction of buildings and roads.
• The formation of black soils is probably the result of erosion of these rocks. These soils are
very much suited to cultivation of cotton and some other crops.
3.1.2. Sedimentary Rocks
The word sedimentary has been derived from the Latin word ‘sedimentum’, meaning settling
down.
Rain, wind, ice, running water, plants and animals constantly break the rocks into fragments of
all sizes. These broken rock materials are carried away by wind, ice and running water, and
deposited in the depressions. The deposited materials are called sediments, and they give rise
to sedimentary rocks.
om
l.c

The sediments are generally deposited in horizontal layers or stratas. Thus these rocks are also
ai
tm

referred to as stratified rocks. The loose materials are converted into hard and compact rocks
ho

such as shale and sandstone. This is due to the pressure exerted from the top or because of
t@
sp

cementation.
h.
es

The sedimentary rocks can be formed mechanically (sandstone), chemically (gypsum or salt) or
ur
ay

organically (coal, limestone). The sedimentary rocks are most widespread and cover about 75
m

per cent of the total land area on the earth.


Characteristics of sedimentary rocks
• They are comparatively softer than the igneous rocks.
• They are made up of minute particles of various shapes and sizes.
• They have layers horizontally arranged one above the other.
• They have been mostly formed under water.
• They have mud cracks and marks of ripples and waves.
• They have fossils between the layers.
• Most of them are permeable and porous.
• Of all the sedimentary deposits, coal and petroleum are the most important ones.
• Modern industries depend on the products from the sedimentary rocks.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


74 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Economic Importance of Sedimentary Rocks


• It is true that they contain lesser minerals than in the igneous rocks. But iron ore,
phosphates, building stones, coal, raw materials for cement and bauxite are obtained from
these.
• Mineral oil and Natural Gas is also obtained from sedimentary rocks. In India there is a
possibility of finding oil fields in the sedimentary rock strata of the sub-Himalayan zone, in
the delta regions of Ganga, Kaveri, Godavari and Krishna rivers, Rann of Kutch and the Gulf
of Khambhat. The mineral oil commonly known as petroleum is formed by the decay of tiny
marine organisms (in contrast Coal is formed from dead plant) between to impermeable
rocks.
• Sandstone, limestone are used in construction of buildings. The forts of Agra, Delhi and
Fatehpur Sikri are built of red sandstone
• Fertile Soils: The Indus and Ganga basins are also made of sedimentary rocks. Their alluvial
soils are highly fertile.
3.1.3. Metamorphic Rocks
The word metamorphic means ‘changed form’. The rocks, originating at or near the surface of
the Earth are sometimes subjected to tremendous heat and pressure. This can change the
original properties of rocks such as their colour, hardness, texture and mineral composition.
Such changed rocks are called metamorphic rocks. Both igneous and sedimentary rocks can
change into metamorphic rocks. The special feature about the origin and formation of
metamorphic rocks is that they remain in their original position and change under the impact of
internal and external forces. Metamorphism can be of thermal and dynamic origin.
1. In the case of thermal metamorphism, the original rocks are changed under the influence
of high temperature inside the Earth’s crust. For example, limestone is converted into
marble, sandstone into quartzite, shale into slate and coal into graphite.
2. In the case of dynamic metamorphism, the original rocks are changed under the influence
om

of pressure at great depths inside the Earth’s crust. For example, granite is converted into
l.c
ai

gneiss and shale into schist.


tm
ho

Characteristics of metamorphic rocks


t@
sp

• They are usually hard.


h.
es

• They have a high specific gravity.


ur

• They may be banded.


ay
m

• They do not have void spaces in them.


Parent Rock and its Metamorphic Changed Form
NAME OF THE ROCK TYPE OF ROCK NAME OF THE METAMORPHIC ROCK
Limestone Sedimentary Rock Marble
Dolomite Sedimentary Rock Marble
Sandstone Sedimentary Rock Quartzite
Shale Sedimentary Rock Slate
Slate Metamorphic Rock Phylite/Schist
Coal Sedimentary Rock Graphite/Diamond
Granite Igneous Rock Gneiss
Phyllite Metamorphic Rock Schist

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


75 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Economic Importance of Metamorphic Rocks


1. Building Construction Materials: Gneiss, quartzite, slate, marble are used as building
materials. In India marble is found in Alwar, Ajmer, Jodhpur and Jaipur districts of
Rajasthan. The thick sheet of slate is used for laying the surface of billiards table. Slate is
found in parts of Riwari (Haryana), Karigra (H.P) and Bihar.
2. Industrial Uses: Graphite is used for making pencils. Its melting point is 3500°C. Therefore
pots for melting of metals are made of graphite. Graphite is indispensible for atomic energy
power house Quartzite, one of the hardest rocks, used in glass making.
3. Beauty Aids: Steatite is used for making talcum powder and other such beauty aids.
4. Asbestos is fire resistant.
5. Garnet: It is a precious stone. It is used for making abrasives.

4. Rock Cycle
Rock cycle is the intimate relationship and mutual interdependence between the three types of
rocks—igneous, sedimentary and metamorphic. The change of one type of rock into another
type under different conditions is known as the rock cycle.
In the cycle of rock change, the materials of the lithosphere are constantly being formed and
transformed in both their physical and mineral composition. The rock cycle has neither a
beginning nor an end.
There are two environments for the working of a rock cycle, such as:
(a) a surface environment of low temperature and pressure
(b) a deep environment of high temperature and pressure.
At the surface of the Earth, the igneous rocks are exposed to the agents of weathering and
erosion. They are then broken and deposited in basins or depressions. Here the sediments are
compressed and cemented into sedimentary rocks.
om

The leftover igneous rocks and the newly created sedimentary rocks are likely to change into
l.c

metamorphic rocks due to heat and pressure in course of time.


ai
tm
ho

The formation of sedimentary rock on the Earth’s surface and its conversion into metamorphic
t@

rock takes place within the crust of the Earth.


sp
h.

The sedimentary rocks may be buried again and may melt to form the igneous rocks.
es
ur
ay

In the rock cycle, the matter of the Earth’s crust is not lost. The cycle of rock change has been
m

active since our planet became a solid.


The loops in the cycle of rock change are powered by two main sources of energy such as:
• the heat inside the Earth, which can melt the existing rocks; and
• the solar energy responsible for weathering and erosion, and finally converting them into
sedimentary rocks.
Throughout the geological period of millions of years, the mineral matter of the Earth has been
changing due to the working of the rock cycle.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


76 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

Copyright © by Vision IAS


All rights are reserved. No part of this document may be reproduced, stored in a retrieval system or
transmitted in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording or
otherwise, without prior permission of Vision IAS.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


77 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

LANDFORMS AND THEIR EVOLUTION


Contents
1. Introduction ............................................................................................................................. 80
2. Landform and Landscape ......................................................................................................... 80
3. Causes ...................................................................................................................................... 80
4. Landforms and Scale: Crustal Orders of Relief ......................................................................... 80
5. Evolution of Landform .............................................................................................................. 80
6. Landform Classification ............................................................................................................ 81
7. Fluvial Landforms (Latin: Fluvius=River)................................................................................... 81
7.1. Action of a River/Stream ................................................................................................... 81
7.1.1. Erosion ....................................................................................................................... 82
7.1.2. Transportation ............................................................................................................ 82
7.1.3. Deposition .................................................................................................................. 83
7.2. River rejuvenation ............................................................................................................. 88
7.2.1. Knick point.................................................................................................................. 89
7.2.2. River Terrace............................................................................................................... 89
7.2.3. Incised or Entrenched Meanders ............................................................................... 90
7.3. Significance of work of River ............................................................................................. 90
7.4. Features of Overview ........................................................................................................ 91
7.4.1. Erosional Landforms................................................................................................... 91
7.4.2. Depositional Landforms ............................................................................................. 91
7.4.3. Erosional and Depositional Landforms ...................................................................... 91
8. Coastal landforms..................................................................................................................... 91
8.1. Coastal processes: Tides, Current and Waves ................................................................... 91
8.1.1. Sea Waves mechanism ............................................................................................... 92
8.2. Coastal erosion .................................................................................................................. 92
om

8.3. Erosional Features ............................................................................................................. 92


l.c
ai

8.3.1. Cliffs and wave-cut-platforms .................................................................................... 92


tm

8.3.2. Capes and bays ........................................................................................................... 93


ho
t@

8.3.3. Cave, Arch and Stack .................................................................................................. 93


sp

8.3.4. Blow holes and Geos .................................................................................................. 94


h.
es

8.4. Depositional Features ....................................................................................................... 94


ur

8.4.1. Wave-Built Platform or Terrace .................................................................................. 94


ay
m

8.4.2. Beaches ...................................................................................................................... 95


8.4.3. Bars, Spits and Tombolo ............................................................................................. 95
8.5. Types of Coasts.................................................................................................................. 96
8.6. Coastlines of submergence ............................................................................................... 96
8.7. Coastlines of Emergence ................................................................................................... 96
9. Glacial Landforms ..................................................................................................................... 97
9.1. Action of Glacier................................................................................................................ 97
9.2. The landforms created by glacial erosion ......................................................................... 98
9.1.1. Cirque (or Corrie) ....................................................................................................... 98
9.1.2. Arete........................................................................................................................... 98
9.1.3. Pyramidal Peaks ......................................................................................................... 98
9.1.4. Tarn............................................................................................................................. 98
9.1.5. Bergschrund ............................................................................................................... 98
9.1.6. ‘U’ - shaped Valley ...................................................................................................... 99
9.1.7. Hanging Valley ............................................................................................................ 99
9.1.8. Truncated spurs .......................................................................................................... 99

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


78 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

9.1.9. Paternoster lakes ........................................................................................................ 99


9.1.10. Roche Moutonnee.................................................................................................. 100
9.2. Glacial landforms resulting from deposition................................................................... 100
9.2.1. Boulder clay or glacial till ......................................................................................... 100
9.2.2. Outwash deposits..................................................................................................... 100
9.2.3. Erratics...................................................................................................................... 100
9.2.4. Moraines .................................................................................................................. 100
9.2.5. Outwash plain and Kettles ....................................................................................... 101
9.2.6. Kames ....................................................................................................................... 101
9.2.7. Eskers ....................................................................................................................... 101
9.2.8. Drumlins ................................................................................................................... 101
10. Landform by the Action of Wind .......................................................................................... 102
10.1. Mechanism of wind Action in deserts........................................................................... 102
10.2. Erosional Landforms-Wind ............................................................................................ 103
10.2.1. Ventifacts or Dreikanter ......................................................................................... 103
10.2.2. Ventifact ................................................................................................................. 103
10.2.3. Rock Pedestals or Mushroom Rocks ...................................................................... 103
10.2.4. Yardangs ................................................................................................................. 104
10.2.5. Zeugens .................................................................................................................. 104
10.2.6. Mesas and Buttes ................................................................................................... 104
10.2.7. Inselbergs ............................................................................................................... 104
10.3. Depositional Landforms-wind ....................................................................................... 104
10.3.1. Loess....................................................................................................................... 105
10.4. Fluvial Desert Landforms .............................................................................................. 105
10.4.1. Wadis...................................................................................................................... 106
10.4.2. Pediments .............................................................................................................. 106
10.4.3. Bahada (Bajada) ..................................................................................................... 106
10.4.4. Playas...................................................................................................................... 106
om

11. Karst Topography .................................................................................................................. 106


l.c

11.1. Erosional landform ........................................................................................................ 107


ai
tm

11.1.1. Sink Holes, Swallow Holes, Dolines and Uvalas/valley sink ................................... 107
ho
t@

11.1.2. Lapies ..................................................................................................................... 107


sp

11.1.3. Caves ...................................................................................................................... 107


h.
es

11.2. Depositional Landforms ................................................................................................ 108


ur

11.2.1. Stalactites and Stalagmites .................................................................................... 108


ay
m

12. Economic significance of karst regions ................................................................................ 108

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


79 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

1. Introduction
The surface of the earth is very uneven and never perfectly flat. It has highlands and lowlands;
slopes of varying types -steep, gentle, long and gradual and some very abrupt features. There
are depressions and cracks of different shapes and sizes. There are also large areas of almost
flat land. Some are rocky, some sandy while the others are covered with soil and vegetation.
These different land features that form a part of the larger landscapes (large tracts of the
earth’s surface) are known as landforms. Each landform has a typical physical shape, size and
material make up.

2. Landform and Landscape


A landscape is the general shape of the land surface. Each landscape has its own geologic
structure and topographic relief. Topographic relief is the change of elevation between the
highest and the lowest places. Landscapes include a variety of topographic features related to
the processes that shaped the land surface. A landform is a single feature of a landscape such
as mountain, valley or a river system. Hence, several related landforms together make up
landscapes.

Topography refers to the elevation and relief of the Earth’s surface.


Landforms are the topographic features on the Earth’s surface.
Geomorphology is the study of earth surface processes and landforms.

3. Causes
The landforms on the Earth’s surface have been created and developed by two types of
forces—the tectonic forces and the gradational forces(weathering etc.). The tectonic forces
originate from within the Earth and create irregularities on the surface of the Earth. The
om

gradational forces originate from outside the Earth and work to modify and smoothen the
l.c

irregularities created by the tectonic forces. The work of these two types of forces develops the
ai
tm

relief features or landforms on the surface of the Earth. (Read more from Geomorphic
ho

Processes Notes).
t@
sp

4. Landforms and Scale: Crustal Orders of Relief


h.
es
ur

To make a systematic study of the landforms, the geographers have divided the landscape into
ay
m

three orders of relief.


1. The first order of relief includes the continental platforms and the ocean basins. The
continental platform is the land above the sea level and the ocean basins are the land
below the sea level.
2. The second order of relief includes the mountains, plateaus and plains. In the ocean basins,
it includes the continental shelves, continental slopes, abyssal plains, mid-oceanic ridges,
submarine canyons and trenches.
3. The third order of relief includes the mountain peaks, cliffs, hills, spurs, sand dunes, valleys,
gorges, caves, beaches, etc.

5. Evolution of Landform
Every landform has a beginning. Landforms once formed may change in their shape, size and
nature slowly or fast due to continued action of geomorphic processes and agents.
Due to changes in climatic conditions and vertical or horizontal movements of land- masses,
either the intensity of processes or the processes themselves might change leading to new

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


80 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

modifications in the landforms. Evolution here implies stages of transformation of either a part
of the earth’s surface from one landform into another or transformation of individual landforms
after they are once formed. That means, each and every landform has a history of
development and changes through time. A landmass passes through stages of development
somewhat comparable to the stages of life — youth, mature and old age.
The evolutionary history of the continually changing surface of the earth is essential to be
understood in order to use it effectively without disturbing its balance and diminishing its
potential for the future. Geomorphology deals with the reconstruction of the history of the
surface of the earth through a study of its forms, the materials of which it is made up of and the
processes that shape it.

6. Landform Classification1
The genetic landform classification system groups landforms by the dominant set of
geomorphic processes responsible for their formation. This includes the following processes
and associated landforms:
1. Tectonic Landforms
2. Extrusive Igneous Landforms
3. Intrusive Igneous Landforms
4. Fluvial Landforms
5. Karst Landforms
6. Aeolian Landforms
7. Coastal Landforms
8. Ocean Floor Topography
9. Glacial Landforms
Within each of these, the resulting landforms are a product of either constructive and
destructive processes or a combination of both. Landforms are also influenced by other agents
om

or processes including time, climate, and human activity.


l.c

7. Fluvial Landforms (Latin: Fluvius=River)


ai
tm
ho
t@

In humid regions, which receive heavy rainfall running water is considered the most important
sp

of the geomorphic agents in bringing about the degradation of the land. The landforms either
h.
es

carved out (due to erosion) or built up (due to deposition) by running water are called Fluvial
ur

Landforms (both erosional and depositional) and the running waters which shape them are
ay
m

called fluvial process.


Fluvial processes involve both the overland flow of water down the slope, and stream flow in
which water moves in a channel along a valley bottom.

7.1. Action of a River/Stream


The work of a stream includes erosion, transportation and deposition. These activities go on
simultaneously in all stream channels.

1
Notes 1: We will discuss only important Landforms here. 2. Too many new terms are introduced in this chapter so do not try to
memorise all landforms in first go. 3. Observe the diagram before reading the description. 4. Some landforms are discussed in other
notes. 5. Landform are generally not asked in mains but could be asked due to changed syllabus. Moreover, understanding of
landforms is needed to understand Indian phyiography correctly. Understanding of Landform also assist us in International relations
(Geostrategy, Culture), Economic, Science and Tech. etc. 6. Notes are little bigger due to inclusion of more diagrams)

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


81 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

7.1.1. Erosion
It is the removal of rock or soil. Stream erosion takes place through four processes – hydraulic
action, abrasion, attrition and solution
• Solution or Corrosion- This is the chemical action of river water. The acids in the water
slowly dissolve the bed and the banks. This occurs in streams running through rocks such
as chalk and limestone.
• Abrasion or Corrasion- As the rock particles bounce, scrape and drag along the bottom and
sides of the river, they break off additional rock fragments. This form of erosion is called
corrasion. This is the mechanical grinding of the rivers against the banks and bed of the
river. The erosional mechanism of abrasion operation in two ways
(i) Lateral Corrasion: This is sideways erosion which widens the river valley.
(ii) Vertical Corrasion: This is the downward erosion which deepens the river valley.
• Attrition- is the mechanical tear and wear of the erosional tools in themselves. The
boulders, cobbles, pebbles etc. while moving with water collide against each other and thus
are fragmented into smaller and finer pieces in the transit.
• Hydraulic Action- involves the breakdown of the rocks of valley sides due to the impact of
water currents of channel. In fact, hydraulic action is the mechanical loosening and removal
of materials of rock by water alone. No load or material is involved in this process.

om
l.c

7.1.2. Transportation
ai
tm

River carries rock particles from one place to another. This activity is known as transportation of
ho
t@

load by a river. The load is transported in four ways.


sp


h.

Traction -The heavier and larger rock fragments like gravel, pebbles etc. are forced by the
es

flow of river to roll along its bed. These fragments can be seen rolling, slipping, bumping
ur
ay

and being dragged. This process is known as traction and the load is called traction load.
m

• Saltation-Some of the fragments of the rocks move along the bed of a stream by jumping
or bouncing continuously. This process is called saltation.
• Suspension-The holding-up of small particles like sand, silt and mud by the water as the
stream flows is called suspension.
• Solution-Some parts of rock fragments are dissolved in the river water and are thus
transported.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


82 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

7.1.3. Deposition
When the stream comes down from hills to plain area, its slope becomes gentle. This reduces
the energy of the stream. The decrease in energy hampers transportation; as a result part of its
load starts settling down. This activity is known as deposition. The larger particles, such as
boulders and pebbles, are deposited first and the finest particles of silt are the last to be
deposited. Deposition takes place usually in plains and low lying areas. When the river joins a
lake or sea, the whole of its load is deposited.
7.1.3.1. Development of a River Valley
The erosional and depositional land features produced and modified by the action of running
water may be better understood if we note the stages through which a stream passes from its
source to its mouth. The source of a river may lie in a mountainous region and the mouth may
meet the sea or lake. The whole path followed by a river is called its course or its valley.
The course of a river is divided into three sections:
1. The upper course or the stage of youth
2. The middle course or the stage of maturity
3. The lower course or the stage of old age.

om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.

The Upper, Middle and Lower Courses of River


es
ur

7.1.3.1.1. The Upper Course


ay
m

The upper course begins from source of the river in hilly or mountainous areas. The river
tumbles down the steep slopes and as a result, its velocity and eroding power are at their
maximum. Consequently, valley deepening assumes its greatest importance at this stage.
Normally, weathering also plays its part on the new surfaces exposed along the banks of the
stream. The weathered rock material is carried into the stream partly through the action of
gravity and partly by rain water flowing into the river. Weathering helps in widening a valley at
the top giving it a typical ‘V’ shaped cross section. Such valleys are known as ‘V’ shaped valleys.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


83 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

• If the bed rock is hard and resistant, the widening of the valley at its top may not take place
and the down cutting process of a vigorous river may lead to the formation of a gorge i.e. a
river valley with almost vertical sides. George generally develops between pairs of
escarpments or cliffs. In India, deep gorges have been cut by the Brahmaputra and the
Indus in the Himalayas. Deep gorges also develop in limestone regions and in rocks lying in
dry climates.

Grand
Canyon
of the
river
Colorado
in U.S.A.

om
l.c
ai
tm
ho

The Valley of Kaveri river near Hogenekal,


t@

Dharmapuri district, Tamilnadu in the form


sp

of gorge
h.
es
ur
ay
m

interlocking spurs

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


84 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

• The narrow and very deep gorge with vertical walls is known as ‘I’ shaped valley or canyon.
A canyon is very deep gorge with steep sides running for hundreds of kilometers, e.g.
Grand Canyon of the river Colorado in U.S.A.
• As the river flows through the valley it is forced to swing from side to side around more
resistant rock outcrops (spurs). As there is little energy for lateral erosion, the river
continues to cut down vertically flowing between spurs of higher land creating interlocking
spurs.
Some of the others features that are developed in the upper course of a river include rapids,
cataracts, cascades, waterfalls, potholes and plunge-pool.
7.1.3.1.1.1. Waterfalls, Rapids and cataracts
Waterfalls develop when a layer of erosion-resistant rock lies across a streams course. The less
resistant rock on the downstream side is more easily eroded than the resistant rock. The river
bed is thus steepened where the two rocks meet and a waterfall develops. The great force of
falling water in a waterfall makes hydraulic action effective at its base. The blocks of rocks are
broken into smaller boulders by attrition as they collide against each other. The base is further
eroded by abrasion to create deep plunge pools beneath.
Rapids are formed due to unequal resistance of hard and soft rocks traversed by a river, the
outcrop of a band of hard rock may cause a river to 'jump' or 'fall' downstream. Similar falls of
greater dimensions are also referred to as cataracts. These interrupt smooth navigation.
om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay

7.1.3.1.1.2. Pot Holes


m

River potholes can be created when larger pieces of load that the river cannot remove by
traction are swirled around by eddy currents. An eddy current is where the water turns round
on itself. The river is not strong enough here to pull the large boulder (as in the diagram,) the
obstruction creates a swirling motion in the water. Eventually, the boulder creates a pothole, by
abrasion on the river bed.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


85 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

7.1.3.1.2. The Middle Course


In the middle course, lateral corrasion tends to replace vertical corrasion. Active erosion of the
banks widens the ‘V’ shaped valley and result in formation of 'U' shaped valley.
In middle valley course river often develops a winding course. Even a minor obstacles force a
river to swing in loops to go round the obstacles. These loops are called meanders. Meander is
not a landform but is only a type of channel pattern. The formation of meanders is due to both
deposition and erosion and meanders gradually migrate downstream. The force of the
water erodes and undercuts the river bank on the outside of the bend where water flow has
most energy due to decreased friction. On the inside of the bend, where the river flow is
slower, material is deposited, as there is more friction. Thus river Meanders refer to the bends
of longitudinal courses of the rivers.

Fig: Development of a meander.


In the middle course the volume of water increases with the confluence of many tributaries and
om

this increases the river’s load. Thus work of the river is predominantly transportation with some
l.c
ai

deposition. Rivers which sweep down from steep mountain valleys to a comparatively level land
tm

drop their-loads of coarse sand and gravels as there is sudden decrease in velocity.
ho
t@

The load deposited generally assumes a fan like shape, hence it is called an alluvial fan.
sp
h.

Sometimes several fans made by neighbouring streams often unite to form a continuous plain
es
ur

known as a piedmont alluvial plain, so called because it lies at the foot of the mountain.
ay
m

Figure 7.4: An alluvial fan deposited by a hill stream


on the way to Amarnath, Jammu and Kashmir

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


86 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

7.1.3.1.3. The Lower Course


In the lower course, the river moving downstream across a broad, level plain is heavy with
debris brought down from the upper and middle courses. Vertical corrasion has almost ceased,
the lateral corrasion still goes on to erode its banks further. The work of the river is mainly
deposition in the lower course.
Many tributaries join the river and the volume of water increases, coarse materials are dropped
and the fine silt is carried down towards the mouth of the river. Large sheets of material are
deposited on the level bed and the river splits into a maze of channels. Such a stream is called a
braided stream.

Diagram showing Braided stream

In lower course large quantity of sediment is carried by river. During annual floods, these
sediments are spread over the low lying adjacent areas. A layer of sediments is thus deposited
during each flood gradually building up a fertile flood plain.
A raised ridge of coarse material is also formed along each bank of the river due to deposition.
om

Such ridges are called levees. They are high nearer the banks and slope gently away from the
l.c

river. When rivers shift laterally, a series of natural levees can form.
ai
tm
ho

Point bars are also known as meander bars. They are found on the convex side of meanders of
t@

large rivers and are sediments deposited in a linear fashion by flowing waters along the bank.
sp

They are almost uniform in profile and in width and contain mixed sizes of sediments. Rivers
h.
es

build a series of them depending upon the water flow and supply of sediment. As the rivers
ur
ay

build the point bars on the convex side, the bank on the concave side will erode actively and
m

these zones are referred as cut bank.

In the lower course of the river, meanders become much more pronounced. The outer bank or
concave bank is so rapidly eroded that the meander becomes almost a complete circle. A time

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


87 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

comes when the river cuts through the narrow neck of the loop. The meander, now cut off from
the main stream, takes the form of an oxbow lake. When the curvature of the meander loops is
so accentuated due to lateral erosion, the meander loop become almost circular and the two
ends of meander loops come closer, consequently, the streams straightness their coarses and
meander loops are abandoned to form ox-bow lakes. This lake gradually, turning into swamps
disappears in course of time. Numerous such partially or fully filled oxbow lakes are marked at
short distance from the present course of river like the Ganga.

Upon entering a lake or a sea, the river deposits all the load at its mouth giving rise to the
om

formation of a delta .Delta is a triangular relief features with its apex pointing up stream and is
l.c
ai

marked as a fan-shaped area of fine alluvium. Some deltas are extremely large. The Ganga-
tm

Brahmaputra Delta is the largest delta in the world. The following conditions favour the
ho
t@

formation of deltas:
sp
h.

1. active vertical and lateral erosion in the upper course of the river to supply large amount of
es

sediments,
ur
ay

2. tideless, sheltered coast;


m

3. shallow sea, adjoining the delta and


4. no strong current at the river mouth which may wash away the sediments.
Due to the obstruction caused by the deposited alluvium, the river discharge its water through
several channels which are called distributaries. Some rivers emptying into sea have no deltas
but instead they have the shape of a gradually widening mouth cutting deep inland. Such a
mouth is called estuary.
The formation of estuaries is due to the scouring action of tides and currents. But in most of
the cases the original cause is the subsidence of the earth’s crust in the area of the outlet. The
two west flowing rivers of India, the Narmada and the Tapi do not form deltas. They form
estuaries when they join the Arabian Sea.

7.2. River rejuvenation


Rejuvenation occurs when there is either a fall in sea level relative to the level of the land or a
rise of the land relative to the sea. This enables a river to renew its capacity to erode as its

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


88 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

potential energy is increased. The river adjusts to its new base level, at first in its lower reaches
and then progressively inland. In doing so, a number of landforms may be created: knick points,
waterfalls and rapids, river terraces and incised meanders.
7.2.1. Knick point
A knick point is a sudden break or irregularity in the gradient along the long profile of a river.
Some knick points are sharply defined, for example waterfalls, whereas others are barely
noticeable. Although a number of factors can cause such features to occur, they are most
commonly attributed to rejuvenation.

When a river is rejuvenated, adjustment to the new base level starts at the sea and gradually
works its way up the river's course. The river gains renewed cutting power (in the form of
vertical erosion), which encourages it to adjust its long profile. In this sense the knick point is
where the old long profile joins the new.
7.2.2. River Terrace
A river terrace is remnant of a former floodplain which has been left at a higher level after
rejuvenation of the river. Where a river renews its down cutting, it sinks its new channel into
om

the former flood plain leaving the old floodplain above the level of the present river. There
l.c
ai

terraces are cut back as the new valley is widened by lateral erosion. If renewed rejuvenation
tm

takes place, the process is repeated and a new pair of terraces is formed beneath the original
ho
t@

ones. The River Thames has created terraces in its lower course by several stages of
sp

rejuvenation. Terraces provide useful shelter from floods in a lower-course river valley, and
h.
es

natural route ways for roads and railways. The built-up areas of Oxford and London are mainly
ur
ay

located along the terraces of the River Thames.


m

When a terrace is present only on one side of the stream and with none on the other side or
one at quite a different elevation on the other side, the terraces are called non-paired terraces.
Unpaired terraces are typical in areas of slow uplift of land or where the water column changes
are not uniform along both the banks.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


89 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

7.2.3. Incised or Entrenched Meanders


If a rejuvenated river occupies a valley with well-developed meanders, renewed energy results
in them becoming incised or deepened. The nature of the landforms created is largely a result
of the rate at which vertical erosion has taken place. When incision is slow and lateral erosion is
occurring, an ingrown meander may be produced. The valley becomes asymmetrical, with steep
cliffs on the outer bends and more gentle slip-off slopes on the inner bends. With rapid incision,
where down cutting or vertical erosion dominates, the valley is more symmetrical, with steep
sides and a gorge-like appearance, These are described as entrenched meanders.

om
l.c

Diagram showing incised meander


ai
tm

7.3. Significance of work of River


ho
t@

All rivers undertake three closely interrelated activities erosion, transportation and deposition.
sp
h.

Their work has therefore both advantages and disadvantages from a human point of view.
es
ur


ay

Rapids and waterfalls interrupt the navigability of a river.


m

• By depositing large quantities of sediments in the lower course, the river silts up ports
preventing large streamers from anchoring close to shores. Thus deltas are not suitable site
for large ports.
• Many rivers flood, bursting leeves and causing damage to life and agricultural activities.
• Rivers with steep gorges and waterfalls provide natural sites for the generation of hydro
electric power which further support industries through supply of energy.
• In the regions of insufficient rainfall irrigational canals support livelihood of people like
Indira Gandhi canal in Rajasthan.
• The flood plains of large rivers with their thick mantles of fine silt are some of the richest
agricultural areas of the world. Like delta of Ganga accounts for almost all the jute
production of world.
• Fresh water fishing is important along many rivers. The organic matter brought down by the
river waters provide valuable food for fishes.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


90 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

7.4. Features of Overview


Youthful Stage – Upper Mature Stage – Old Stage –Lower Course
course Middle Course
Characteristics • Vertical and • Vertical and • Deposition
headward erosion Lateral erosion • Lateral erosion
• Rough channel bed • Wider and deeper • High discharge & velocity
• High competence, channel • High capacity, low competence
low capacity • Competence • Meandering course
• Large gradient / slope decreases, • Wide flood plain
• High turbulence capacity increases • Channel depth & width at
• Narrow channel maximum
• Straight course • Low gradient/slope

Features v-shaped valley, Meanders, river Levees, deltas, point bars, sand
waterfalls, rapids, cliffs, slip off slopes, bars, oxbow lakes, meanders,
potholes, gorges, flood plains, larger flood plain, raised banks
braided streams,
Interlocking spurs

7.4.1. Erosional Landforms


• Waterfalls
• Gorges
• Rapids
• Potholes
• V-shaped valleys
• Interlocking spurs
7.4.2. Depositional Landforms

om

Deltas
l.c

• Levees
ai


tm

Braided Rivers
ho

7.4.3. Erosional and Depositional Landforms


t@
sp
h.

• Meanders
es

• Oxbow lakes
ur
ay

• Floodplains
m

8. Coastal landforms
8.1. Coastal processes: Tides, Current and Waves
Coastal processes are the most dynamic and hence most destructive. The coastline of any place
is always affected by the dynamic processes operating on the coasts, such as tides, waves and
current.
Tides and currents when come in contact with the shore have very little direct impact on the
coastline. Instead, Waves are the prime agents of erosion in coastal regions. Waves are the
result of transfer of energy from atmosphere to water by the wind moving over the water
surface. The size of a wave is dependent upon wind velocity, wind duration and the area or
distance over which the wind is traveling.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


91 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Anatomy of a wave
8.1.1. Sea Waves mechanism
Waves are most destructive during storm conditions. They exhibit a chaotic pattern at that
time, with smaller waves being superimposed over larger waves. The destruction caused by
combined effect of those waves is very huge. When these waves approach shallow areas near
the coast, they experience rapid reduction in speed. The result is curling of the crest and
eventual breaking of the wave. The zone of breaking of waves is called the surf zone. When a
wave breaks, the water from it runs up the beach. This is called the swash. The movement of
water back down the beach to the sea is called the backwash.

om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es

Surf Zone: Swash and Backwash


ur
ay

Coastal landforms are of two types erosional landform and depositional landform.
m

8.2. Coastal erosion


Coastal erosion is the wearing away and breaking up of rock along the coast. Sea waves play a
prominent role in coastal erosion. The rate of marine erosion depends on the nature of rock,
the extent of rock exposure to the sea, the effect of tides and currents, and human
interference.

8.3. Erosional Features


8.3.1. Cliffs and wave-cut-platforms
A rock rising vertically above sea water with steep slope is called cliff. It is formed because
maximum impact of the sea waves is observed on the lower part of the coastal rocks and
consequently the lower part of the rocks is eroded more rapidly than the upper part. In India a
number of sea cliffs are found along the Konkan Coast of India.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


92 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Figure No. 3- Cliff


As the cliff retreats, a new landform is formed. This is a wave-cut-platform. It is a gentle sloping
rock cut flat surface. It is created at the bottom of the cliff face. It is not a smooth platform of
rock, rather it consists of ridges and grooves. The basic reason for the formation of a wave-cut-
platform is the recession of the cliff.
8.3.2. Capes and bays
Capes and bays are features of irregular coastline. They are formed where hard rocks like
granite and limestone occur in alternating bands with softer rocks like sand and clay.
• The softer rocks are eroded and converted into inlets, coves and bays.
• The harder rocks resist erosion and persist as headlands or capes.
om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

Figure No. 4- Formation of Headlands and Bays


8.3.3. Cave, Arch and Stack
The processes of erosion by waves particularly hydraulic power and corrosion, convert any
vertical line of weakness in rocks into caves. However, the rock needs to be relatively hard or
resistant otherwise it will collapse before the cave is formed.
If the headland is subjected to erosion from two sides, the caves developing on either sides of
the headland join to form a natural arch or sea arch. With time, continued erosion causes the
arch to collapse, leaving an isolated vertical column of the rock, known as a stack, in front of

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


93 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

the cliff. In due course of time, the stack also gets eroded by the action of waves and it ends up
in the form of a stump.

Figure No. 5-Coastal Erosional Features


8.3.4. Blow holes and Geos
Hole on the roof of the cave is known as blow hole. When the lines of weakness occur on the
roof of a cave, hydraulic action of waves leads to the collapse of joint blocks from the roof and
leads to the development of a hole on the roof.
The enlargement of blow holes and continued action of waves weakens the cave roof. When
the roof collapses, a long narrow inlet, or creek, develops. Such deep and long creeks are called
om
l.c

geos
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

.
Figure No. 6- blow holes
8.4. Depositional Features
The sea waves also transport the eroded materials and deposit these at other places.
Landforms resulting from deposition include platforms, beaches, bars & tombolos .
8.4.1. Wave-Built Platform or Terrace
It is a terrace formed by the deposition of sediments derived from the erosion of cliffs or from
the continued abrasion of a cliff by the action of waves.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


94 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

8.4.2. Beaches
Beaches are the most familiar of all the coastal landforms. They are the main feature of
deposition found along the coast. They consist of all the material (sand etc.) built up between
the high and low tide mark (High tide is highest level of tide while low tide is lowest level of
tide). There are a number of different sources of beach material. Rivers are the main source as
fine mud and gravel are deposited at the mouth of a river. Other sources of beach material
include constructive waves (bringing material up the beach from the sea) and cliff erosion.
Beaches are temporary features. Beaches called shingle beaches contain excessively small
pebbles and even cobbles. Marina Beach of Chennai and Kovalam Beach of
Thiruvananthapuram are the famous beaches of India.

Beach and related features

8.4.3. Bars, Spits and Tombolo


These are ridges of sand, pebbles or mud.
• Bar is such ridge which has joined two headlands cutting across a bay. (see figure) .Sand
om

bars that obtain a length of hundreds of kilometres are called offshore bars or longshore
l.c

bars.
ai
tm

• Offshore bars may enclose a water body to form a lagoon, such as the Chilka Lake and
ho

Pulicat Lake in India. (Laggons are referred as Kayals in Kerala).


t@


sp

If bars are formed in such a way that one end is linked to land and the other end projects
h.

into the sea, they are called spits.


es
ur

• A connecting bar that joins two landmasses (mainland to island) is known as a tombolo.
ay

(see figure 8)
m

Depositional Features along the Coast

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


95 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

8.5. Types of Coasts


Coastlines are divided into two basic types (1) Coastline of Submergence (2) Coastline of
Emergence

8.6. Coastlines of submergence


Coastlines of submergence are formed in Coastal areas which have become lowered below
current sea level. The cause is rise in sea level in consequence of ice melting since the last ice
age. This group includes Ria, fiord, estuarine, and Dalmatian or Longitudinal coasts.
a) Ria Coasts: A ria coast is formed when a non-glaciated highland coast becomes
submerged and the valleys filled with sea water. These submerged valleys are often V-
shaped. This type of coast is found in north-western Spain and south-western Ireland.
b) Fiord (Fjord) Coasts: A fjord is a narrow, high-walled, and very long submerged glacial
valley. Fjords are formed when a descending glacier carves a U-shaped valley into the
bedrock. When these fjord are submerged fjord coast is formed.
c) Dalmatian or Longitudinal Coasts: These coasts are formed when a mountain ridge running
parallel to the sea coast is submerged. In this mountain ranges become chains of islands
resembling patches on body of Dalmatian dog.
d) Estuarine Coast: Estuary/estuarine coasts are coasts where lowland coasts are submerged,
flooding river. Their entrances are sand and silt free, Thames of Britain are the example of
such type of coasts.

8.7. Coastlines of Emergence


Uplifted or emergent coasts are coasts where the coast has been raised(due to fall in sea level
or a rising of the crust) and the ocean waves now erode a lower level.
a) Emerged Upland Coasts: An emerged highland coast is formed when coastal plateau lands
are raised above sea level. The chief feature of an emerged upland coast is a raised beach
om

or cliff-line which now found above the present zone of wave action. The Northern part of
l.c

west coast of India is an example of an emerged upland coast.


ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

Emergent upland coast


b) Emerged Lowland Coasts: An emerged lowland coast is produced by the uplift of part of
the neighbouring continental shelf. The chief feature of an emerged lowland coast is spits
lagoons, bars, marshes and beaches. The coasts of Kerala and Tamil Nadu are example of an
emerged lowland coast.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


96 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Emergent lowland coast

9. Glacial Landforms
A moving mass of ice and snow is called a glacier. Glaciers are formed when there is net year to
year accumulation of snow, that is, when the amount of snow that falls in winter is greater than
the amount that melts away in summer. Snow keeps on accumulating in layers one above the
other. Its overlying pressure is applied to the underlying snow. It is so great that snow in lower
layers becomes granular, hard and compact. The pressure also quickens the melting of some of
the snow, which on refreezing starts turning into a granular ice. Again it is the pressure of the
overlying layers which makes this solid mass of ice mobile. Thus glacier is formed through the
processes of accumulation, compaction and recrystallisation of snow.
The movement of glacier is very slow and it moves from a few centimetres to a few metres in a
day.

9.1. Action of Glacier


There are three main types of glacial erosion - plucking, abrasion and freeze thaw.
om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

Plucking is when melt water from a glacier freezes around lumps of cracked and broken rock.
When the ice moves downhill, rock is plucked from the back wall. Abrasion is when rock frozen
to the base and the back of the glacier scrapes the bed rock. Freeze-thaw is when melt water or
rain gets into cracks in the bed rock, usually the back wall. At night the water freezes, expands
and causes the crack to get larger. Eventually the rock will break away.
Erosional work of glacier
Erosion by glaciers is tremendous because of friction caused by sheer weight of the ice. As a
glacier moves over the land, it drags rock fragments, gravel and sand along with it. These rock
fragments become efficient erosive tools. With their help glacier scrapes and scours the surface
rocks with which it comes in contact. This action of glacier leaves behind scratches and grooves
on rocks. Glaciers can cause significant damage to even un-weathered rocks and can reduce
high mountains into low hills and plains.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


97 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

9.2. The landforms created by glacial erosion


9.1.1. Cirque (or Corrie)
This is an arm chair shaped hollow found in the side of a mountain
9.1.2. Arete
This is a narrow, knife edge ridge separating two corries
9.1.3. Pyramidal Peaks
These are formed when three or more corries form in the side of one mountain.
9.1.4. Tarn
This is a lake found in a corrie

om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

Cirque, arete and pyramidal peak


9.1.5. Bergschrund
These form when a crevasse or wide crack opens along the headwall of a glacier; most visible in
the summer when covering snow is gone.

Figure no.2- Bergschrund

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


98 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

9.1.6. ‘U’ - shaped Valley


The glacier does not carve a new valley like a river but deepens. Glacier movement widens a
preexisting valley by smoothening away the irregularities. In this process the glacier broadens
the sides of the valley and form a ‘U’ - shaped valley. Such a valley is relatively straight, has a
flat floor and nearly vertical sides.
9.1.7. Hanging Valley
Just like tributary streams of river, there are tributary glaciers also which join the main glacier
after moving over their mountainous path. These tributary glaciers like the main glaciers carve
U - shaped valleys. However, they have less volume of ice than the main glaciers and thus their
rate of erosion is less rapid. As a result their valleys are smaller and not as deep as that of the
main glacier. Due to this difference in deepening; the valley of the tributary glacier is left at a
higher level than that of the main glacier. The valley of the tributary glacier just looks like
hanging downwards at the point of its confluence with the main valley. This type of a
topographical feature is called a hanging valley. This feature is visible when ice has melted in
both the valleys. When the ice in the hanging valley melts, a waterfall is formed at the point of
confluence of this stream with the main river.

om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@

Glacial Erosional Landforms


sp
h.

9.1.8. Truncated spurs


es
ur
ay

In the process of carving the sides of its valley, a glacier erodes or truncates the lower ends of
m

ridges that extended into the valley. These ridges that have triangular facets produced by glacial
erosion at their lower ends are termed as truncated spurs.

9.1.9. Paternoster lakes


A series of Tarns lakes, resembling a string of prayer beads, are known as paternoster lakes.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


99 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

9.1.10. Roche Moutonnee


A roche moutonnée is a rock hill shaped by the passage of ice to give a smooth up-ice side
(stoss side) and a rough, plucked surface on the down-ice side(lee side).

Roche Moutonnee

9.2. Glacial landforms resulting from deposition


Glaciers carry along their bases the rock fragments they have scraped and plucked from the
underlying bedrock. These forms the feature of glaciated lowland.
The landforms created by glacial erosion are:
9.2.1. Boulder clay or glacial till
The unassorted coarse and fine debris dropped by the melting glaciers is called glacial till.
9.2.2. Outwash deposits
Some amount of rock debris small enough to be carried by such melt-water streams is washed
down and deposited. Such glacio- fluvial deposits are called outwash deposits. Unlike till
deposits, the outwash deposits are roughly stratified and assorted.
9.2.3. Erratics
om
l.c

When boulders of considerable size are deposited far from their origin, they are known as
ai

erratics. They have been transported and deposited by a glacier.


tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

9.2.4. Moraines
When glacial ice melts, different types of rock are laid down that have been carried along by the
glacier. Piles of these deposits are called moraines.
Different types of moraine
Terminal moraines are found at the terminus or the furthest (end) point reached by a glacier.
Lateral moraines are found deposited along the sides of the glacier.
Medial moraines are found at the junction between two glaciers.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


100 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Ground moraines are disorganised piles of rocks of various shapes, sizes and of differing rock
types.

9.2.5. Outwash plain and Kettles


As the moraines are deposited, melting water emerges from the glaciers rapidly in the form of
streams. These streams carry loads of suspended materials. As the water moves, it soon loses
its velocity and load carrying capacity, and it drops most of its bed load. As a result, a broad
surface of stratified drift is formed, which is called an outwash plain. The basins or depressions
found between the outwash plains are called Kettles.
9.2.6. Kames
Rounded mounds/hills of fluvioglacial deposits are known as Kames.
9.2.7. Eskers
In glaciated areas sinuous ridges of sand and gravel are known as eskers. They marks the former
sites of sub glacial melt water streams.
om

9.2.8. Drumlins
l.c
ai
tm

Drumlins are elongated hills of glacial deposits. They can be 1 km long and 500 metres wide,
ho
t@

often occurring in groups. A group of drumlins is called a drumlin swarm or a basket of eggs.
sp

These would have been part of the debris that was carried along and then accumulated under
h.
es

the ancient glacier. The long axis of the drumlin indicates the direction in which the glacier was
ur

moving. The drumlin would have been deposited when the glacier became overloaded with
ay
m

sediment. However glaciologists still disagree as to exactly how they were formed.

Glacio-Fluvial Deposits

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


101 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

10. Landform by the Action of Wind


(Also called Aeolian=Wind )
Wind is also an important agent of denudation. Wind action is mostly limited to arid and semi-
arid areas of the world, where the absence of vegetation cover and the presence of extensive
desolate rocks, help in erosional, transportation and depositional processes.

There is a definite pattern to the location of world deserts. Almost all the deserts are confined
within the 15° to 30° north and south latitudinal belts, also known as the trade wind belts.
• Aridity is the result of lack of water, which is dependent on the mean annual rainfall.
• These areas are affected by cold currents. These cold currents ensure that there is little
moisture available to condense and form clouds. The coasts of western North and South
America and Africa display such conditions.
• Continetiality is also a major reason for the development of arid and semi-arid conditions.
Air descending from mountainous areas warms and dries by compression, little rainfall
forms and it results in aridity. Central areas of continents are also dry because air moving
over landmasses does not absorb large amounts of water vapour.
About one-third of the land surface of the world can be classified as arid, semi- arid or dry. The
major deserts regions of the world include the Sahara desert, Arabian Desert, Kalahari, Namib,
Atacama deserts, Great Australian desert, desert of the south-west U.S.A and Mexico.
The combined effect of the erosional activity of wind and water in the arid and semi-arid
regions give rise to the following types of surfaces.
• Erg (Sandy or True Desert): The erg in the Sahara and Saudi Arabia, and koum in
Turkmenistan are the true sandy deserts. They consist of vast, almost horizontal, sand
sheets or of regular dune lines, or of an undulating sand sea.
• Stony Desert: In a stony desert, horizontal sheets of smoothly angular gravel cover the
om

surface. This is known as the reg in Algeria and serir in Libya and Egypt.
l.c
ai

• Badland: Badland is any landscape characterised by deep dissection, ravines, gullies, and
tm
ho

sharp- edged ridges. The name has been given after the arid area in South Dakota, U.SA.
t@

• Hamada or Rocky Desert: It consists of large areas of sand and dust, with patches of bare
sp

rock. These bare rocks are perfectly smoothened and polished. This type of deserts in
h.
es

Sahara is known as Hamada.


ur
ay

• Mountain Desert: Some deserts are found in the highlands, mountain ranges and the
m

plateau areas. The Ahaggar Mountain and Tibesti mountain of Sahara are examples of these
deserts.

10.1. Mechanism of wind Action in deserts


Attrition: When wind borne particles roll against one another in collision they wear each other
so that their sizes are greatly reduced and converted into finer materials.
Deflation: The complete blowing away of fine dust, leaving coarse and heavier materials, is
known as deflation. As a result of deflation, larger hollows known as blow-outs are formed.
Deflation also exposes bedrock to wind abrasion (corrasion). There are numerous blow-outs
(deflation hollows) in the valley of the Nile.
Abrasion or Corrosion: In the process of abrasion, winds pick up dust and sand and drive them
with tremendous force against the rocks. In fact, in the desert and semi-desert areas, winds
carry with them enormous quantities of sand, dust and small angular fragments which act as
tools of erosion as they strike against the rock surfaces. By this process, the less resistant rocks

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


102 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

are eroded and in time completely worn away, while the hard and very resistant rocks are
polished and smoothed to a remarkable degree.

10.2. Erosional Landforms-Wind


10.2.1. Ventifacts or Dreikanter
These are stone that has received one or more highly polished, flattened facets as a result
of erosion by windblown sand. The facets are cut in sequence and correlate with the dominant
wind direction. As one surface is cut, the stone may become out of balance and may turn to
expose another surface to the wind. A ventifact that has been eroded to three curved facets is
called a dreikanter.

10.2.2. Ventifact

10.2.3. Rock Pedestals or Mushroom Rocks


Due to the presence of alternate layers of soft and hard rock and the effect of sand-blasting by
om

winds on these, features with irregular edges are formed. Grooves and hollows are cut into the
l.c

rock surfaces, carving them into fantastic pillars called rock pedestals.
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

Formation of yardangs Formation of zeugen

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


103 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

10.2.4. Yardangs
A yardang is a streamlined hill carved from bedrock or any consolidated or semi-consolidated
material by the dual action of wind abrasion, dust and sand, and deflation.
10.2.5. Zeugens
Zeugens are also formed by wind abrasion where a surface layer of hard rock is underlain by a
layer of soft rock into a ridge and furrow landscape. The ridges are called zeugens which may be
as high as 100 feet. Ultimately the are undercut and gradually worn away.
10.2.6. Mesas and Buttes
Mesa is a Spanish word meaning table. It is a flat, table-like landmass with a very resistant
horizontal top layer and very steep sides. With continued denudation through the ages, mesas
are reduced to flat-topped hills called buttes.

om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

10.2.7. Inselbergs
Inselberg is a German word for Island Mountain, has been widely adopted to describe a steep-
sided hill of solid rock, rising abruptly from a plain (level ground). They are made of granite.
Inselbergs in arid regions are also called bomhardts.

10.3. Depositional Landforms-wind


The main depositional landforms of wind are sand dunes and loess.
Ripple Marks: Ripple marks are small scale depositional features of sand. This pattern is
produced in unconsolidated sediments by the agents of erosion-like wind. Ripples may be
either longitudinal or transverse.
Sand Dunes: These are mounds or ridges of wind-blown sand. The dunes are generally mobile.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


104 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

There is wide variation in their shape, size and structure. On an average, their height ranges
between a few metres to 20 metres, but there are some sand dunes which are more than
several hundred metres in height and 5 to 6 km in length. Dunes are most well represented in
the erg desert (a broad, flat area of desert).
There are many types of sand dunes. The two most important dunes are Barchans and
Longitudinal dunes, which are described in detail.
Barchans: They are crescent-shaped sand dune produced by the action of wind predominately
from one direction. This type of dune possesses two "horns" that face downwind, with the
steeper slope known as the slip face, facing away from the wind. They gradually migrate with
the wind as a result of erosion on the windward side and deposition on the leeward side.

om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay

Longitudinal Dunes (Seif): Seif is an Arabic word, meaning sword dune. These are long, straight
m

dunes and are parallel to the wind direction. Formed in regions where wind blows from more
than one direction in a region with an abundant supply of sand.
10.3.1. Loess
Loess is fine-grained material that has been transported and deposited by the wind. The
sediments come from glacial outwash plains, where glaciers deposit fine particles of silt and
clay, or from desert areas that have little vegetation to anchor small particles. Prevailing wind
patterns blowing across these environments can produce thick deposits of loess downwind of
the area. In China such yellowish wind borne dust from the Gobi desert is called Hwangtu-the
yellow earth

10.4. Fluvial Desert Landforms


Despite being a dry climate arid and semi-arid regions are also influenced by the action of
water. Running water is also an important external agent for landform development in deserts.
Though rare, the rainfall is intense in its effect on the lightly vegetated cover region of desert

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


105 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

and produce abrupt runoff. This occasional rainfall in the deserts results in flash-floods. Loose
gravels, sand and fine dust are swept down the hill sides. They cut deep gullies and ravines
forming badland topography. The Chambal present a typical example of badland.
Some of the important landforms resulting from fluvial action in deserts are pediments, bajada,
and playas.
10.4.1. Wadis
In Deserts the water flow during flash flood is so strong that it cuts the ground and carries away
the soil material. This results in creation of wide channels called wadis. These remain dry for
most of the times.
10.4.2. Pediments
It is an erosional plain formed at the base of the surrounding mountains scraps.
10.4.3. Bahada (Bajada)
It is a depositional feature made up of alluvial material laid down by the seasonal streams.
These are also known as depositional plains of desert.
10.4.4. Playas
A (shallow) playa lake may form in the central basin of a desert from abundant rainfall on rare
occasions Due to evaporation and infiltration the water in these lakes are present for only a
few days or weeks--the dry flat lake bed that remains is called a playa. These lakes are
temporary in nature.
om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

Desert Fluvial Landforms

11. Karst Topography


In rocks like limestones or dolomites rich in calcium carbonate the surface water as well as
groundwater through the chemical process of solution and precipitation develop varieties of
landforms. These two processes of solution and precipitation are active in limestones or
dolomites occurring either exclusively or interbedded with other rocks. Any limestone or
dolomitic region showing typical landforms produced by the action of groundwater through the
processes of solution and deposition is called Karst topography .‘Karst’ word comes from the
Karst region of Adriatic Sea coast in Croatia (Yugosalvia) where such formations are noticeable.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


106 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

This region is made up of limestone rocks, where underground water is the most active agent of
gradation.

11.1. Erosional landform


11.1.1. Sink Holes, Swallow Holes, Dolines and Uvalas/valley sink
A sinkhole is a surface depression or hole in a region of limestone terrain. Sinkholes can range
in size from a few feet or meters to over 100 meters (300 feet) deep. A sinkhole can even
collapse through the roof of an underground cavern and form what's known as a collapse
sinkhole

Gradual enlargement of sink holes due to continuous dissolution of limestones result in the
coalescence of closely spaced sink holes into one large hole which is called Swallow hole.
Further enlargement of swallow holes due to continuous solution result into a larger depression
which are called dolines in karst erosion.
Uvalas are extensive depression. Larger uvalas have been seen to cover several square
kilometers, with a depth of up to 200 metres. They are formed due to coalescence of several
dolines due to continuous solution and enlargement of dolines, or due to collapse of upper roof
of large cavities formed underground or due to coalescence of various sink holes.
om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

11.1.2. Lapies
It is weathered limestone surface found in karst regions and consisting of etched, fluted, and
pitted rock pinnacles separated by deep grooves. This rugged surface is formed by the solution
of rock along joints and areas of greater solubility by water containing carbonic and humic
acids.
11.1.3. Caves
In areas where there are alternating beds of rocks (shales, sandstones, quartzites) with
limestones or dolomites in between or in areas where limestones are dense, massive and
occurring as thick beds, cave formation is prominent. Water percolates down either through the
materials or through cracks and joints and moves horizontally along bedding planes. It is along
these bedding planes that the limestone dissolves and long and narrow to wide gaps called
caves result. There can be a maze of caves at different elevations depending upon the

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


107 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

limestone beds and intervening rocks. Caves normally have an opening through which cave
streams are discharged. Caves having openings at both the ends are called tunnels.

11.2. Depositional Landforms


11.2.1. Stalactites and Stalagmites
They are the major depositional features formed in the caverns in limestone regions. The
water containing limestone in solution, seeps through the roofs of the caverns in the form of
a continuous chain of drops. A portion of the water dropping from the ceiling gets evaporated
and a small deposit of limestone is left behind on the roof. This process continues and deposit
of limestone grows downwards like pillars. These forms are called stalactites.
When the remaining portion of the water dropping from the roof of the cavern falls on the
floor, a part of it is again evaporated and a small deposit of limestone is left behind. This deposit
grows upward from the floor of the cavern. These type of depositional features are called
stalagmites. As the process grows, both stalactite and stalagmite often join together to form
vertical columns and pillars in the caverns.

om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@

12. Economic significance of karst regions


sp
h.
es

• Karst regions are often barren. The porosity of the rocks and the absence of surface
ur
ay

drainage makes vegetation growth difficult. Therefore, these regions support short turf and
m

poor grasses.
• However, limestone vegetation in tropical regions is luxuriant because of all the year round
rainfall.
• Lead is the only mineral of importance in karst region. Lead occurs in veins in associations
with limestone.
• In addition to this, Limestone is used as building materials or quarried for the cement
industry.

Copyright © by Vision IAS


All rights are reserved. No part of this document may be reproduced, stored in a retrieval system or
transmitted in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording or
otherwise, without prior permission of Vision IAS.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


108 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

INDIA: PHYSICAL FORMATION,


PHYSIOGRAPHY, DRAINAGE, STRUCTURE AND
RELIEF AND BASICS OF SOILS
Contents
1. India Location ......................................................................................................................... 111
1.1. Indian Standard Time (IST) .............................................................................................. 111
1.2. Size .................................................................................................................................. 112
1.3. India’s Administrative Division ........................................................................................ 113
1.4. India and the World ........................................................................................................ 113
2. Physical Formation of India .................................................................................................... 114
2.1. The Peninsular Block ....................................................................................................... 114
2.2. The Himalayas ................................................................................................................. 115
2.2.1. Syntaxial Bends of the Himalayas............................................................................. 116
2.3. Indo-Ganga-Brahmaputra Plain ...................................................................................... 116
3. Physiography .......................................................................................................................... 117
3.1. Himalayan Mountains ..................................................................................................... 118
3.1.1. Kashmir or Northwestern Himalayas ....................................................................... 120
3.1.2. Himachal and Uttrakhand Himalayas ....................................................................... 120
3.1.3. Darjiling and Sikkim Himalayas ................................................................................ 121
3.1.4. Arunachal Himalayas ................................................................................................ 121
3.1.5. Eastern Hills and Mountains or Purvanchal ............................................................. 122
3.2. The Northern Plains ........................................................................................................ 122
3.2.1. The Bhabar Plain ...................................................................................................... 123
3.2.2. The Tarai Tract .......................................................................................................... 123
om

3.2.3. Bhangar Plains .......................................................................................................... 123


l.c

3.2.4. Khadar Plains ............................................................................................................ 123


ai
tm

3.2.5. The Delta Plains ........................................................................................................ 123


ho

3.2.6. The Plains of Rajasthan ............................................................................................ 124


t@

3.2.7. The Punjab Haryana Plains ....................................................................................... 124


sp
h.

3.2.8. The Ganga Plains ...................................................................................................... 124


es

3.2.9. The Brahmaputra Plain............................................................................................. 125


ur
ay

3.3. The Peninsular Plateau.................................................................................................... 125


m

3.3.1. The Deccan Plateau .................................................................................................. 126


3.3.2. The Central Highlands .............................................................................................. 127
3.3.3. The North-Eastern Plateau ....................................................................................... 127
3.4. The Indian Desert ............................................................................................................ 127
3.5. The Coastal Plains ........................................................................................................... 128
3.5.1. Western Coastal Plains ............................................................................................. 128
3.5.2. Eastern Coastal Plains .............................................................................................. 128
3.6. The Islands ...................................................................................................................... 128
3.6.1. Andaman and Nicobar Islands ................................................................................. 128
3.6.2. Lakshadweep Islands................................................................................................ 129
4. Drainage ................................................................................................................................. 129
4.1. Drainage Pattern ............................................................................................................. 129
4.2. Drainage System of India................................................................................................. 130
4.3. The Himalayan Drainage System ..................................................................................... 133
4.3.1. Landforms of Himalayan Rivers ................................................................................ 133

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


109 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

4.3.2. The Indus System ..................................................................................................... 133


4.3.3. The Ganga System .................................................................................................... 134
4.3.4. The Brahmaputra System ......................................................................................... 135
4.4. The Peninsular Drainage System ..................................................................................... 136
4.4.1. Evolution of Peninsular Drainage System................................................................. 136
4.4.2. River Systems ........................................................................................................... 136
4.4.3. East Flowing Rivers ................................................................................................... 136
4.4.4. West Flowing Rivers ................................................................................................. 137
4.5. Comparison Between Himalayan and Peninsular Rivers ................................................ 138
4.6. National River Linking Project ......................................................................................... 138
4.7. National Waterways ........................................................................................................ 140
5. Soil .......................................................................................................................................... 141
5.1. Soil Properties ................................................................................................................. 141
5.2. Soil Horizons .................................................................................................................... 143
5.3. Soil Forming Factors ........................................................................................................ 143
5.4. Soil Classification ............................................................................................................. 145
5.4.1. Soil Classification in India ......................................................................................... 145
5.5. Soil Degradation .............................................................................................................. 147
5.6. Soil Erosion ...................................................................................................................... 147
5.7. Soil Management ............................................................................................................ 148
om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


110 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

1. India Location
India is a vast country lying entirely in the Northern hemisphere. The main land extends
between latitudes 8°4'N and 37°6'N and longitudes 68°7'E and 97°25'E (figure 1). The Tropic of
Cancer (23° 30'N) divides the country into almost two equal parts (figure 2). The southern part
of the country lies within the tropics and the northern part lies in the sub-tropical zone or the
warm temperate zone. This location is responsible for large variations in land forms, climate,
soil types and natural vegetation in the country. To the south east and south west of the
mainland, lie the Andaman and Nicobar islands and the

Figure 1 – India in the world


Lakshadweep islands in Bay of Bengal and Arabian Sea respectively. Andaman and Nicobar
om
l.c

islands make southern boundary of India Union at 6°45'E in Bay of Bengal. The southernmost
ai

point of the India Union “Indira Point” got submerged under the sea water in 2004 during the
tm
ho

Tsunami.
t@
sp

If you work out the latitudinal and longitudinal extent of India, they are roughly about 30
h.

degrees, whereas the actual distance measured from north to south extremity is 3,214 km, and
es
ur

that from east to west is only 2,933 km (figure 2). Why is it so? This is because the east-west
ay
m

distance between two successive meridians of longitude along the equator is at its maximum -
111 km. This, however, goes on decreasing as one moves from the equator to the poles, where
it is zero. This is because all the meridians of longitude merge in a single point at the poles -
both North and South. On the other hand, the north-south distance between any two
successive parallels of latitude along any meridian of longitude remains almost uniform, i.e.,
111 km.

1.1. Indian Standard Time (IST)


While the sun rises in the northeastern states about two hours earlier as compared to
Jaisalmer, the watches in Dibrugarh, Imphal in the east and Jaisalmer, Bhopal or Chennai in the
other parts of India show the same time. Why does this happen? What is Indian Standard Time
(IST)? What is the use of standard meridian (figure 2)? Variation of nearly 30degree in
longitude causes a time difference of

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


111 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

om
l.c
ai
tm
ho

Figure 2 – India: Extent and Standard Meridian


t@
sp

nearly two hours between the easternmost and the westernmost parts of our country. Standard
h.

meridian is an imaginary line used for reckoning standard time. For the convenience of all, each
es
ur

country chooses its standard meridian in a multiple of 7°30'. India’s standard meridian passes
ay
m

through 82° 30'E.Time along this Standard Meridian of India passing through Mirzapur (in Uttar
Pradesh) is taken as the standard time for the whole country and known as IST with a time
offset of UTC + 5:30.
There is a continuous demand from northeastern states to have separate time zone. Currently,
the single time zone causes problems for them, especially in summers when daybreak comes as
early as 4:30am around the summer solstice. A farmer in Assam can start work one hour before
her or his counterpart in a state like Gujarat. Tea gardens in Assam have for years set their
clocks an hour ahead of the rest of the country.

1.2. Size
The land mass of India has an area of 3.28 million square km. India’s total area accounts for
about 2.4 per cent of the total geographical area of the world; whereas it sustains17.5per cent
of the world population. India is the seventh largest country of the world. India has a land
boundary of about 15,200 km and the total length of the coast line of the mainland including
Andaman and Nicobar and Lakshadweep is 7,516.6 km.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


112 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Figure 3 – India: Administrative Division


India is bounded by the young fold mountains in the northwest, north and north east. South of
om

about 22° north latitude, Indian Landmass begins to taper, and extends towards the Indian
l.c
ai

Ocean, dividing it into two seas, the Arabian Sea on the west and the Bay of Bengal on its east.
tm
ho

The Peninsular shape of India makes climate of southern India differ from that of Northern
t@

India. Vast sandy expanse of Marusthal in Rajasthan and marshy great Rann of Kachchh make
sp

western boundary of the India.


h.
es
ur

1.3. India’s Administrative Division


ay
m

India, that is Bharat, is a union of states. India has total twenty-eight1 states and seven Union
Territories (Figure 3). New Delhi is the capital of India. Rajasthan is the largest state while Goa is
the smallest state in terms of geographical area. The Tropic of Cancer (23° 30'N) passes through
Mizoram, Tripura, West Bengal, Jharkhand, Chhattisgarh, Madhya Pradesh, Rajasthan and
Gujarat (8 states). Jammu and Kashmir makes northern border while Tamil Nadu makes
southern border. Similarly, Gujarat and Arunachal Pradesh are the western most and eastern
most states respectively. Except Madhya Pradesh, Chhattisgarh, Jharkhand, Haryana, all states
share international or marine boundary.

1.4. India and the World


The Indian landmass has a central location between the East and the West Asia. India is a
southward extension of the Asian Continent. The Trans Indian Ocean routes provide a strategic

1
As of Jan 2013 Telangana is in process.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


113 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

central location to India. It is India’s eminent position in the Indian Ocean which justifies the
naming of an Ocean after it.
India is part of Indian sub-continent and shares boundary with every country of this region.
Land neighbours of India include Pakistan, Afghanistan, China, Nepal, Bhutan, Myanmar and
Bangladesh. Most of our boundary with Pakistan and Bangladesh is almost man-made while
boundary with other countries largely form a natural boundary. Sri Lanka and Maldives are the
two island countries located in the Indian Ocean, which are our neighbours. Sri Lanka is
separated from India by the Gulf of Mannar and Palk Strait.

2. Physical Formation of India


Earth of the distant past was a very different planet than the one we know today. Over these
long years, it has undergone many changes brought about primarily by the endogenic and
exogenic forces. We have already studied about the movement of Indian plate which started its
northward journey about 200 million years ago. This northward movement of the Indian plate is
still continuing and it has significant consequences on the physical environment of the Indian
subcontinent. Here, we will study about geological structure of India. The geological regions of
India are broadly divided into three parts - (i) The Peninsular Block; (ii) The Himalayas; and (iii)
Indo-Ganga-Brahmaputra Plain.

2.1. The Peninsular Block


The plateau of Peninsular India exhibits a complex system of geological structures. It has some
of the oldest rocks of the world from the Precambrian period and the youngest rocks of the
Quaternary period. The features of this block have developed over period of time. Since the
Cambrian period, the Peninsula has been standing like a rigid block with the exception of some
of its western coast which is submerged beneath the sea and some other parts changed due to
tectonic activity without affecting the original basement. It has been subject to various vertical
movements and block faulting. The rift valleys of the Narmada, relict and residual mountains
om

like the Aravali hills, and block fault like Malda fault in the Eastern India are example of it.
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

Figure 4 – Peninsular block

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


114 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

This region contains all types of rocks - igneous, metamorphic and sedimentary rocks. For
instance, limestone, sandstone sedimentary rocks are found in river valleys. Coal belts of
Peninsular India were developed during the Gondwana period. The black soil of Deccan is due
to outpouring of huge quantity of lava during Cretaceous period.
The northern boundary of the Peninsular Block may be taken as an irregular line running from
Kutch along the western flank of the Aravali Range near Delhi and then roughly parallel to the
Yamuna and the Ganga as far as the Rajmahal Hills and the Ganga delta (figure 4). Apart from
these, Rajasthan in the west and the Karbi Anglong and the Meghalaya Plateau in the northeast
are also extensions of this block. The northeastern parts are separated by the Malda fault in
West Bengal from the Chotanagpur plateau. In Rajasthan, the desert and other desert–like
features overlay this block.

2.2. The Himalayas


The Himalayas are geologically young, weak and flexible and structurally fold mountains unlike
the rigid and stable Peninsular Block. The disintegration of Pangaea, about 200 million years
ago, led to the formation of a long Tethys sea between the Lauretian Shield and Gondwanaland.
This sea was occupying the region of Himalayas called geosyncline. About 65-30 million years
ago, the Indian plate came very close to the Eurasian plate and started subducting under it
(figure 5). This caused lateral compression due to which the sediments of the Tethys were
squeezed and folded into three parallel ranges of the Himalayas. Since the northward
movement of the Indian plate is still continuing, these mountains are still subjected to
endogenic forces apart from exogenic forces. It is said that the height of the Himalayan peaks is
still increasing.
om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

Figure 5 – Plate tectonics and evolution of Himalayas


The Himalayas consist of four litho tectonic mountain ranges, namely (i) the Trans-Himalaya; (ii)
the Greater Himalaya; (iii) the Lesser Himalaya; and (iv) the Shiwalik. The first phase of uplift
produced the ranges of Trans Himalayas around 65 million years ago. Subsequent uplift led to
formation of Greater Himalayas, Lesser Himalayas and Shiwalik mountain ranges.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


115 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

2.2.1. Syntaxial Bends of the Himalayas


The structures and trends of the Himalaya change sharply at both ends of the range, defining
bends called "syntaxes." It develops along the edges of two colliding plates near the zone of
active collision. The western syntaxial bend is near Nanga Parbat where the Indus has cut deep
gorge. The geological formations here take sharp hair-pin bends as if they were bent around
pivotal points obstructing them. There is a similar hair-pin bend in Arunachal Pradesh where
the mountains take a sharp bend from the eastern to southern direction after crossing the
Brahmaputra river.

Figure 6 – Himalaya’s syntaxes at NP (Nanga Parbat) and NB (Namcha Barwa)

2.3. Indo-Ganga-Brahmaputra Plain


om
l.c

The third geological division of India comprises the plains which lie to the south of Shiwalik
ai
tm

formed by the river system Indus, the Ganga and the Brahmaputra. Originally, it was a geo-
ho

synclinal depression which attained its maximum development during the third phase of the
t@
sp

Himalayan mountain formation approximately about 64 million years ago. It is an aggradational


h.

plain formed by the alluvial deposits of rivers originating in Himalayas in north and the
es
ur

Peninsular plateau in South. Since then, it has been gradually filled by the sediments brought by
ay

the Himalayan and Peninsular rivers. Average depth of alluvial deposits in these plains ranges
m

from 1,000-2,000 m. Some geologists are of the opinion that Great plains are a remnant of the
Tethys Sea. After the upheaval of Shiwalik, the remaining part of the Tethys was left as a large
trough. Because the Himalayas were rising during that period, rivers experienced rejuvenation
and greater quantity of eroded material which increased the thickness of alluvium in this trough
(figure 7).

Figure 7 – The great plains of India

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


116 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

Table 1 – Geological Time Scale of India

3. Physiography
‘Physiography’ deals with the study of the surface features and landforms of the earth. It is the
outcome of structure, process and the stage of development. There are significant variations
among the different regions of India in terms of their geological structure. The relief and
physiography of India has been greatly influenced by the geological and geomorphological
processes active in the Indian subcontinent. The land of India is characterized by great diversity
in its physical features. The north has a vast expanse of rugged topography consisting of a series
of mountain ranges with varied peaks, beautiful valleys and deep gorges. The south consists of
stable table land with highly dissected plateaus, denuded rocks and developed series of scarps.
In between these two lies the vast north Indian plain. Based on these macro variations, India
can be divided into the six physiographic divisions as shown in figure 8.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


117 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Figure 8 – Physiographic division of India

3.1. Himalayan Mountains


The North and Northeastern Mountains consist of the Himalayas and the Northeastern Hills.
The Himalayas represent the loftiest and one of the most rugged mountain barriers of the
om

world. The altitudinal variations are greater in the eastern half than those in the western half.
l.c

They are steeper at their southern side as compared to northern side. They are separated from
ai
tm

the plains by the Himalayan Front Fault (HFF).Himalayas are not only the physical barrier, they
ho

are also a climatic, drainage and cultural divide.


t@
sp

The general orientation of these ranges is from northwest to the southeast direction in the
h.
es

northwestern part of India. Himalayas in the Darjiling and Sikkim regions lie in an east west
ur

direction, while in Arunachal Pradesh they are from southwest to the northwest direction. In
ay
m

Nagaland, Manipur and Mizoram, they are in the north south direction. They form an arc, which
covers a distance of about 2,400 Km. Its width varies from 400 Km in Kashmir to 150 Km in
Arunachal Pradesh.
Longitudinal division of Himalayas include – Trans-Himalayas, the Greater Himalayas, the Lesser
Himalayas and the Shiwaliks (Figure 9). The trans-Himalayas are about 40km wide and contain
Tethys sediments which are underlain by ‘Tertiary granite’. Trans-Himalayas in clue Karakoram,
Ladakh and Zaskar Mountain ranges in India. The Greater Himalayas rise abruptly like a wall.
They are 25 km wide with an average height above 6100m. Almost all the lofty peaks of the
Himalayas Mt. Everest, Kanchenjunga, Nanga-Parbat lies in this zone. This mountain range has
very few gaps mainly provided by the antecedent rivers, otherwise it is the most continuous
range in the Himalayan system. The width of lesser Himalayas is about 80 km with an average
height of 1300 – 4600 m. This region is subjected to extensive erosion due to heavy rainfall,
deforestation and urbanization. The Shiwalik extend over a width of 10-50 Km and have an
altitude varying between 900 and 1100 metres. These ranges are composed of unconsolidated
sediments brought down by rivers from the main Himalayan ranges

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


118 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Figure 9 – Himalayas and Northeastern Hills


located farther north. Shiwalik are absent beyond Nepal. Landforms like gorges, V-shaped
valleys, rapids, waterfalls etc. are indicative of youthful stage of Himalayas. Cross sectional view
of Himalayan system is given below (figure 10).
om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

Figure 10 - Cross sectional view of Himalayan system


Besides the longitudinal divisions, the Himalayas have been divided on the basis of regions from
west to east. These divisions have been generally demarcated by river valleys. On the basis of
relief, alignment of ranges and other geomorphologic features, the Himalayas can be divided
into the five sub-divisions as shown in figure 11.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


119 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Figure 11 – Himalayan – Longitudinal Divisions


3.1.1. Kashmir or Northwestern Himalayas
Sprawling over an area of about 350,000 sq km, the range stretches about 700km in length and
500 km in width. This division is lying between Indus and Ravi rivers. With an average height of
3000m, it has the largest number of glaciers in India such as Baltoro, Siachen glaciers. Kashmir
Himalayas comprise a series of ranges such as the Karakoram, Ladakh, Zaskar and Pir Panjal. The
northeastern part of the Kashmir Himalayas, Ladakh, is a cold desert, which lies between the
Greater Himalayas and the Karakoram ranges. It is one of the loftiest inhabited regions of the
world. Between the Great Himalayas and the Pir Panjal range, lies the world famous valley of
Kashmir and the famous Dal Lake.
om

A special feature of Kashmir valley is Karewas formation which is thick deposits of glacial clay
l.c

and other materials embedded with moraines and useful for saffron cultivation. The
ai
tm

southernmost part of this region consists of longitudinal valleys known as ‘duns’ such as Jammu
ho

duns and Pathankot duns etc. Some of the important passes of the region are Zoji La on the
t@

Great Himalayas, Banihal on the Pir Panjal, Photu La on the Zaskar and Khardung La on the
sp
h.

Ladakh range. Important fresh lakes such as Dal and Wular and salt water lakes such as Pangong
es

Tso and Tso Moriri are also in this region. Some famous places of pilgrimage such as Vaishno
ur
ay

Devi, Amarnath Cave, Charar -e-Sharif, etc. are also located here. Srinagar, capital city of the
m

state of Jammu and Kashmir is located on the banks of Jhelum river.


3.1.2. Himachal and Uttrakhand Himalayas
Stretching over Himachal Pradesh, it occupies an area of about 83,000 sqkm. All the three
ranges – the Greater, the Lesser (which is locally known as Dhaoladhar in Himachal Pradesh and
Nagtibha in Uttaranchal) and the Shiwalik Himalayas – are well represented in this region. This
division lies between Ravi and Kali rivers. It is drained by two major river systems of India, i.e.
the Indus and the Ganga. Tributaries of the Indus include the river Ravi, the Beas and the Satluj,
and the tributaries of Ganga flowing through this region include the Yamuna and the Ghaghara.
The northernmost part of the Himachal Himalayas is an extension of the Ladakh cold desert.
Gangotri, Milam and Pindar are the main glaciers of Uttarakhand.
The northern slopes of this region are clothed with thick forests and show plains and lakes,
while the southern slopes are rugged and forest clad. The famous Valley of flowers is also
situated in this region of Himalayas. The two distinguishing features of this region from the
point of view of physiography are the ‘Shiwalik’ and ‘Dun formations’ such as Chandigarh-Kalka

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


120 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

dun, Nalagarh dun. Dehra Duns the largest of all the duns with an approximate length of 35-45
km and a width of 22-25 km.
In the Great Himalayan range, the valleys are mostly inhabited by the Bhotias. These are
nomadic groups who migrate to ‘Bugyals’ (the summer grasslands in the higher reaches) during
summer months and return to the valleys during winters. The places of pilgrimage such as the
Gangotri, Yamunotri, Kedarnath, Badrinath and Hemkund Sahib are also situated in this part.
The region is also known to have five famous Prayags - Vishnu Prayag, Nand Prayag, Karn
prayag, Rudra Prayag and Dev Prayag, in the descending flow sequence of their occurrence. In
this section of Lesser Himalayas, the altitude between 1,000-2,000 m especially attracted to the
British colonial administration, and subsequently, some of the important hill stations such as
Dharamshala, Mussoorie, Shimla, and the cantonment towns and health resorts such as Shimla,
Kasauli etc. were developed in this region.
3.1.3. Darjiling and Sikkim Himalayas
The Darjiling and Sikkim Himalayas are flanked by Nepal Himalayas in the west and Bhutan
Himalayas in the east. It is relatively small but is a most significant part of the Himalayas. As
compared to the other sections of the Himalayas, these along with the Arunachal Himalayas are
conspicuous by the absence of the Shiwalik formations. In place of the Shiwaliks here, the ‘duar
formations’ are important, which have also been used for the development of tea gardens.
Known for its fast-flowing rivers such as Tista, it is a region of high mountain peaks and deep
valleys. Kanchenjunga (8598 m), 3rd highest peak of the world, is situated on the border of India
and Nepal. This region has very few passes. The passes of Nathu-La and Jelep-La connect
Gangtok (Sikkim) with Lhasa, Tibet (China).
The higher reaches of this region are inhabited by Lepcha tribes while the southern part,
particularly the Darjiling Himalayas, has a mixed population of Nepalis, Bengalis and tribals from
Central India. The British, taking advantage of the physical conditions such as moderate slope,
thick soil cover with high organic content, well distributed rainfall throughout the year and mild
om

winters, introduced tea plantations in this region. Sikkim and Darjiling Himalayas are also
l.c

known for their scenic beauty and rich flora and fauna, particularly various types of orchids.
ai
tm

3.1.4. Arunachal Himalayas


ho
t@
sp

Arunachal Himalayas extend from the east of the Bhutan Himalayas up to the Diphu pass in the
h.

east. The general direction of the mountain range is from southwest to northeast. In this part,
es
ur

the Himalayas rise very rapidly from the plains of Assam. Some of the important mountain
ay

peaks of the region are Kangtu and Namcha Barwa. These ranges are dissected by fast-flowing
m

rivers from the north to the south, forming deep gorges. Brahmaputra flows through a deep
gorge after crossing Namcha Barwa. Some of the important rivers are the Kameng, the
Subansiri, the Dihang, the Dibang and the Lohit. These are perennial with the high rate of fall,
thus, having the highest hydro-electric power potential in the country. Due to heavy rainfall,
fluvial erosion is quite pronounced here. Few important passes of this region are Bomdi La,
Diphu , Pangsau La etc.
An important aspect of the Arunachal Himalayas is the numerous ethnic tribal communities
inhabiting in these areas. Some of the prominent ones from west to east are the Monpa, Daffla,
Abor, Mishmi, Nishi and the Nagas. Most of these communities practise Jhumming (shifting
cultivation). This region is rich in biodiversity which has been preserved by the indigenous
communities. Due to rugged topography, the inter-valley transportation linkages are nominal.
Hence, most of the interactions are carried through the duar region along the Arunachal-Assam
border.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


121 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

3.1.5. Eastern Hills and Mountains or Purvanchal


Eastern hills or Purvanchal are part of the Himalayan mountain system. On the southern border
of Arunachal Pradesh, the Himalayas take a southerly turn and the ranges are arranged in a
north-south direction. They are known by different local names. In the north, they are known
as Patkai Bum (Arunachal Pradesh), Naga hills (Nagaland), the Manipur hills (Manipur) and in
the south as Mizo or Lushai hills (Mizoram).
Most of these ranges are separated from each other by numerous small rivers. The Barak is an
important river in Manipur and Mizoram. The physiography of Manipur is unique by the
presence of a large lake known as ‘Loktak’ lake at the centre, surrounded by mountains from all
sides. Mizoram which is also known as the ‘Molassis basin’ is made up of soft unconsolidated
deposits. Most of the rivers in Nagaland form the tributary of the Brahmaputra. These are low
hills, inhabited by numerous tribal groups practicing Jhum cultivation.

3.2. The Northern Plains


The northern plains of India are remarkably homogeneous surface with an imperceptible slope.
In fact, they are a featureless alluvial fertile plains formed by the alluvial deposits brought by
the rivers – the Indus, the Ganga and the Brahmaputra along with their tributaries and
Vindhyan rivers flowing towards north. The plain extends from the arid and semi-arid areas of
Rajasthan in the west to Brahmaputra valley in the east. The average width of these plains
varies between 150-300 km. The maximum depth of alluvium deposits varies between 1,000-
2,000 m. Its average height is 200 metres above the mean se level. Due to a very gentle slope
towards the sea, the rivers in this plain flow very leisurely and at times even sluggishly. The
slope from Varanasi upto the mouth of Ganga is only 10 cm. per km. The land around Ambala is
a bit more elevated.
Due to almost flat land, changing river courses in the areas of frequent floods is a unique
geomorphic process in the plains. The Kosi (The Sorrow of Bihar) is one of two major tributaries
om

of Ganga, the other river being Gandak, draining the plains of north Bihar, the most flood-prone
l.c

area of India. Over the last 250 years, the Kosi River has shifted its course over 120 kilometres
ai
tm

and the unstable nature of the river is attributed to the heavy silt which it carries during the
ho

monsoon season (figure 12).From north to south, northern plains can be divided into three
t@

major zones: the Bhabar, the Tarai and the alluvial plains. The alluvial plains can be further
sp
h.

divided into the khaddar and the Bhangar.


es
ur
ay
m

Figure 12 – Shifting course of river Kosi in last 250 years

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


122 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

3.2.1. The Bhabar Plain


Bhabar is a narrow belt ranging between 8-10 km parallel to the Shiwalik foothills at the break-
up of the slope. Its width is, however, more in the western plains than in the eastern plains of
Assam. The streams and rivers coming from the mountains deposit heavy materials of rocks and
boulders, and at times, disappear in this zone due to high porosity. These rivers carry very
coarse load with them. This load becomes too heavy for the streams to be carried over gentler
gradients and gets dumped and spread as a broad low to high cone shaped deposit called
alluvial fan ath the foothills of Shiwalik. Usually, the streams which flow over fans are not
confined to their original channels for long and shift their position across the fan forming many
channels called distributaries. The Bhabar tract is not suitable for cultivation of crops. Only big
trees with large roots thrive in this region. The inhabitants are largely the cattle keeping Gujjars.
3.2.2. The Tarai Tract
South of the Bhabar is the Tarai belt, with an approximate width of 10-20 km where most of the
streams and rivers re-emerge without having any properly demarcated channel, thereby,
creating marshy and swampy conditions known as the Tarai. Unlike Bhabar tracts, Tarai is wider
in the eastern parts of the Great plains, especially in Brahmaputra valley due to heavy rainfall.
This has a luxurious growth of natural vegetation and houses a varied wild life. Many parts of
the Tarai, especially in Uttarakhand, Uttar Pradesh, Haryana, Punjab and Jammu, have been
reclaimed, for agricultural crops such as sugarcane, rice, wheat, maize etc. This marshy tract is
infested with mosquitoes and infamous for Japanese Encephalitis (JE) disease.
3.2.3. Bhangar Plains
The south of Tarai is a belt consisting of old and new alluvial deposits known as the Bhangar and
Khadar respectively. The Bhangar represents the upland alluvial tracts formed by the older
alluviums. The largest part of the northern plains is formed of this older alluvium. The Bhangar
formations were deposited during the middle Pleistocene period. The Bhangar land lies above
om

the flood limits of the rivers. The soil is dark in colour, rich in humus content and productive. It
l.c

contains concentration and nodules of impure calcium carbonate or kankar.


ai
tm

3.2.4. Khadar Plains


ho
t@
sp

New alluvial deposits along the courses of the rivers are known as the khadar lands. Himalayan
h.

rivers have more flood area in the eastern India and thus, Khadar plains are wider here as
es
ur

compared to western area. The khadar tracts are enriched by fresh deposits of silt every year
ay

during the rainy season. The khadar land consists of sand silt, clay and mud. Most of the Khadar
m

land has been brough under the cultivation and devoted to sugarcane, rice, wheat, maize,
oilseeds.
Together alluvial plains (Khadar and Bhangar) are stretched over 100kms from north to south
direction. These plains have characteristic features of mature stage of fluvial erosional and
depositional landforms such as sand bars, meanders, oxbow lakes and braided channels. The
Brahmaputra plains are known for their riverine islands and sand bars. It is also home to first
green revolution that took place in 1960s-70s in India.
3.2.5. The Delta Plains
The mouths of these mighty rivers also form some of the largest deltas of the world, for
example, the famous Sunderbans delta. Otherwise, this is a featureless plain with a general
elevation of 50-150 m above the mean sea level. The deltaic plains are extension of the Khadar
land. It covers 1.9 lakh sqkm of area in lower reaches of the Ganga River. In fact, it is an area of
deposition as the river flows in this tract sluggishly. The deltaic plain consists of old mud, new
mud and marsh.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


123 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Figure 13 – Different section of northern plains of India


On the basis of geo-climatic and topographical characteristics, the northern plains of India may
be divided into the following four meso-regions, namely (i) the plains of Rajasthan; (ii) the
Punjab-Haryana plains; (iii) the Ganga plains; and (iv) the Brahmaputra Plains (figure 13).
3.2.6. The Plains of Rajasthan
They lie to the west of Aravallis. These plains cover a total area of about 175,000 sqkm. A
substantial part of this plain has been formed by the recession of the sea as is evidenced by the
presence of salt water lakes such as Sambhar lake near Jaipur city. During the Permo-
carboniferous period, the greater part of the Rajasthan plain was under the sea. It has several
dry beds of rivers like Saraswati which indicate that the area earlier was fertile. At present, the
greater part of these plains is a desert covered with sand dunes and barchans. The Indira
Gandhi canal has led to intensive agriculture in north-western Rajasthan.
om

3.2.7. The Punjab Haryana Plains


l.c
ai
tm

Stretching over an area of about 650km from northeast to southwest and 300km from west to
ho
t@

east, the Punjab-Haryana plain is an aggradational plain, deposited by Satluj, Ravi and Beas
sp

rivers. Delhi ridge divides plains from the Gangetic plain. The height of the plains varies from
h.
es

300 m in the north to 200 m in south east. The general direction of slope is from northeast to
ur

southwest and south. A plain between two rivers is called doab such as Bist doab between the
ay
m

Beas and Satluj.


3.2.8. The Ganga Plains
The Ganga plains lie between the Yamuna catchment in the west to the Bangladesh border in
the east. It is about 1400km in length and has an average width of 300km. the general gradient
of the plain is about 15cm per km. The ganga plains can be subdivided into the following sub-
regions
• The upper Ganga plain – includes the Ganga-Yamuna Doab, Rohilakhand division and parts
of the Agra division. The catchment area of the Yamuna river makes its western boundary,
Shiwalik in the north. Its height varies from 100m to 300m. Kali, Sharda are other rivers
feeding these plains. It is one of the most productive plains of India in which the Green
revolution is a big success. Main crops grown here are sugarcane, wheat, rice, maize,
mustard, vegetables etc.
• The middle Ganga plain – sprawling over an area of 150, 000 sqkm, it includes central and
eastern Uttar Pradesh, Bihar up to Muzaffarpur and patna. It has thick alluvial deposits with

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


124 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

less kankar. Being a low gradient plain, the rivers often change their courses in this region as
described above about Kosi river. Son, Gandak are major tributaries of Ganga.
• The lower ganga plain – extends from Patna to the Bay of Bengal. It is bordered by Assam,
Bangladesh in the east and Chotanagpur plateau in the west and Sundarban delta in the
south. It is drained also by Tista, Sankosh, Mahananda, Damodar, Subarnarekha rivers.
These plains have filled faults with sediment created during movement of Indian plate.
Ganga is divided into several distributaries in the delta region. Hooghly is the best example
of a distributary of Ganga.
3.2.9. The Brahmaputra Plain
Stretching over an area of around 56,000sqkm, it is the eastern most part of plains. It is about
720 km long, 80 km wide and altitude varies from 30 m to 130 m. The region is surrounded by
high mountains except in western side. Assam valley is characterized by a steep slope along
northern margin. Majuli with area of around 930sqkm is the largest river island of India and
the second largest of world. But this island is undergoing severe erosion and needs special
protection. The tributaries descending from Himalayas form a series of alluvial fans. The fertile
valley is conducive to grow rice and jute. It is also famous for its tea and two national parks –
Kaziranga and Manas.

3.3. The Peninsular Plateau


The Great Peninsular plateau is a tableland composed of the old crystalline, igneous and
metamorphic rocks. It lies to the South of the Great Northern Plains. It covers an area of about
16 lakh square km, i.e., about half of the total area of the country. It is an irregular triangle
rising from the height of 150 m above the river plains up to an elevation of 600-900 m. Delhi
ridge in the northwest, (extension of Aravalis), the Rajmahal hills in the east, Gir range in the
west and the Cardamom hills in the south constitute the outer extent of the peninsular plateau.
However, an extension of this is also seen in the northeast, in the form of Shillong and Karbi-
Anglong plateau separated from Peninsular by Malda fault. One of the distinct features of the
om

peninsular plateau is the black soil area known as Decean Trap. This is of volcanic origin hence
l.c
ai

the rocks are igneous. When Indian plate was moving over Reunion hotspot, basalt lava spread
tm

to form these igneous rocks. Actually these rocks have denuded over time and are responsible
ho
t@

for the formation of black soil.


sp
h.

The Peninsular India is made up of a series of patland plateaus such as the Hazaribagh plateau,
es

the Palamu plateau, the Ranchi plateau, the Malwa plateau, the Coimbatore plateau and the
ur
ay

Karnataka plateau, etc. This is one of the oldest and the most stable landmass of India. The
m

general elevation of the plateau is from the west to the east, which is also proved by the
pattern of the flow of rivers. Rivers such as Krishna, Kaveri, Godavari, all rise from Western
Ghats, makes delta in the Bay of Bengal side. Plateau has been subjected to large scale
denudation. Its mountains are generally of relic type. Because of their old age, all the rivers
have almost attained their base level and have built up broad and shallow valleys. Some of the
important physiographic features of this region are tors, block mountains, rift valleys, spurs,
bare rocky structures, series of hummocky hills and wall-like quartzite dykes offering natural
sites for water storage.
This Peninsular plateau has undergone recurrent phases of upliftment and submergence
accompanied by crustal faulting and fractures. These spatial variations have brought in
elements of diversity in the relief of the peninsular plateau. The northwestern part of the
plateau has a complex relief of ravines and gorges. The ravines of Chambal, Bhind and Morena
are some of the well-known examples. On the basis of the prominent relief features, the
peninsular plateau can be divided into three broad groups: (i) The Deccan Plateau; (ii) The
Central Highlands; and (iii) The Northeastern Plateau.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


125 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

om
l.c
ai

Figure 14 – Peninsular India: Relief


tm
ho

3.3.1. The Deccan Plateau


t@
sp

This physiographic division is the largest region (about 7 lakh square km) of the Great Indian
h.
es

Plateau. The shape of this plateau is triangular and lies to the south of the river Narmada. This
ur
ay

is bordered by the Western Ghats in the west, Eastern Ghats in the east and the Satpura, Maikal
m

range and Mahadeo hills in the north.The Satpura range is formed by a series of scarped
plateaus on the south, generally at an elevation varying between 600-900 m. It is a classic
example of the relict mountains which are highly denuded and form discontinuous ranges. The
Deccan Plateau is higher in the west and slopes gently eastwards.
Western Ghats are locally known by different names such as Sahyadri in Maharashtra, Nilgiri
hills in Karnataka and Tamil Nadu and Anaimalai hills and Cardamom hills in Kerala. These are
block mountains formed due to the downwarping of a part into the Arabian Sea. Western ghats
lie parallel to the western coast from mouth of Tapi rover to Kanyakumari. The western slope is
steeper as compared to gentle eastern slope. Thal, Bhor and pal Ghats are major passes of
Western Ghats. The Eastern Ghats stretch from the Mahanadi Valley to the Nigiris in the south.
The Eastern Ghats are discontinuous and irregular and dissected by rivers such as Mahanadi,
the Godavari, the Krishna, the Kaveri draining into the Bay of Bengal. Shevroy Hills and the
Javadi Hills are located to the southeast of the Eastern Ghats.
Western Ghats are comparatively higher (900-1600m) in elevation and more continuous than
the Eastern Ghats (600m). Their average elevation is about 1,500 m with the height increasing

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


126 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

from north to south. ‘Anaimudi’ (2,695 m), the highest peak of Peninsular plateau is located on
the Anaimalai hills of the Western Ghats followed by Dodabetta (2,637 m) on the Nilgiri hills.
Mahendragiri (1,501 metres) is the highest peak in the Eastern Ghats. The Eastern and the
Western Ghats meet each other at the Nilgiri hills.
3.3.2. The Central Highlands
It extends between Vindhayalchal range in South and Great Northern Plains in nroth. The
Aravallis form the west-northwestern edge of the Central Highlands. An eastern extension of
the Central Highland is formed by the Rajmahal hills. Malwa plateau forms the dominant part of
the Central Highlands. The part of the Central Highlands which extends to the east of Malwa
Plateau is known as Bundelkhand and is further followed by Baghelkhand and the well known
Chhotanagpur Plateau with large mineral reserves. Chhotanagpur is drained by Damodar river.
The Mahadeo Hills, Kaimur Hills and Maikal Range lie towards further east. The valley of
Narmada has been formed due to the subsidence of the land mass between the Vindhyas and
the Satpuras.
The general elevation of the Central Highlands ranges between 700-1,000 m and it slopes
towards the north and northeastern directions. Most of the tributaries (Chambal, Sind, Betwa,
Ken) of the river Yamuna have their origin in the Vindhyan and Kaimur ranges. Banas, tributary
of the river Chambal, originates from the Aravalli in the west.
The extension of the Peninsular plateau can be seen as far as Jaisalmer in the West, where it
has been covered by the longitudinal sand ridges and crescent-shaped sand dunes called
barchans. Aravallis hills extend from Gujarat, through Rajasthan to Delhi in the northeasterly
direction for a distance of about 700 km till Delhi. The highest peak of the Aravalli hills is
Gurushikhar (1722 m) near Mt. Abu, hill station.
3.3.3. The North-Eastern Plateau
It is an extension of the main Peninsular plateau in the northeast– locally known as the
om

Meghalaya and Karbi-Anglong Plateau. It is separated by Malda fault from the Chotanagpur
l.c

Plateau. Later, this depression got filled up by the deposition activity of the numerous rivers.
ai
tm

The Meghalaya plateau is further sub-divided into three: (i) The Garo Hills; (ii) The Khasi Hills;
ho

(iii) The Jaintia Hills, named after the tribal groups inhabiting this region. An extension of this is
t@
sp

also seen in the Karbi Anglong hills of Assam. Shillong is the highest peak in this plateau.
h.
es

Similar to the Chotanagpur plateau, the Meghalaya plateau is also rich in mineral resources like
ur
ay

coal, iron ore, sillimanite, limestone and uranium. This area receives maximum rainfall from the
m

south west monsoon. As a result, the Meghalaya plateau has a highly eroded surface

3.4. The Indian Desert


The Indian desert lies towards the western margins of the Aravali Hills. It is a land of undulating
topography dotted with longitudinal dunes and barchans. This region receives low rainfall
below 150 mm per year; hence, it has arid climate with low vegetation cover. Low precipitation
and high evaporation makes it a water deficit region. Streams appear during the rainy season.
Luni is the only large river in this region. It is believed that during the Mesozoic era, this region
was under the sea. This can be corroborated by the evidence available at wood fossils park at
Aakal and marine deposits around Brahmsar, near Jaisalmer. Land features present here are
mushroom rocks, shifting dunes and oasis. the desert can be divided into two parts: the
northern part is sloping towards Sindh and the southern towards the Rann of Kachchh.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


127 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

3.5. The Coastal Plains


The Peninsular plateau is flanked by stretch of narrow coastal strips, running along the Arabian
Season the west and the Bay of Bengal on the east.
3.5.1. Western Coastal Plains
West Coastal Plain extends along the Arabian Sea from the Rann of Kutchch in the north to
Kanyakumari in the south. These plains are an example of submerged coastal plain. Because of
this submergence it is a narrow belt and provides natural conditions for the development of
ports and harbours. Kandla, Mazagaon, JLN port Navha Sheva, Marmagao, Mangalore, Cochin,
etc. are important natural ports.
Extending from the Gujarat coast in the north to the Kerala coast in the south, the western
coast may be divided into following divisions – the Kutch and Kathiawar coast in Gujarat,
Konkan coast in Maharashtra, Goan coast and Malabar coast in Karnataka and Kerala
respectively. The plains of Gujarat are made up of black soil. There are a number of long and
narrow lagoons on Malabar Coast. Kochi port is situated on one of the lagoons. These plains are
narrow in the middle and get broader towards north and south. The rivers flowing through this
coastal plain do not form any delta. The Malabar coast has got certain distinguishing features in
the form of ‘Kayals’(backwaters), used for fishing, inland navigation, tourism.
3.5.2. Eastern Coastal Plains
The eastern coastal plain is broader, leveled and is an example of an emergent coast. These
plains are formed by the alluvial fillings. The monotony of plains is broken by the numerous
hills. In the northern part, it is referred to as the Northern Circar, while the southern part is
known as the Coromandal Coast. There are well developed deltas here, formed by rivers
Mahanadi, Krishna, Godavari, Kaveri etc.Lakes such as Chilika, Pulicat, and Kolluru are the
famous lagoons of this plain. Because of its emergent nature, it has less number of ports and
harbours. The continental shelf extends up to 500 km into the sea, which makes it difficult for
om

the development of good ports and harbours. Paradip, Visakhapatnam, Ennor, Chennai,
l.c

Tuticorin are important ports along eastern coast. Rice is the intensively grown here.
ai
tm
ho

3.6. The Islands


t@
sp

There are two major island groups in India – one in the Bay of Bengal and the other in the
h.
es

Arabian Sea.
ur
ay

3.6.1. Andaman and Nicobar Islands


m

The Bay of Bengal island groups consist of about 572 islands/islets. These are situated roughly
between 6°N-14°N and 92°E -94°E (Figure 15a). The entire group of island is divided into two
broad categories – the Andaman in the north and the Nicobar in the south. They are separated
by a water body which is called the Ten degree channel. It is believed that island group is an
extension of submarine mountains. However, some smaller islands are volcanic in origin.
Barren island, the only active volcano in India is also situated here. The coastal line has some
coral deposits, and beautiful beaches. These islands lie close to equator and thus, experience
equatorial climate. The islands have thick forest cover due to heavy convectional rainfall.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


128 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

(a) – Andaman and Nicobar Islands (b) Lakshadweep Islands


Figure 15 – Island groups of India
3.6.2. Lakshadweep Islands
Lakshadweep Islands are situated in the Arabian Sea, at a distance of 280-480km off the coast
of Kerala. These are scattered between 8°N-12°N and 71°E -74°E (Figure 15b). All these islands
are of coral origin. They have been built up by corals. Only 11 out of 36 islands are inhabited.
The largest island among these, the Minicoy, has an area of 4.5 square km only. The entire
group of islands is broadly divided by the Eleventh degree channel, north of which is the Amini
Island and to the south of the Canannore Island. Landform features are storm beaches
consisting of unconsolidated pebbles, shingles, cobbles and boulders.
om

In overall, it would be clear that each region complements the other and makes the country
l.c
ai

richer in its natural resources. The northern mountains are the major sources of water and
tm

forest wealth. The northern plains are the granaries of the country. They provide the base for
ho
t@

early civilisations. The plateau is a storehouse of minerals, which has played a crucial role in the
sp

industrialisation of the country. The coastal region and island groups provide sites for fishing
h.
es

and port activities.


ur
ay

4. Drainage
m

Rivers have always been of supreme importance to man, providing focal points for habitation,
water for cultivation and avenues to travel, water power and recreation. A river or stream is a
body of water flowing in a channel. The term ‘drainage’ describes the river system of an area. It
is an integrated system of a river and its tributaries which collect and funnel surface water to
the sea. The area drained by a single river system is called a drainage basin. The boundary line
separating one drainage basin from the other is known as the watershed. A river drains the
water collected from a specific area, which is called its ‘catchment area’. The catchments of
large rivers are called river basins while those of small rivulets and rills are often referred to as
watersheds. Watersheds are small in area while the basins cover larger areas.

4.1. Drainage Pattern


A geometric arrangement of streams in a region; determined by slope, differing rock resistance
to weathering and erosion, climate, hydrologic variability, and structural controls of the
landscape is known as drainage pattern. The rivers that existed before the upheaval of the

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


129 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Himalayas and cut their courses by making gorges in the mountains are knows as the
antecedent rivers. Indus, Satluj, Ganga are some important antecedent rivers. The rivers which
follow general direction of slope are known as the consequent rivers. Godavari and Krishna etc.
rivers descending from the Western Ghats are some consequent rivers.
The drainage pattern resembling the branches of a tree is known as “dendritic” the examples of
which are the rivers of northern plain. It develops where the river channel follows the slope of
the terrain. When the rivers originate from a hill and flow in all directions, the drainage pattern
is known as ‘radial’. The rivers originating from the Amarkantak range present a good example
of it. When the primary tributaries of rivers flow parallel to each other and secondary
tributaries join them at right angles, the pattern is known as ‘trellis’. It develops where hard
and soft rocks exist parallel to each other. Right bank tributaries of Brahmaputra rivers make
trellis pattern while the left bank tributaries exhibit the

om
l.c
ai
tm

Figure 16–Drainage patterns


ho
t@

dendritic pattern. When the rivers discharge their waters from all directions in a lake or
sp
h.

depression, the pattern is known as ‘centripetal’. It is reverse of radial and occurs in the areas
es

of karst topography. A combination of several patterns may be found in the same drainage
ur
ay

basin.
m

4.2. Drainage System of India


The drainage systems of India are mainly controlled by the broad relief features of the
subcontinent. Indian drainage system may be divided on various bases. On the basis of
discharge of water (orientations to the sea), it may be grouped into: (i) the Arabian Sea
drainage; and (ii) the Bay of Bengal drainage. They are separated from each other through the
Delhi ridge, the Aravalis and the Sahyadris (water divide is shown by a line in Figure 17).Many
rivers have their sources in the Himalayas and discharge their waters in the Bay of Bengal
except Indus river system which discharge into Arabian Sea. Ganga, Yamuna, Gandak, Tista and
Brahmaputra rivers are major example of it.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


130 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

Figure 17 – Water divide between east flowing and west flowing rivers
Large rivers flowing on the Peninsular plateau have their origin in the Western Ghats and
discharge their waters in the Bay of Bengal. Krishna, Godavari, Kaveri, Tungabhadra are some
example of it. The Narmada and Tapi are two large rivers which are exceptions. They along with
many small rivers discharge their waters in the Arabian Sea. These small rivers have origin in
Western Ghats such as Mandavi, Netravati, Sharavati, and Periyar rivers.
Nearly 77 per cent of the drainage area consisting of the Ganga, the Brahmaputra, the
Mahanadi, the Krishna, etc. is oriented towards the Bay of Bengal while 23 per cent comprising
the Indus, the Narmada, the Tapi, the Mahi and the Periyar systems discharge their waters in
the Arabian Sea.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


131 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

Figure 18 – Major river Basins of India


On the basis of mode of origin, the drainage of India may be divided into (i) Himalayan
Drainage; and (ii) Peninsular drainage. However, many of the Peninsular rivers like the Chambal,
Betwa, Ken, Son are tributaries of Ganga river system which originate in Himalayas (figure 17).
On the basis of the size of the watershed, the drainage basins of India are grouped into three
categories: (i) Major river basins with more than 20,000 sq. km of catchment area (figure 18). It
includes 14 drainage basins such as the Ganga, the Indus, the Godavari, the Krishna, the
Brahmaputra, the Mahanadi, the Narmada, the kaveri, the Tapi, the Pennar, the Brahmani, the
Mahi, the Sabarmati, the Barak, the Suvarnarekha; (ii) Medium river basins with catchment area
between 2,000-20,000 sq. km incorporating 44 river basins such as the Kalindi, the Periyar, the
Meghna, etc.; and (iii) Minor river basins with catchment area of less than 2,000 sq. km include
fairly good number of rivers flowing in the area of low rainfall.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


132 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

4.3. The Himalayan Drainage System


The Himalayan drainage system has evolved through a long geological history. There is no
unanimity among geologists about the origin of the Himalayan rivers. However, it is believed
that a mighty river, namely Shiwalik or Indo-Brahma was flowing west from Assam to Sind and
finally discharged into Gulf of Sind during Miocene period. The remarkable continuity of the
Shiwalik and its lacustrine origin and alluvial deposits consisting of sands, silt, clay, boulders and
conglomerates support this viewpoint.
This mighty Shiwalik river was dismembered into three main systems which are now called as
Indus, Ganga and Brahmaputra systems (figure 19).The dismemberment is attributed to
upheaval in the Western Himalayas including uplift of the Potwar Plateau (or Delhi Ridge). This
ridge act as a water divide between Indus and Ganga river systems. Similarly, the down
thrusting of the Malda fault (area between Rajmahal Hills and the Meghalaya Plateau) caused
the Ganga and the Brahamputra systems to flow towards Bay of Bengal. The giant gorges,
sudden bends towards South and other such features are evidence in support that these rivers
are older than the Himalayas.

om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp

Figure 19 – evolution of Himalayan Drainage


h.
es

Currently, Indus, Ganga and Brahamputra with their respective tributaries make major drainage
ur
ay

systems of Himalayas. Since these are fed both by melting of snow and precipitation, rivers of
m

this system are perennial.


4.3.1. Landforms of Himalayan Rivers
The Himalayan rivers are in their youthful stage carving out a number of erosional landforms.
These rivers pass through the giant gorges carved out by the erosional activity carried on
simultaneously with the uplift of the Himalayas. Satluj, Indus forms great gorges near Gilgit and
Sukkur respectively. Besides deep gorges, these rivers also form V-shaped valleys, rapids and
waterfalls in their mountainous course. While entering the plains, they form depositional
features like flat valleys, ox-bow lakes, flood plains, braided channels, and deltas near the river
mouth. In the Himalayan reaches, the course of these rivers is highly tortuous, but over the
plains they display a strong meandering tendency and shift their courses frequently.
4.3.2. The Indus System
The Indus (Sindhu) is one of the most important drainage systems of the Indian subcontinent
and one of the largest in the world. It covers an area of 11, 65,000 sq. km and length of 2,880
km, out of which 321, 289 sqkm area and 1,114 km length is in India. The Indus is the

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


133 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

westernmost of the Himalayan rivers in India. Indus has origin from a glacier near Bokar Chu in
the Kailash Mountain range in the Tibet province of China. In Tibet, it is known as ‘Singi
Khamban; or Lion’s mouth. After flowing in a constricted valley in Tibet, it follows a long, nearly
straight course between the Ladakh and Zaskar ranges in the northwest direction where it
receives Zaskar below Leh town. It cuts across the Ladakh range, forming a spectacular gorge
near Gilgit which is 5200m in height. In this region, transverse glaciers and landslides
periodically dam the river. River passes Nanga Parbat and turns south-west to enter Pakistan
near Chillar in the Dardistan region. In the Jammu and Kashmir, Indus receives a number of
Himalayan tributaries such as the Shyok, the Gilgit, the Hunza, the Nubra, the Shigar, the
Gasting and the Dras. Right bank tributaries such as the Khurram, the Tochi, etc. originate in
Sulaiman ranges. Down in the Punjab province of Pakistan, Indus receives ‘Panjnad’, five rivers
of Punjab, namely the Satluj, the Beas, the Ravi, the Chenab and the Jhelum. River finally drains
into the Arabian Sea, east of Karachi city. These rivers do not meet Indus separately but as a
single river.
The Jhelum (Vitasta) rises from a spring at Verinag Spring situated at the foot of the Pir Panjal. It
flows through Srinagar and the Wular lake before entering Pakistan through a deep narrow
gorge. It joins the Chenab in Pakistan. It is the most important river of Kashmir.
The Chenab (Asikni) flows in India for about 1180km draining around 26,755 sqkm area. It is the
largest tributary of the Indus. It is formed by two streams, the Chandra and the Bhaga, which
join at Tandi near Keylong in Himachal Pradesh. Hence, it is also known as Chandrabhaga. Major
hydro power plants installed in Chenab are Salal, Baghliar, and Dulhasti.
The Ravi (Parushni) river flows for about 725 km and drains 6000 sqkm area in India. It rises
near the Rohtang Pass in Kullu hills in Himachal Pradesh, very close to the source of the Beas
river. It flows through the famous Chamba valley. It drains an area lying between Pir Panjal and
Dhauladhar ranges. It also cuts a gorge in Dhaula Dhar range. In plains of Punjab, it runs along
the Indo-Pak border and joins Chenab near Sarai Sidhu in Pakistan.
om

The Beas (Vipasa) river originates from the Beas Kund near the Rohtang Pass at an elevation of
l.c

4,000 m. The river flows through the Kullu valley and forms gorges at Kati and Largi in the
ai
tm

Dhaula Dhar range. Further down, it flows through the Kangra valley. It enters the Punjab plains
ho

where it meets the Satluj near Harike in India’s Punjab. Indira Gandhi Canal that feeds western
t@
sp

Rajasthan has origin at Harike, confluence of Beas and Satluj.


h.
es

The Satluj (Satadru) river rises from the Rakas Lake near Mansarovar (4,555m) in Tibet. This is
ur
ay

an antecedent river. It flows almost parallel to the Indus for about 400 km before entering India,
m

and comes out of a gorge across the Great Himalayas. It passes through the Shipki La (4300 m)
on the Himalayan ranges at India-China border. It cuts the Zaskar ranges, Dhaula Dhar range,
Shiwalik and finally enters the Punjab plains. It feeds the canal system of the Bhakra Nangal
project.
The Ghaggar (Saraswati) is an inland drainage which rises in the talus fan of the Shiwalik near
Ambala, Haryana. After entering the plains, it disappears but reappears at Karnal. Further on,
the stream disappears near Hanumargarh in Bikaner. It is believed that it is an old tributary of
the Indus.
4.3.3. The Ganga System
The Ganga is the most important river of India both from the point of view of its basin and
cultural significance. The river has a length of 2,525 km. It is the largest river basin in India with
about one-fourth area of the country under it. It rises in the Gangotri glacier near Gaumukh
(3,900 m) in the Uttarakhand where it is known as the Bhagirathi. At Devprayag, the Bhagirathi
meets the Alaknanda and both makes Ganga. The Alaknanda consists of the Dhauli and the

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


134 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Vishnu Ganga which meet at Vishnuprayag. Pindar joins Alaknanda at Karnaprayag while
Mandakini meets it at Rudraprayag. At Haridwar, Ganga enters into plains. Further on, it moves
in west-east direction and split into two distributaries, namely the Bhagirathi and the Hugli in
Bengal. Along with Brahmaputra, it makes largest delta of the world. The Ganga river is having a
number of perennial and non-perennial rivers originating in the Himalayas in the north and the
Peninsula in the south, respectively. It flows through major cities of India – Kanpur, Allahabad,
Patna, and Kolkata.
The Yamuna river, the western most and the longest tributary of the Ganga, has its source in the
Yamunotri glacier on the western slopes of Banderpunch range (6,316 km). It flows parallel to
Ganga and finally meets the same at Allahabad (Prayag). The right bank tributaries involves the
Chambal, the Sind, the Betwa and the Ken which originates in the Peninsular plateau while the
Hindan, the Rind, the Sengar, the Varuna, etc. join it on its left bank. It is a major source to feed
the canals of Haryana and Uttar Pradesh. It flows through cities such as Karnal, Delhi, and Agra.
The Gandak river comprises two streams, namely Kaligandak and Trishulganga. It rises in the
Nepal Himalayas between Dhaluagiri and Mt. Everest. It enters the Ganga Plains of India in
Champaran, Bihar and joins Ganga at Sonpur near Patna. This river changes its course
frequently.
The Ghaghara originates in the glaciers of Mapchachungo. It comes out of the mountain,
cutting a deep gorge at Shishapani. The river Sarda joins it in the plain before it finally meets
the Ganga at Chhapra. It flows through famous Ayodhya town.
The Ramganga is the first major tributary to join the Ganga from its left near Kannauj. It rises in
the Garhwal hills near Gairsain. A large dam has been built on this river near Kalagarh.
The Damodar drains the eastern parts of the Chotanagpur Plateau where it flows through a rift
valley and finally joins the Hugli at Falta. The Barakar is its main tributary. Once known as the
‘sorrow of Bengal’, the Damodar has been now tamed by the Damodar Valley Corporation, a
multipurpose project.
om
l.c

The Chambal rises near Mhow in the Malwa plateau from Vindhyan range and flows
ai
tm

northwards through a gorge up wards of Kota in Rajasthan. From Kota, it traverses down to
ho

Bundi, Sawai Madhopur and Dholpur, and finally joins the Yamuna at Etawah. The Chambal is
t@

famous for its badland topography called the Chambal ravines. Ravines are being reclaimed for
sp
h.

agricultural and pastoral activities. Banas river is its main tributary. The main dams across the
es
ur

river are Gandhi Sagar (Kota), Rana Pratap Sagar and Jawahar Sagar.
ay
m

The Son originates from the Amarkantak plateau. It has length of 780km and drains areas of
around 54,000 sqkm. After forming a series of waterfall at the edge of plateau, it reaches Arrah,
west of Patna to join the Ganga.
The Sarda or Saryu river rises in the Milan glacier in the Nepal Himalayas where it is known as
the Goriganga. Along the Indo-Nepal border, it is called Kali or Chauk, where it joins the
Ghaghara. The Mahananda is another important tributary of the Ganga rising in the Darjiling
hills. It joins the Ganga as its last left bank tributary in West Bengal.
4.3.4. The Brahmaputra System
The Brahmaputra is one of the largest river of not only India but the world. Its total length is
2900km and basin area is 5,80,000 sqkm (916 km and 1,87,00 sqkm in India). Its origin is in the
Chemayungdung glacier of the Kailash range near the Mansarovar lake. From here, it flows
parallel to the Greater Himalayas in the dry and flat Tibetan region where it is known as
Tsangpo. It emerges as a turbulent and dynamic river after carving out a deep gorge in the
Central Himalayas near Namcha Barwa (7,755 m). The river emerges from the foothills under

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


135 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

the name of Siang or Dihang. It enters India west of Sadiya town in Arunachal Pradesh. It
receives its main left bank tributaries, viz., Dibang or Sikang and Lohit; thereafter, it is known as
the Brahmaputra.
In the Assam valley, its major left bank tributaries are the Burhi Dihing, Dhansari (South) and
Kalang whereas the important right bank tributaries are the Subansiri, Kameng, Manas and
Sankosh. The Brahmaputra enters into Bangladesh near Dhubri and flows southward. In
Bangladesh, the Tista joins it on its right bank from where the river is known as the Yamuna.
The Brahmaputra is well-known for floods, channel shifting and bank erosion. This is due to the
fact that most of its tributaries are large, and bring large quantity of sediments owing to heavy
rainfall in the region

4.4. The Peninsular Drainage System


The Peninsular drainage system is older than the Himalayan one. This is evident from the broad,
largely-graded shallow valleys, and the maturity of the rivers. Rivers follow the relief pattern of
the plateau. Except for the rivers flowing through fault valleys, the slope of all rivers is very
gentle.
4.4.1. Evolution of Peninsular Drainage System
Three major geological events in the distant past have shaped the present drainage systems of
Peninsular India: (i) Subsidence of the western flank of the Peninsula leading to its
submergence below the sea during the early tertiary period. Generally, it has disturbed the
symmetrical plan of the river on either side of the original watershed. Earlier the area to the
west of the Western ghats was also a landmass in ancient times. At that time, rivers flowed in
both directions from the water divide formed by the Ghats and there was a symmetrical
distribution of rivers. (ii) Upheaval of the Himalayas when the northern flank of the Peninsular
block was subjected to subsidence and the consequent trough faulting. The Narmada and The
Tapi flow in trough faults and fill the original cracks with their detritus materials. Hence, there is
om

a lack of alluvial and deltaic deposits in these rivers. (iii) Slight tilting of the Peninsular block
l.c

from northwest to the southeastern direction gave orientation to the entire drainage system
ai
tm

towards the Bay of Bengal during the same period.


ho

4.4.2. River Systems


t@
sp
h.

The Western Ghats situated near the western coast form the major water divide between the
es

major Peninsular rivers, discharging their water in the Bay of Bengal and as small rivulets joining
ur
ay

the Arabian Sea. Except Narmada and Tapi, all major rivers flow in east direction. The other
m

major river systems of the Peninsular drainage are – the Mahanadi the Godavari, the Krishna
and the Kaveri. Peninsular rivers are characterised by fixed course, absence of meanders and
ephemeral flow of water. The Narmada and the Tapi which flow through the rift valley are,
however, exceptions. Peninsular rivers receive water from Southwest monsoon and Tamil Nadu
rivers gets water from retreating or northeast monsoon also.
4.4.3. East Flowing Rivers
The Mahanadi rises near Sihawa, Amarkantak hills in the highlands of Chhattisgarh and runs
through Orissa to discharge its water into the Bay of Bengal. It is 851 km long and its catchment
area spreads over 1.42 lakh sq. km. Some navigation is carried on in the lower course of this
river. Deltaic stretch of this river is part of National Waterways 5(NW5).
The Godavari is the largest Peninsular river. It rises from the slopes of the Western Ghats in the
Nasik district of Maharashtra. It is also called Dakshinganga. It is 1,465 km long with a
catchment area spreading over 3.13 lakh sq. km 49 per cent of this, lies in Maharashtra. The
Penganga, the Indravati, the Pranhita, and the Manjra are its principal tributaries. It forms a

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


136 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

picturesque gorge in Eastern Ghats. The Godavari is subjected to heavy floods in its lower
reaches. It is navigable only in the deltaic stretch. The river after Rajamundri splits into several
branches forming a large delta.
The Krishna is the second largest east-flowing Peninsular river which rises from a spring near
Mahabaleshwar. Its total length is 1,401 km. The Koyna, the Tungbhadra and the Bhima are its
major tributaries. Its drainage basin is shared by Maharashtra, Karnataka and Andhra Pradesh.
The Kaveri rises in Brahmagiri hills (1,341m) of Kogadu district in Karnataka. Its length is 800 km
and it drains an area of 81,155 sq. km. Since the upper catchment area receives rainfall during
the southwest monsoon season (summer) and the lower part during the northeast monsoon
season (winter), the river carries water throughout the year. It flows into the Bay of Bengal at
Kaveripatnam. It drains parts of Tamil Nadu, Karnataka and Kerala. Its important tributaries are
the Kabini, the Bhavani and the Amravati.
The Brahmani and the Subernarekha rivers drain a part of area between the Ganga and the
Mahanadi into the Bay of Bengal. Their drainage area extends over parts of Bihar, Odisha, West
Bengal and Madhya Pradesh. It supplies water to the Tata steel plant at Jamshedpur.
4.4.4. West Flowing Rivers
The Narmada originates on the western flank of the Amarkantak plateau at a height of about
1,057 m. Flowing in a rift valley between the Satpura in the south and the Vindhyan range in
the north, it forms a picturesque gorge in marble rocks and Dhuandhar waterfall near Jabalpur.
It meets the Arabian Sea south of Bharuch, forming a broad 27 km long estuary. Its length is
1312 km and catchment area of 98,796 sqkm. All the tributaries are very short and make trellis
pattern. The Sardar Sarovar Project has been constructed on this river. Narmada has been
joined with other Gujarat rivers to shift its water.
The Tapi is the other important westward flowing river. It originates from Multai in the Betul
district of Madhya Pradesh and discharge in Surat district, Gujarat. It is 724 km long and drains
om

an area of 65,145 sq. km. The Purna, Girna and Panjhra are its important tributaries.
l.c
ai

Luni is the largest river system of Rajasthan, west of Aravali. It originates near Pushkar in two
tm

branches, i.e. the Saraswati and the Sabarmati, which join with each other at Govindgarh. It
ho
t@

flows towards the west till Telwara and then takes a southwest direction to join the Rann of
sp

Kutch.
h.
es
ur

The Mahi river rises in the Satmala hills of the Vindhyan mountains. After flowing for 533km, it
ay

drains into the Gulf of Khambhat. The Sabarmati riverrises in the Aravalli hills and flows into
m

Arabian Sea after flowing over a distance of 300km.


Small west flowing rivers are numerous which rises in the Western Ghats and have short runoff.
The Shetruniji is one such river which rises near Dalkahwa in Amreli district. The Bhadra
originates near Aniali village in Rajkot district. The Dhadhar rises near Ghantar village in
Panchmahal district. The Vaitarna rises from the Trimbak hills in Nasik district at an elevation of
670 m. The Kalinadi rises from Belgaum district and falls in the Karwar Bay. The Sharavati is
another important river in Karnataka flowing towards the west. The Sharavati originates in
Shimoga district of Karnataka. Goa has two important rivers which can be mentioned here. One
is Mandovi and the other is Juari. The longest river of Kerala, Bharathapuzha rises near
Annamalai hills. It is also known as Ponnani. It drains an area of 5,397 sq. km. The Periyar is the
second largest river of Kerala. Its catchment area is 5,243 sq. km.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


137 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

4.5. Comparison Between Himalayan and Peninsular Rivers


Difference between the rivers rising in the Himalayas and those rising in the Peninsular plateau
are primarily a result of the differences between the two areas in terms of relief and climate.
Following table shows major differences between these two groups.
S.N. Aspects Himalayan River Peninsular River
1 Place of Himalayan mountain covered with Peninsular plateau and central
Origin glaciers highland
2 Nature of Perennial Ephemeral
flow
3 Type of Antecedent and Consequent Super imposed, rejuvenated
drainage leading to dendritic pattern resulting in trellis, radial and
rectangular
Patterns
4 Nature of Long course, flowing through the Smaller, fixed course with well-
river rugged mountains experiencing adjusted valleys;
headward erosion and river
capturing;
In plains meandering and shifting
of
Course;
5 Catchment Very large basins Relatively smaller basin
area
6 Age of the Young, active and deepening of Old rivers with graded profile and
river valley lateral erosion
7 Irrigation Flows through plains and canal Flows over uneven plateau; canals
system only in deltaic region
8 Hydro- Eastern region has very high Natural waterfalls for generating
om
l.c

electricity potential and large dams are electricity


ai

building up
tm
ho

4.6. National River Linking Project


t@
sp
h.

The idea of linking water surplus Himalayan rivers with water scarce parts of western and
es
ur

peninsular India has been doing the rounds for the past 150 years. The rivers of India carry huge
ay

volumes of water per year but it is unevenly distributed both in time and space. There are
m

perennial rivers carrying water throughout the year while the non-perennial rivers have very
little water during the dry season. During the rainy season, much of the water is wasted in
floods and flows down to the sea. Similarly, when there is a flood in one part of the country, the
other area suffers from drought. Such linkage is said to provide major benefits such as
irrigation, assured drinking water, flood and draught prevention, generation of electricity, and
inland navigation. Nevertheless, project is facing several challenges in its implementation.
Project involves hundreds of billions of dollars that India could not afford. Water shortage
Peninsular plateau has higher altitude compare to water surplus Ganges plains. Carrying water
to higher level required either electricity to pump water or create chain of deep channels which
seems very difficult in rocky Peninsular. Project will have to acquire lakhs of hectares of land. It
will affect the ecosystem(submergence of forest land, deforestation, flora and fauna) and
rehabilitation issue of lakhs of displaced persons.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


138 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Figure 20 – Inter-linking of rivers


Ironically, rivers of northern plains have water surplus during or just after monsoon. This time
Peninsular rivers also have sufficient water. While the water availability in the southern rivers
may be increased, the main reason why such project is not being put to implementation is the
om

apprehension of future water shortage in the Northern plains as a result of Climate change,
l.c
ai

whose effects are now not known. Shifting huge quantity of water would have affect on heat
tm
ho

balance of Indian subcontinent which may affect monsoon pattern and intensity also. It will also
t@

affect the temperature and salinity of Bay of Bengal water near Bengal region.
sp
h.

NDA government's proposal of river interlinking met with stiff opposition from several quarters.
es
ur

The Supreme Court cleared the river-linking project. A group of citizens has filed review petition
ay

in the Supreme Court. Recent report of planning commission also does not support the project
m

due to environmental and monsoon issues. Rivers linkage crosses political boundaries of states.
Consensus among states is another challenge.
Linkage at small scale is feasible and few links of this river projects are under analysis or under
construction. For instance, many links in Gujarat are connected. Five Peninsular links namely (i)
Ken – Betwa, (ii) Parbati – Kalisindh – Chambal, (iii) Damanganga – Pinjal, (iv) Par – Tapi –
Narmada & (v) Godavari (Polavaram) - Krishna (Vijayawada) have been identified as priority
links for taking up their Detailed Project Reports (DPRs) by ministry of water resources in 2012.
DPR of one priority link namely Ken-Betwa has been completed and was communicated to the
party states. Solution envisaged in the 12thfive year plan is the water management. Locally
available water needs to be managed with proper conservation techniques and by use of best
available technologies in agriculture, industry with full incentive to be given for recycling of
water.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


139 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

4.7. National Waterways


An efficient transport sector is vital for development of the economy of any country. Compare
to European countries, China etc., India has poor performance in using Inland river navigation
for goods

om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

Figure 21 – NATIONAL WATERWAYS (NWS) OF INDIA


transportation. Inland Water Transport (IWT) is a fuel efficient, environment friendly and cost
effective mode of transport. Currently, there are five national waterways(NW) and sixth is being
under consideration(figure 21). Following is the details of NWs:
NW1 is from Allahabad to Haldia with total length of 1620 kms. It is being used by tourism
vessels, ODC carriers, IWAI vessels. Many coal based plants are located along Ganga and thus,
are potential revenue source for inland navigation sector. NW2 waterways is from Sadiya town
in Assam to Dhubri at Bangladesh border with total length of 891 km. it is used by tourism
vessels, Border security forces, Assam government, and private vessels. NW3 waterway involves
multiple canals on the western coast. It involves West coast canal(168km), Udyogmandal
canal(23km), and Champakara canal (14km). It is one of the most navigable and tourism
potential area in India. Raw material for fertilizer plants is major part of movement. Similarly,
NW4 waterway involves Kakinada-Puducherry canala (767km), Godavari river (171 km), and

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


140 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Krishna river (157 km). Coal on Godavari river, Cement on Krishna river and rice on both rivers,
and other such food commodities are major transport on this waterway. NW5 waterway
consists of stretches such as Mahanadi Delta(101km), Brahmani and others (265km), Matai
river(40km) and Geonkhali-Charbatia(217km). Coal is the major commodity on transportation
here. Declaration of Barak river from Bhanga to Lakhipur (121 km) in the State of Assam as
National Waterway is under consideration of Govt. Budget 2013 stressed on waterways
connectivity for northeast India. Poor maintenance of NW is a major challenge for the
government. Inland water navigation is cheaper as compared to other transport modes but
does not get same level of subsidy by the government for transporting various commodities
such as PDS food etc.

5. Soil
Soil constitutes a major element in the natural environment, linking climate and vegetation, and
they have a profound effect on man’s activities through their relative fertility. It is a valuable
resource and the most important layer of the earth’s crust. Soils are very much dynamic entities
in which physical, chemical and biological activities are continually taking place.

5.1. Soil Properties


Soil is the mixture of rock debris and organic materials which develop on the earth’s surface. It
contains matter in all three states: solid, liquid and gaseous. The solid portion is partly organic
and partly inorganic. The inorganic part is made up of particles derived from the parent
material, the rocks which weather to form the soil. The organic portion consists of living and
decayed plant and animal materials such as roots and worms. Soil water is a dilute but complex
chemical solution derived from direct precipitation and from run-off, and groundwater. The soil
atmosphere fills the pore spaces of the soil when these are not occupied by water. Soil
atmosphere and water are present in inverse proportion to each other. The actual amounts of
each of these components depend upon the type of soil.
om

The Texture of a soil refers to the sizes of the solid particles composing the soil. The sizes range
l.c

from clay (less than 0.002mm) to gravel (more than 2mm). The proportions of the different
ai
tm

sizes present vary from soil to soil and from layer to layer. Texture largely determines the water-
ho

retention properties of soil. Loam texture is best for plant growth (figure 22(i)).
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


141 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

(i) Soil textural classes (ii) Four basic soil structures


Figure 22 – soil texture and structure
The soil structure is the way the soil particles are arranged. Because of cementing action of ions
in the soil, individual particles in a soil tend to aggregate together in lumps. According to the
shape of the lumps, soils can be described as having a platy, prismatic, crumby and Granular
structure (figure 22(ii)). The presence of humus helps the formation of a crump structure. The
soil structure has an important bearing on its east of cultivation. Soils with a crumb structure
are best for seed germination. Forking, raking, ploughing and harrowing are few techniques to
om

improve the soil structure.


l.c

Soil colloids - tiny particles with unusual chemical properties – may be organic (very finely
ai
tm

divided humus) or mineral (minute thin flakes called clay mineral). Together, the two types
ho
t@

make up a clay-humus complex. Clay minerals have a vast surface area in relation to their
sp

weight and are net negatively charged. This is invariably neturalised by the attraction to their
h.
es

surface of positively charged ions (cations) of calcium, magnesium, potassium and sodium
ur

(bases). They are only held loosely in an exchangeable position by the clay minerals and may be
ay
m

given up in the process of exchange to plants in forms of nutrients which require them for
growth. These cations are generally replaced by hydrogen ions. Over a period of time, this
process makes soil more acid, unless the bases are replenished in some way. It is possible
naturally with decomposition of animals and plants or artificially in form of fertilizer.
Soil acidity is a property related to the proportion of exchangeable hydrogen in the soil in
relation to other elements. A pH value of about 6.5 is normally regarded as the most favourable
for the growth of cereal crops.
Colour varies considerably in soil and can tell us much about how a soil is formed and what it is
made of. In recently formed soils, the colour will largely reflect that of the parent material, but
in many other cases, the colour is different from the underlying rocks. Soils can range from
white to black, usually depending on the amount of humus. In cool humid areas, most soils
contain relatively high humus content and are generally black or dark brown, wheras in desert
or semi-desert areas, little humus is present and soils are light brown or grey. Reddish colours in
soills are associated with the presence of ferric compounds and usually soil is well drained. In
humid climates, grayish colours relect poor drainage conditions.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


142 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

5.2. Soil Horizons


A vertical section of soil from the surface down to the bedrock consisting of many layers is
collectively known as soil profile. These different sections are called soil horizons. We can easily
observe different horizons in a mine or roads dug under the ground. The recognition of
different soil horizons is based on the physical and chemical characteristics of soils. Scientists
have divided the soil into three main horizons (figure 23). ‘Horizon A’ is the topmost zone,
where organic materials have got incorporated with the mineral matter, nutrients and water,
which are necessary for the growth of plants. ‘Horizon B’ is a transition zone between the
‘Horizon A’ and ‘Horizon C’, and contains matter derived from below as well as from above. It
has some organic matter in it, although the mineral matter is noticeably weathered. ‘Horizon C’
is composed of the loose parent material. This layer is the first stage in the soil formation
process and eventually forms the above two layers. Underneath these three horizons is the rock
which is also known as the parent rock or the bedrock.

om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

Figure 23 – cross section of Soil profile along a tree

5.3. Soil Forming Factors


There are five main factors which controls the operation of soil processes, namely (i) parent
material; (ii) topography; (iii) climate; (iv)biological activity; and (v) time. Climate and biological
activity active control factors while Time, Topography and Parent Material are passive control
factors. Active factors are those which supply energy that acts on the mass for the purpose of
soil formation.
Parent Material
Parent material can be any in-situ or on-site weathered rock debris or transported deposits. Soil
formation depends upon the texture, structure as well as the mineral and chemical composition
of the rock debris. Nature, rate and depth of weathering are important considerations under
parent materials. There may be differences in soil over similar bedrock and dissimilar soils

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


143 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

above them. Generally young soils or the lowermost horizon shows similarity with the parent
material. Ultimately, parent material’s effect is seen through the texture and fertility. For
instance, soils of limestone area show clear relation with the parent rock.
Topography
The influence of topography is felt through the amount of exposure of a surface to sunlight,
drainage condition, and slope angle etc. In middle latitudes pole-facing slopes may have slightly
different soil conditions from equator-facing slopes due to poor exposure to sunlight. Soils on
hillsides tend to be much better drained than those in valleys, where gleying may take place.
The susceptibility of soil to erosion increases with gradient, and soils on steep slopes are
normally thinner than those on flat sites.
Climate
This factor has a major influence in governing the rate and type of soil formation, particularly
through precipitation in terms of its intensity, frequency, duration; and temperature in terms of
seasonal and diurnal variations. The effect of temperature is to influence the rate of chemical
and biological reactions. In cool climates, bacterial action is relatively slow while in tropics,
bacteria thrive. Soil of hot tropical region show deeper profiles as compared to soils of cold
tundra region. Although the leaf fall in tropical forest is great, much of this is consumed and
translocated down the soil profile. This is the reason why soil in tropical forests is poor in
nutrients. It is the net precipitation (after subtracting evapo transpiration) that works on the
soil.
Biological Activity
The vegetative cover and organism that occupy the parent materials from the start to later
stages help in adding organic matter, moisture retention, nitrogen (nitrogen fixation by
bacterias such as Rhizobium) etc. Dead plants provide humus. Some organic acids which form
during humification aid in decomposing the minerals of the soil parent materials. Humus
accumulates in cold climate as bacterial growth is low and thus layers of peat develop in sub-
om

arctic and tundra climates.


l.c
ai

The organisms affecting soil development range from microscopic bacteria to large mammals,
tm

including man. Besides providing much of the humus, vegetation influences the soil in several
ho
t@

other ways. By intercepting direct rainfall and binding the soil with roots, plants check soil
sp

erosion. They counteract percolation by transpiration, reducing the effectiveness of the rainfall.
h.
es

They also help in maintaining the fertility of soil by brining bases (calcium, Magnesium) from
ur

the lower parts of the soil into stems and leaves, and then releasing them into the upper soil
ay
m

horizons. A change in vegetation may cause a change in soil.


The influence of animals on soils is both mechanical and chemical. For example, earthworms
rework the soil by burrowing and also change its texture and chemical composition by passing it
through their digestive systems. Equally, soil characteristics closely determine the type of
animal present in the soil.
Time
Generally, the length of time the soil forming processes operate, determines maturation of soils
and profile development. However, it is difficult to be precise about the role of time in soil
formation, since soils vary greatly in their rates of development. On porous materials such as
sandstones, soil formation is much more rapid than on impermeable materials, at least initially.
On glacial hills, a few hundred years may be enough to form a soil; on dense basalt very much
longer is likely to be required. Renewed evolution takes place in soils when climate or other
factors change, causing the soil to adjust. In practice, many soils in mid-latitude regions are
polycyclic.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


144 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

5.4. Soil Classification


Soil is not found same everywhere. A soil of one place is different from that of the other. Early
classifications followed biological principles to group soils. One of the most important
classifications of soils has been the zonal system. This was proposed by Russian pedologists who
recognized the strong relationship between climate, vegetation and soil zones throughout the
world. Three main classes of soil are recognized.
Zonal soils are those that are well developed and reflect the influence of climate as the major
soil-forming factor. They can be subdivided into podzol soils, Tundra soils, brown earth,
Ferralsol, Chernozem, Chestnut and Prairie soils. Sierozem of desertic and semi-desertic areas is
extreme form of chestnut.
Intrazonal types are well-developed soils formed where some local factor such as parent
material, terrain or age is dominant. They can be subdivided into Calcimorphic soil(on
calcareous parent material), Halomorphic soils(saline), and Hydromorphic soil (marshes,
swamps or poorly drained upland).
Azonal soils are those that are immature or poorly developed. It lacks a B-horizon. Thus, A-
horizon likes immediately above the C-horizon of weathered parent material. This may
happened because of characteristics of parent material or nature of terrain or simply the lack of
time for development. It is commonplace on active flood plains, volcanic soils, newly deposited
glacial drift, windblown sand, marine mud-flats. Azonal soils are subdivided into Lithosol
(erosion removes soil almost as fast as it is formed on steep slopes), Regosol (dry and loose
dune sands) and alluvial soils(regular supply of sediments).
5.4.1. Soil Classification in India
In ancient times, soils used to be classified into two main groups – Urvara and Usara, which
were fertile and sterile, respectively. The National Bureau of Soil Survey and the Land Use
Planning an Institute under the control of the Indian Council of Agricultural Research (ICAR) did
om

a lot of studies on Indian soils. ICAR has classified Indian soils into eight types on the basis of
l.c

their formation, colour, composition and location. These are described shortly below.
ai
tm
ho

• Alluvial Soil – it is formed by rivers by depositing sediments brought from the mountains.
t@

The new alluvium is called Khadar while older deposited one is called Bangar. Khadar is
sp
h.

renewed annually with fresh floods. Alluvial soils are most widespread in the northern
es

plains and the covers about 40 per cent of the total area of the country. Through a narrow
ur
ay

corridor in Rajasthan, they extend into the plains of Gujarat. In the Peninsular region, they
m

are found in deltas of the east coast and in the river valleys. These soils are more loamy and
clayey in the lower and middle Ganga plain and the Brahamaputra valley. The sand content
decreases from the west to east. They are generally rich in potash but poor in phosphorous.
Alluvial soils are intensively cultivated.
• Black Soil – it is formed from the volcanic lava. On account of high iron content and humus
it is of black colour. It is also known as the Regur soil or black cotton soil. It covers most of
the Deccan Plateau. In the upper reaches of the Godavari and the Krishna, and the north
western part of the Deccan Plateau, the black soil is very deep. Black soil is spread over 5.18
lakh sqkm area of the country. These soils are known for their ‘self ploughing’ nature. The
black soils are generally clayey, deep and impermeable. They swell and become sticky when
wet and shrink when dried. So, during the dry season, these soils develop wide cracks. the
black soil retains the moisture for a very long time, which helps the crops, especially, the
rain fed ones, to sustain even during the dry season.
• Red and Yellow Soil – it is formed from weathering of crystalline granite (igneous rocks) and
gneiss (metamorphic rocks) in areas of low rainfall in the eastern and southern part of the

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


145 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Deccan plateau. Along the piedmont zone of the Western Ghat, long stretch of area is
occupied by red loamy soil. The soil develops a reddish colour due to a wide diffusion of
iron in crystalline and metamorphic rocks. It looks yellow when it occurs in a hydrated form.
They are generally rich in minerals like Iron, lime and potash but poor in nitrogen,
phosphorous and humus.
• Laterite Soil – it is formed under specific monsoon conditions of climate. The dry season
after rainfall is one of the speciality of monsoon climate. Under such conditions, leaching of
soils is accelerated. This process reduces the silica content of rocks in soils leaving the soil
rich in iron and aluminum content. Humus content of the soil is removed fast by bacteria
that thrive well in high temperature. These soils are poor in organic matter, nitrogen,
phosphate and calcium, while iron oxide and potash are in excess. Hence, laterites are not
suitable for cultivation; however, application of manures and fertilizers are required for
making the soils fertile for cultivation. Red laterite soils in Tamil Nadu, Andhra Pradesh and
Kerala are more suitable for tree crops like cashewnut. Laterite soils are widely cut as bricks
for use in house construction.
• Arid Soil – in the deserts, accelerated weathering of rocks take place on account of heating
during day and cooling during night. In this type of soil mainly sand grains are found with
little or no humus. In some areas, the salt content is so high that common salt is obtained
by evaporating the saline water. It has also less capacity to hold moisture. Its colour varies
from red to brown. Nitrogen is insufficient and the phosphate content is normal. Arid soils
are characteristically developed in western Rajasthan and semi-arid type in southern
Punjab and Haryana.
om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

Figure 24 – Major Soil types of India

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


146 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

• Forest Soil – it is formed in the mountain ranges of Himalayas, Purvanchal, Sahaydri etc.
where sufficient rainfall is available. Soil is loamy and silty on valley sides and coarse-
grained in the upper slopes. The lower valleys soil is fertile. On steep slopes, soil is very thin
and less productive. This soil is spread over approximately 3 lakh sqkm area of the country.
• Saline Soil or Usara Soil – it contain a larger proportion of sodium, potassium and
magnesium, and thus, they are infertile, and do not support any vegetative growth. They
have more salts, largely because of dry climate and poor drainage. Their structure ranges
from sandy to loamy. They lack in nitrogen and calcium. They are found in arid and semi-
arid regions, western Gujarat, deltas of the eastern coast and in Sunderban areas of West
Bengal. Seawater intrusions in the deltas promote the occurrence of saline soils. In the
areas of intensive cultivation with excessive use of irrigation, especially in areas of green
revolution, the fertile alluvial soils are becoming saline. In such areas, especially in Punjab
and Haryana, farmers are advised to add gypsum to solve the problem of salinity in the soil.
• Peaty and Marshy Soil – it is found in areas of heavy rainfall and high humidity such as
Kerala, Odisha, Bengal, Coastal areas of Tamil Nadu. Large quantity of dead organic matter
accumulates in these areas, and this gives a rich humus and organic content to the soil.
Organic matter in these soils may go even up to 40-50 per cent. The vegetation grows very
dense in these areas. At many places, they are alkaline also due to presence of salt.

5.5. Soil Degradation


In simple terms, soil degradation is defined as the decline in the soil quality or the soil fertility. It
can happen either by declining share of nutrients or low population of micro-organism in the
soil such as earthworms or change in soil structure or change in pH (alkinity) or addition of toxic
elements and pollutants etc. For instance, animals walking on the land or human removing
upper layers of soil may results into soil degradation. Soil degradation is the main factor leading
to the depleting soil resource base in India. The degree of soil degradation varies from region to
region according to the topography, wind, precipitation and anthropogenic factors. Soil
degradation includes soil erosion, physical deterioration, chemical deterioration and biological
om

deterioration.
l.c
ai
tm

5.6. Soil Erosion


ho
t@

It is the removal of soil at a greater rate than its replacement by natural agencies. Soil forming
sp

and erosional processes go on simultaneously. When the balance between these two different
h.
es

processes is disturbed by natural or human factors, result into net removal of soil. Some soil
ur
ay

erosion occurs without the intervention of human activities but the latter often accelerates the
m

natural processes, e.g. vegetation clearance, over-grazing, some land-drainage schemes.


Problem of soil erosion increases with pressure of increasing population on the land. Natural
vegetation is cleared for agricultural, pastoral and construction activities.
Topography, rainfall, wind, lack of vegetation cover, land use practices etc. are the causes of soil
erosion. The rugged topography and steep slopes affect soil erosion rate through its
morphological characteristics. Two of these, namely gradient and slope length, are essential
components in quantitative relationships for estimating soil loss. Erosion increases dramatically
because the increased angle facilitates water flow and soil movement.
Two main elements of climate – wind and rainfall – are powerful agents of soil erosion. Erosive
processes are set in motion by the energy transmitted from either rainfall or wind or a
combination of these forces. Wind erosion is significant in arid and semi-arid regions. Regions
with heavy rainfall have dominance of water in erosional processes. Removal may be in the
form of splash erosion, Sheet wash, Rill erosion, gullying erosion (figure 25). Splash erosion is
the first stage in soil erosion and it occurs when raindrop hit bare soil. Sheet erosion, takes
place on level of lands after a heavy shower, removes finer and fertile top soil. Gullies cut the

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


147 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

agricultural lands into small fragments and make them unfit for cultivation. Chambal region of
central India is infamous for its ravines (large number of deep gullies).

Figure 25 – Gully erosion


The lowest soil erosion rate is found in undisturbed forests. However, once forest land is
converted to agriculture, erosion rates increase because of vegetation removal, over-grazing,
and tilling. Vegetation cover reduces erosion. Living and dead plant biomass reduces soil
erosion by intercepting and dissipating raindrops and wind energy. Plant roots physically bind
particles, thus stabilising the soil and increasing its resistance to erosion. The uptake of water by
plant roots also depletes the soil water content and thereby further increases infiltration rates.
Land use practices such as agricultural and pastoral activities are causes of soil erosion.
Croplands are vulnerable because the soil is repeatedly tilled and left without a protective cover
of vegetation. Excessive grazing by animals lead to poor vegetation cover and thus, enhances
om

wind and water-led soil erosion processes. Over-irrigation results into removal of top nutrient
l.c

soil with excess water. It also brings salts to the surface and destroys fertility. Without proper
ai
tm

humus, addition of chemical fertilizer hardens the soil.


ho

5.7. Soil Management


t@
sp
h.

Soil management is not a single and straight process. It concerns all operations, practices that
es
ur

are used to maintain the quality of soil. If soil erosion and exhaustion are caused by humans; by
ay

corollary, they can also be prevented by humans. Soil erosion is essentially aggravated by faulty
m

practices. For instance, recommended ratio of nitrogen, phosphorus and potassium (NPK)
fertilizer in India is 4:2:1 but actual usage is in the ration of 10:4:1. Lands with a slope gradient
of 15 - 25 per cent should not be used for cultivation. If at all the land is to be used for
agriculture, terraces should carefully be made.
Over-grazing and shifting cultivation are other major faulty practices. It should be regulated and
controlled by villagers collectively. Contour bunding, Contour terracing, check dams, regulated
forestry, cover cropping, mixed farming and crop rotation are some other sustainable methods
to manage soil quality. In arid and semi-arid areas, shelter belts or green belts should be
constructed around the cultivable land to protect them from progressive sand dunes.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


148 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Figure 26 – soil management techniques


The Central Soil Conservation Board, set up by the Government of India, has prepared a
number of plans for soil conservation in different parts of the country. These plans are based on
the climatic conditions, configuration of land and the social behaviour of people.
Centrally sponsored scheme entitled “National project on management of soil health and
fertility (NPMSF)” has been formulated by the centre in 2008-09. It aims to facilitate and
promote Integrated Nutrient Management (INM) through judicious use of chemical fertilizers in
om

conjunction with organic fertilizers. It also aims to strengthen soil testing facilities by installing
l.c

more soil testing laboratories. One of the components is to build up capacity through training of
ai
tm

farmers and field demonstration etc. Project also envisages preparing database for balanced
ho

use of fertilizer, which is site specific. Other project/missions such as National Mission on
t@

Sustainable Agriculture (NMSA), National project on promotion of organic farming, Mahatma


sp
h.

Gandhi national rural employment guarantee act (MGNREGA), soil and land use survey projects
es

of centre etc. have bearing on managing the quality of soil.


ur
ay
m

Copyright © by Vision IAS


All rights are reserved. No part of this document may be reproduced, stored in a retrieval system or
transmitted in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording or
otherwise, without prior permission of Vision IAS.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


149 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

COMPOSITION AND STRUCTURE OF THE


ATMOSPHERE
Contents
1. Composition of the Atmosphere ............................................................................................ 151

1.1. Gases ............................................................................................................................... 151

1.2. Water Vapour .................................................................................................................. 152

1.3. Dust Particles................................................................................................................... 152

1.4. Changes in the Atmosphere ............................................................................................ 153

1.4.1. Air Pollution.............................................................................................................. 153

1.4.2. Global Warming ....................................................................................................... 153

1.4.3. Ozone Depletion....................................................................................................... 154

1.4.4. Ozone Pollution ........................................................................................................ 154

2. Structure of the Atmosphere ................................................................................................. 154

2.1. Troposphere .................................................................................................................... 155


om

2.2. Stratosphere .................................................................................................................... 156


l.c
ai

2.3. Mesosphere .................................................................................................................... 156


tm
ho
t@

2.4. Thermosphere ................................................................................................................. 156


sp
h.
es

2.5. Exosphere ........................................................................................................................ 156


ur
ay
m

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


150 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

1. Composition of the Atmosphere


In general, atmosphere is a layer of gases and dust surrounding a planet that is held in place by
the gravity of the planet body. An atmosphere is more likely to be retained if the gravity is high
and the atmosphere's temperature is low. In fact, earth’s atmosphere makes earth unique in
the solar system. Planet Earth’s atmosphere is best suitable for life and thus, it is important to
understand the composition as well as structure of it. In this context, man has started studying
the atmosphere thousands of years before. The Rig Vedic verses have mention of Monsoon,
seasons etc.
Earth’s atmosphere is composed of gases, water vapours and dust particles. Although other
important properties of the atmosphere such as temperature and pressure, can vary
considerably in both time and space, its composition in terms of the relative proportions of the
gases present in any unit volume, tends to remain remarkably constant. Thus, the atmosphere
generally tends to act very much as a single gas, which we commonly known as ‘air’. The
horizontal variation in the per cent share of these components of atmosphere has less variation
as compare to vertical variation.

1.1. Gases
The main component gases of dry air are listed in Table 1. It should be noticed that nitrogen
and oxygen together make up about 99 per cent of the volume, and that the other one per cent
is chiefly Argon. Other gases such as Methane, Ozone are found in traces.
Constituent gas Percentage volume
Nitrogen 78.08
Oxygen 20.95
Argon 0.93
Carbon dioxide 0.036
Neon 0.002
om

Helium 0.0005
l.c
ai

Krypton 0.001
tm

Xenon 0.00009
ho
t@

Hydrogen 0.00005
sp

Table 1 – Average composition of dry air


h.
es
ur

Nitrogen does not easily enter into chemical union with other substances, but it is an important
ay

constituent of many organic compounds. Atmospheric nitrogen acts as a reservoir pool for
m

nitrogen cycle. Nitrogen fixing organisms such as Rhizobium use free nitrogen of the
atmosphere to convert it to usable form such as nitrates.
Oxygen is an important part of the atmosphere and is necessary to sustain terrestrial life as it is
used in respiration. It is also used in combustion. It is believed that first oceans got saturated
with oxygen and after that it started flowing into the atmosphere. Source of oxygen is plants
with photosynthesis. Mountain climbers sometime require oxygen cylinders due to low
concentration of oxygen at greater heights.
Argon is an inert gas. Argon extracted from the atmosphere is used for industrial purposes such
as bulb manufacturing, welding equipments etc.
Carbon dioxide is released from the earth’s interior, respiration, soil processes, deforestation,
and combustion. Carbon dioxide is meteorologically a very important gas as it is transparent to
the incoming solar radiation but opaque to outgoing terrestrial radiations. It absorbs a part of
terrestrial radiation and reflects back some part of it towards the earth’s surface. It is largely
responsible for the greenhouse effect.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


151 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Ozone is another important constituent of atmosphere. Ozone is made up of three atoms of


oxygen when three molecules of oxygen gas convert into two molecules of Ozone using sun’s
high energy radiations. It is found in very small quantity (0.00005 per cent by volume) in the
upper atmosphere, 15-50km above the earth’s surface. Maximum concentration is found at the
height of 15-35km. It protects the life on earth by absorbing ultra-violet rays radiating from the
sun and prevents them from reaching the surface of the earth. In the absence of the ozone
layer, high energy ultra-violet rays would have made earth unfit for habitation.

1.2. Water Vapour


Table 1 refers to the average constituents of dry air. The lower parts of the atmosphere, up to
10-15 km, contain in addition water vapour, which is largely derived by evaporation from water
bodies on the earth and by transpiration from plants. It is one of the ‘most variable’
components of the atmosphere. It decreases with altitude and not found at great heights
because mixing and turbulence is not sufficiently strong to carry it up very far. In the warm and
wet tropics, it may account for 4% of the air by volume, while in the dry and cold areas of
desert and polar regions, it may be less than 1% of the air. Water vapour also decreases from
the equator towards the poles.
Water vapour, too, is capable of absorbing heat and acts like a blanket allowing the earth
neither to become too cold nor too hot. Water vapour is fundamental to many essential
meteorological processes, such as rain-making. It is source of all clouds and precipitation. In the
condensation process, vast amount of energy is released in form latent heat of condensation,
ultimate driving force for most of the storms.
The actual amount of the water vapour present in the atmosphere is known as the absolute
humidity. It is the weight of water vapour per unit volume of air. The absolute humidity differs
from place to place on the surface of the earth. The percentage of moisture present in the
atmosphere as compared to its full capacity at a given temperature is known as the relative
humidity. It is greater over the oceans and least over the continents. The air containing
om

moisture to its full capacity at a given temperature is said to be saturated. Moisture holding
l.c
ai

capacity of the air is directly proportional to its temperature.


tm
ho

1.3. Dust Particles


t@
sp

The atmosphere also carries in suspension variable amounts of solid material in the lower layers
h.
es

of atmosphere. Convectional air currents may transport them to great heights. The higher
ur

concentration of dust particles is found in subtropical and temperate regions due to dry winds
ay
m

in comparison to equatorial and polar regions. The term ‘dust particles’ includes all the solid
particles present in the air except the gases and water vapour. It includes sea salts, fine soil,
smoke-soot, ash, pollen, dust and disintegrated particles of meteors and originates from
different sources.
Dust particles provide the necessary nuclei on which water vapour can condense to form clouds
and eventually precipitation. Condensation on these fine particles near the surface causes
formation of fog. Large amount of dust tend to make the atmosphere hazy, and in extreme
cases, where pollution is involved, dust particles can be positively harmful to health. By the
process of scattering, dust particles contribute to the varied colours of red and orange at
sunrise and sunset. The blue colour of the sky is also due to selective scattering by dust
particles. The duration of twilight is also affected by the presence of these dust particles in the
air.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


152 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

1.4. Changes in the Atmosphere


Since industrial revolution, human activities have caused various changes into earth’s
atmosphere. We look at four very different atmospheric changes here.
1.4.1. Air Pollution
Air pollution is the introduction of chemicals, particulates, biological materials or other harmful
materials into the earth’s atmosphere. These pollutants can be solid particles, liquid, and gases.
Major pollutants are carbon oxides (COx), Nitrous Oxides (NOx), Volatile organic compounds,
particulates, sulphur dioxide, Toxic metals such as lead and mercury etc. Many of these are new
compounds in the atmosphere which have changed the composition to negligible level but their
presence throws challenges for humans. It causes damage, disease and death of humans and
other living organisms or infrastructure. Air pollution causes respiratory infections, heart
disease, and lung cancer etc. Major sources of these pollutants involves vehicular emission,
power plants, industries, waste incinerators, agricultural practices, fumes, waste deposition etc.
Acid rain is the result of increased pollutants in the atmosphere. Rain water is naturally acidic
due to atmospheric carbon dioxide which makes weak acid with rain water. Acid rain is caused
by other gases released when fossil fuels are burnt. Two gases are the main culprits: Sulphur
dioxide (forms sulphuric acid) and Nitrogen oxides (forms nitric acid). These increase the
acidity of rainwater. The dilute acid falls to ground as acid rain which causes the following
problems:
• Lakes become acidic and plants and fishes die as a result
• Tree growth is damaged, whole forests can die as a result
• Acid rain attacks metal structures and also buildings made of limestone
1.4.2. Global Warming
In very cold regions, glass houses are constructed for growing vegetables. These are known as
Greenhouses. In these houses, glass covering allows short wavelength sunrays to enter but
om
l.c

does not allow it to be radiated back to atmosphere. At atmospheric level, the greenhouse
ai

gases do not allow thermal radiation from a planetary surface (long waves) to pass and re-
tm
ho

radiate them in all directions. Since part of this re-radiation is back towards the surface and the
t@

lower atmosphere, it results in an elevation of the average surface temperature above what it
sp
h.

would be in the absence of the gases. Major greenhouse gases are: carbon dioxide, methane,
es

nitrous oxide, water vapour and Ozone.


ur
ay
m

With increase in the percentage of greenhouse gases, it is believed that temperature of earth is
increasing dramatically. This is termed as global warming. Main contributor for this rise in
temperature is carbon dioxide (CO2). The scientists have observed that CO2 is largely
contributed from burning of fossil fuels. The burning of fossil fuels and extensive clearing of
native forests has contributed to a 40% increase in the atmospheric concentration of carbon
dioxide, from 280 to 392 parts per million (ppm) in 2012.
Other gases such as Methane, water vapour, Nitrous oxide, Hydroflurocarbons (HFCs),
Perflurocarbons (PFCs), Sulphur hexafluoride (SF6) are playing considerable role in global
warming. SF6, PFCs etc. are present only in traces but their life span and greenhouse potency is
very high. For instance, SF6 is the most potent greenhouse gas in existence. With a global
warming potential 23,900 times greater than carbon dioxide, one pound of SF6 has the same
global warming impact of 11 tons of carbon dioxide. It is also very persistent in the atmosphere
with a lifetime of 3,200 years. SF6 is widely used in circuit breakers, gas-insulated substations,
and other switchgear to manage the high voltages.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


153 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Global warming would adversely affect the ecosystem on the Earth and the weather patterns
around the world in the following ways:
• Melting of ice at polar regions and glaciers on high mountains. It would increase the sea
level.
• Many climatic and weather events are expected to change drastically. Recent examples of
extreme temperature, precipitation are associated with the global warming.
• Global warming would change the habitats of organism. Those unable to adjust to these
rapid changes may not be able to survive.
1.4.3. Ozone Depletion
The release of chemical compounds such as Chlorofluorocarbons (CFCs) from earth into the
atmosphere poses a serious threat to ozone layer. CFCs are synthetic industrial chemical
compounds containing chlorine, fluorine, and carbon atoms. CFCs are widely used as cooling
fluids in the refrigerating systems. CFCs when released in air are transported by the vertical
atmospheric circulation and reach the ozone layer in the stratosphere. The CFCs absorb the
ultra-violet radiation and decompose to chlorine oxide molecules and can convert the ozone
into ordinary oxygen molecules. A study of the ozone layer based on data provided by the
satellites, showed a substantial decline in the total ozone gas. The scientists have discovered a
hole in the ozone layer over the continent of Antarctica. CFCs are transported to Antarctica
region by atmospheric wind systems. Here, CFCs get trapped in the Antarctica cold air by polar
vortex1 and deplete ozone layer.
1.4.4. Ozone Pollution
Ozone occurs at ground-level naturally in low concentrations. The two major sources of natural
ground-level ozone are hydrocarbons, which are released by plants and soil, and small amounts
of stratospheric ozone, which occasionally migrate down to the earth's surface. Neither of these
sources contributes enough ozone to be considered a threat to the health of humans or the
environment. But the ozone that is a byproduct of certain human activities does become a
om
l.c

problem at ground level. With more automobiles, and more industry, there's more ozone in the
ai

lower atmosphere. Tropospheric ozone is formed by the interaction of sunlight, particularly


tm
ho

ultraviolet light, with hydrocarbons and nitrogen oxides, which are emitted by automobiles,
t@

gasoline vapors, fossil fuel power plants, refineries, and certain other industries.
sp
h.

High ozone levels usually occur during the warm, sunny summer months (from May through
es
ur

September). Typically, ozone levels reach their peak in mid to late afternoon. A hot, sunny, still
ay
m

day is the perfect environment for ozone pollution production.


Near the earth’s surface, ozone molecules damages forests and crops; destroys nylon, rubber,
and other materials; and injures or destroys living tissue. It is a particular threat to people who
already have respiratory problems.

2. Structure of the Atmosphere


It is the lower part of the atmosphere which has interested man from times immemorial. But
from the beginning of the 20th century, when aeroplanes and radio waves were invented, the
knowledge of the upper part of the atmosphere became rather essential. The earth’s
atmosphere consists of zones or layers arranged like spherical shells according to altitude above
earth’s surface. Each zone has a unique set of characteristics. For the most part the layers are

1
The stratospheric polar vortex is a large-scale region of air that is contained by a strong west-to-east jet
stream that circles the polar region.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


154 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

not at all sharply defined, and their boundaries are arbitrarily established. The density,
temperature and composition of the atmosphere varies with altitude. Density is highest near
the surface of the earth and decreases with increasing altitude. The temperature changes
differently in different layers. Heavy gases such as Oxygen exist near the surface. At greater
heights, the lightest gases do in fact separate out, forming several concentric gas envelopes
around the Earth.
The atmosphere is divided into the five different layers depending upon the temperature
condition. They are: troposphere, stratosphere, mesosphere, thermosphere and exosphere.

2.1. Troposphere
Troposphere is the lowermost layer of the atmosphere. Its average height is 13 km and extends
roughly to a height of 8 km near the poles and about 18 km at the equator. It is thickest at the
equator because strong convection currents transport heat to such great heights. It contains 75
per cent of the total gaseous mass of the atmosphere. This layer contains dust particles and
water vapour also. The temperature in this layer decreases at the rate of 1°C for every 165m of
height (or at a mean rate of 6.5 degree C /km).The decrease occurs because air is compressible
and its density decreases with height allowing rising air to expand and thereby cool. It is
interesting to note that the lowest temperature in the entire troposphere is found over the
equator and not at the poles. The air temperature at the top of troposphere is about minus
800C over the equator and about minus 450C over the poles.
Word ‘troposphere’ is derived from the Greek word ‘tropos’ meaning ‘mixing’. Troposphere is
marked by turbulence and eddies. It is also called the convective region, for all the convective
cease at the upper limit of the troposphere. All changes in climate and weather take place in
this layer. Clouds formation, thunderstorms etc. occur in this layer. Wind velocity increase with
height and attain the maximum at the top.
At the top of the troposphere there is a shallow layer separating it from the next thermal layer
of the atmosphere. This shallow layer is known as the tropopause. Tropopause has its greatest
om
l.c

height near the equator. In the middle and high latitudes, the height of the tropopause varies
ai

according to seasons. For example, at latitudes 45N&S the average height of the tropopause in
tm
ho

January is about 12.5 km while in July it becomes 15 km.


t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

Figure 1 – Structure of atmosphere on the basis of temperature

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


155 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

2.2. Stratosphere
The stratosphere is found above the tropopause and extends up to a height of 50 km. The lower
stratosphere is isothermal in character. This temperature region is found to be present up to
about 20 km and after this temperature rises. In summers, the increase in the stratospheric
temperature with latitudes continues upto the poles. But during the winter season the
stratosphere is warmest between latitudes 500 – 600. Onwards, temperature decreases again.
The thickness of the stratosphere is highest at the poles.
This layer is free of any clouds of weather changes. It is an ideal place for flying of big planes. At
about 50 km, temperature begins to fall. This is end of stratosphere, and is called the
stratopause.
The portion of the stratosphere having maximum concentration of ozone is called ozonosphere.
The rise in temperature with height in stratosphere is because of the absorption of ultra-violet
by the ozone gas. Details of ozone gas are already discussed above.

2.3. Mesosphere
The mesosphere lies above the stratopause, and extends up to a height of 80 km from 50km. In
this layer, once again, temperature starts decreasing with the increase in altitude and reaches
up to minus 100° C at the height of 80 km. It is the coldest layer in the atmosphere. The exact
upper and lower boundaries of the mesosphere vary with latitude and with season, but the
lower boundary of the mesosphere is usually located at heights of about 50 km above the
Earth's surface and the mesopause is usually at heights near 100 km. In summers, the height of
mesosphere descends down to 85km at middle and high latitudes. The upper limit of
mesosphere is known as the mesopause.

2.4. Thermosphere
The thermosphere is located between 80 and 400 km above the mesopause. In this layer the
om

temperature increases rapidly with increase in height. It is estimated that the temperature
l.c

reaches 1500 degree C. The air is so thin that a small increase in energy can cause a large
ai
tm

increase in temperature. Because of the thin air in the thermosphere, scientists can't measure
ho

the temperature directly. They measure the density of the air by how much drag it puts on
t@
sp

satellites and then use the density to find the temperature.


h.
es

The Earth's thermosphere also includes the region called the ionosphere. It contains electrically
ur
ay

charged particles known as ions, and hence, it is known as ionosphere. Ionization of molecules
m

and atoms occurs mainly as a result of ultra-violet, x-rays and gamma radiations. The high
temperatures in the thermosphere also cause molecules to ionize. This is why an ionosphere
and thermosphere can overlap.
Radio waves transmitted from the earth are reflected back to the earth by this layer. This layer
also protects the earth from meteorites and remains of abandoned satellites. They are burned
and reduced to ashes due to high temperature as they enter this layer.
Ionosphere also includes some parts of mesosphere and exosphere. Ionosphere is further
divided into different layers, namely D-layer (upto 99km), E-layer (90-130km), Sporadic E-Layer,
F1 & F2 layer (150-380km) and G-layer (>400km). Layers such as D-layer, E-layer, exist only
during day time and vanishes as soon as sun sets.

2.5. Exosphere
The uppermost layer of the atmosphere above the thermosphere is known as the exosphere.
This is the highest layer but very little is known about it. It lies beyond 400km to 1000s of kms
where it merges with outer space. At such great height the density of atoms is extremely low. It

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


156 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

is largely home to Helium and Hydrogen. Temperature increases with height and may cross
50000C.
Stratification of atmosphere can also be done on the basis of chemical composition. According
to International Space Symposium 1962, atmosphere can be divided into two broad layers,
namely Homosphere and Heterosphere. Former is the lower layer and extends up to 88km
from the earth’s surface. The proportions of the component gases are uniform at different
levels. The three main-sub divisions of Homosphere are troposphere, stratosphere and
mesosphere. Heterosphere extends beyond 88 km to more than 3500 km. Here, atmosphere is
not uniform in its composition. It is also referred to as thermosphere as temperature rises with
height. In this sphere, gases are arranged in roughly spherical shells. The innermost of these is a
Nitrogen layer, found at heights between 100 and 200km; this is succeeded in turn by layers of
Oxygen (200-1100km) and Helium (1100-3500km); and finally beyond 3500km only Hydrogen
exists.

om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

Copyright © by Vision IAS


All rights are reserved. No part of this document may be reproduced, stored in a retrieval system or
transmitted in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording or
otherwise, without prior permission of Vision IAS.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


157 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

INSOLATION, EARTH’S HEAT BALANCE,


DIFFERENT ATMOSPHERIC CIRCULATIONS –
GLOBAL WINDS, CYCLONES
Contents
1. Insolation................................................................................................................................ 159
1.1. Factors Influencing Insolation ......................................................................................... 159
1.2. Heating and Cooling of the Atmosphere ......................................................................... 161
2. Heat Budget ........................................................................................................................... 162
2.1. Latitudinal Heat Balance ................................................................................................. 164
3. Temperature ........................................................................................................................... 164
3.1. Distribution of Temperature............................................................................................ 167
3.2. Temperature Anomaly..................................................................................................... 168
3.3. Temperature Inversion .................................................................................................... 168
3.4. Temperature Ranges ....................................................................................................... 169
4. Atmospheric Circulation ......................................................................................................... 170
4.1. Atmospheric Pressure ..................................................................................................... 170
4.2. Pressure Variations.......................................................................................................... 170
4.3. Forces Governing Air Movement .................................................................................... 172
4.3.1. Pressure Gradient..................................................................................................... 172
4.3.2. Coriolis Force ............................................................................................................ 173
4.3.3. Centripetal Force ...................................................................................................... 174
4.3.4. Frictional Force......................................................................................................... 174
4.4. Geostrophic Wind ........................................................................................................... 174
4.5. Distribution of Pressure Belts ......................................................................................... 174
4.6. Shifting of Belts ............................................................................................................... 175
om

4.7. General Circulation of the Atmosphere .......................................................................... 176


l.c
ai

4.7.1. Planetary Winds ....................................................................................................... 176


tm

4.8. Local Winds ..................................................................................................................... 177


ho
t@

4.8.1. The Land and Sea Breezes ........................................................................................ 177


sp

4.8.2. The Mountain and Valley Breezes ............................................................................ 178


h.
es

4.8.3. Hot Local Winds ....................................................................................................... 179


ur

4.8.4. Cold Local Winds ...................................................................................................... 179


ay
m

4.9. Upper Air Circulation....................................................................................................... 180


4.9.1. Jet Streams ............................................................................................................... 181
5. Air Mass.................................................................................................................................. 183
6. Fronts ..................................................................................................................................... 184
6.1. Warm Front ..................................................................................................................... 185
6.2. Cold Front ........................................................................................................................ 186
6.3. Stationary Front .............................................................................................................. 186
6.4. Occluded Front ................................................................................................................ 186
7. Cyclones ................................................................................................................................. 186
7.1. Extra-Tropical Cyclones ................................................................................................... 187
7.2. Tropical Cyclones ............................................................................................................. 189
7.3. Thunderstorms and Tornadoes ....................................................................................... 191
7.3.1. What Causes Lightning and Thunder ....................................................................... 192
7.3.2. Why Thunders are Cause of Concern ....................................................................... 193

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


158 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

1. Insolation
The earth’s atmosphere is very much a dynamic entity. Large volumes of air are continually
being moved both up and down and across the face of the Earth. As a proof, we feel air when it
is in motion. There must be some energy involved here. It needs to be understood that the
atmosphere is not a closed system. It is in contact with both the earth and with space, and
receives energy from both directions. However, Earth itself directly contributes only a negligible
amount of energy to the atmosphere, and its main role is to reflect energy from elsewhere. The
ultimate sole source of atmospheric energy is in fact heat and light received through space
from the Sun. This energy is known as solar insolation.
The Earth receives only a tiny fraction of the total amount of Sun’s radiations. Only two
billionths or two units of energy out of 1,00,00,00,000 units of energy radiated by the sun
reaches the earth’s surface due to its small size and great distance from the Sun. The unit of
measurements of this energy is Langley (Ly). On an average the earth receives 1.94 calories per
sq. cm per minute (2 Langley) at the top of its atmosphere.

1.1. Factors Influencing Insolation


The insolation received on earth is not same everywhere. The amount and the intensity of
insolation vary from place to place, during a day, in a season and in a year. The factors that
cause these variations in insolation are:
1. Revolution of earth around sun: earth revolves in an elliptical orbit around the sun. Thus,
distance between the Sun and the earth vary. The earth is farthest from the sun on 4th July.
This position of the earth is called aphelion. On 3rd January, the earth is the nearest to the
sun. This position is called perihelion. Therefore, the annual insolation received by the
earth at perihelion is slightly more than the amount received at aphelion. However, the
effect of this variation in the solar output is masked by other factors like the distribution of
land and sea and the atmospheric circulation. Hence, this variation in the insolation does
om

not have great effect on daily weather changes on the surface of the earth.
l.c

2. The rotation of earth on its axis: earth rotates around its axis and makes an angle of 66½
ai
tm

with the plane of its orbit round the sun. This particular characteristic of earth has great
ho

amount of influence on the amount of insolation received at different latitudes. The


t@
sp

seasons in each hemisphere are dictated not by the closeness to the sun but by the axial tilt
h.

of the earth.
es
ur

3. The angle of inclination of the sun’s rays: Since the earth is round, the sun’s rays strike the
ay
m

surface at different angles at different places. The angle formed by the sun’s ray with the
tangent of the earth’s circle at a point is called angle of incidence. It influences the
insolation in two ways as follows:
• When the sun is almost overhead, the rays of the sun are vertical. The angle of
incidence is large. Hence, they are concentrated in a smaller area, giving more amount
of insolation at that place. If the sun’s rays are oblique, angle of incidence is small and
sun’s rays have to heat up a greater area, resulting in less amount of insolation received
there.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


159 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Figure 1 – effect of angle of inclination on Insolation


• The sun’s rays with small angle traverse more of the atmosphere than rays striking at a
large angle. Longer the path of sun’s rays, greater is the amount of reflection and
absorption of heat by atmosphere. As a result the intensity of insolation at a place is less
(figure 1). Angle of inclination of solar radiation depends on latitude of a place. The higher
the latitude the less is the angle they make with the surface of the earth resulting in slant
sun rays. Figure 1 show the winter Solstices in the Northern Hemisphere where angle of
inclination is zero at 66 ½ N latitude.
Latitude 0° 20° 40° 60° 90°
December 22 (winter solstice) 12h 00m 10h 48m 9h 8m 5h 33m 0m
June 21(summer Solstice) 12h 13h 12m 14h 52m 18h 27m 6 months
Table 1 – Length of Day on winter and summer Solstices in the Northern Hemisphere
4. The length of the day: the duration of day is controlled partly by latitude and partly by the
season of the year. The amount of insolation has close relationship with the length of the
day. It is because insolation is received only during the day. Other conditions remaining the
om

same, the longer the days the greater is the amount of insolation. In summers, the days
l.c
ai

being longer the amount of insolation received is also more. As against this in winter the
tm

days are shorter the insolation received is also less. On account of the inclination of the
ho
t@

earth on its axis at an angle of 23 ½ 0, rotation and revolution, the duration of the day is not
sp

same everywhere on the earth. At the equator there is 12 hours day and night each
h.
es

throughout the year. As one moves towards poles duration of the days keeps on increasing
ur

or decreasing. It is why the maximum insolation is received in equatorial areas. Table 1


ay
m

show the duration of day (in hours & minutes) on winter and summer solstices in the
Northern hemisphere.
5. The transparency of the atmosphere: The earth’s atmosphere is more or less transparent
to short wave solar radiation which has to pass through the atmosphere before striking the
earth’s surface. The transparency depends upon cloud cover, its thickness, water vapour
and solid particles, as they reflect, absorb or transmit insolation. High energy ultra-violet
rays are absorbed by the Ozone layer. Thick clouds hinder the insolation to reach the earth
while clear sky helps it to reach the surface. Water vapour absorbs insolation, resulting in
less amount of insolation reaching the surface. Very small-suspended particles in the
troposphere scatter visible spectrum both to the space and towards the earth surface.
6. Solar variation: It is the change in the amount of radiation emitted by the Sun. These
variations have periodic components, the main one being the approximately 11-
year sunspot cycle. Sunspots are temporary phenomena on the photosphere of the Sun
that appear visibly as dark spots compared to surrounding regions. When there is an
increase in sun spots it leads to increase1 in the amount of solar radiation. But this change
is almost negligible.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


160 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Figure 2 – average annual insolation on the surface of the earth


7. Topographical variations: Earth does not have a featureless surface. The topographical
variations are the major factors modifying the distribution of insolation. Variability in
elevation, surface orientation (slope and aspect), and obstruction by surrounding
topographic features creates strong local gradients of insolation. Similarly, in the northern
hemisphere a south-facing slope (more open to sunlight and warm winds) will therefore
generally be warmer and dryer due to higher levels of evapotranspiration than a north-
facing slope.[1] This can be seen in the Swiss Alps, where farming is much more extensive
on south-facing than on north-facing slopes. In the Himalayas, this effect can be seen to an
extreme degree, with south-facing slopes being warm, wet and forested, and north-facing
slopes cold, dry but much more heavily glaciated. Vegetation, human activities are more
visible on the slopes where insolation is more relatively.
om

Under combined effect of the above discussed factors, the amount of total annual insolation
l.c

received by different regions is different. The insolation received at the surface varies from
ai

about 320 Watt/m2 in the tropics to about 70 Watt/m2 in the poles. Maximum insolation is
tm
ho

received over the subtropical deserts. Equator receives comparatively less insolation than the
t@

tropics due to presence of clouds. Generally, at the same latitude the insolation is more over
sp
h.

the continent than over the oceans because more clouds over the oceans reflect sun rays back
es

into space. Isohels are lines connecting points on the earth surface that receive equal amounts
ur
ay

of sunshine. Isohels are more or less parallel to latitudes, especially in southern hemisphere
m

(figure 2).

1.2. Heating and Cooling of the Atmosphere


Sun is the ultimate source of the atmospheric heat and energy, but its effect is not direct. For
example, as we climb a mountain or ascend in the atmosphere, temperature become
steadily lower, rather than higher, as we might expect. This is because the mechanism of
heating the atmosphere in not simple. Four common types of energy transport are involved
in heating of the atmosphere (figure 3). They are:
1. Radiation: it is the process where transference of heat is directly from space to atmosphere
through electromagnetic radiations2. Photon3 particles in the radiations collide with the air
molecules in the atmosphere and transfer energy in this process. All objects whether hot or
cold emit radiation continuously. The wavelength at which a body radiates depends on its
surface temperature. The shorter the wavelength, higher the energy carried by the
radiations The sun, having an extremely hot surface temperature, radiates fairly short
wavelengths, part of which is felt as warmth, part of which are visible as light. The Earth, on

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


161 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

the other hand, having a cool surface, re-radiates heat at much longer wavelengths. The re-
radiate heat from the earth is called Terrestrial radiation. Atmosphere is transparent to
short waves and opaque to long waves. The long wave radiation is absorbed by the
atmospheric gases particularly by carbon dioxide and the other green house gases. Hence
energy leaving the earth’s surface heats up the atmosphere more than the incoming solar
radiation.
2. Conduction: When two objects of unequal temperature come in contact with each other,
heat energy flow from the warmer object to the cooler object and this process of heat
transfer is known as conduction. The flow continues till temperature of both the objects
becomes equal or the contact is broken. The conduction in the atmosphere occurs at zone
of contact between the atmosphere and the earth’s surface by terrestrial radiations.
However, this is a minor method of heat transfer in terms of warming the atmosphere since
it only affects the air close to the earth’s surface. This is because of the fact that the air is
poor conductor of heat4.
3. Convection: In this process, energy is transferred through motion of molecules itself. The
air in contact with the earth rises vertically on heating in the form of currents and further
transmits the heat of the atmosphere. The heating of the air leads to its expansion. Its
density decreases and it moves upwards. Continuous ascent of heated air creates vacuum
in the lower layers of the atmosphere. As a consequence, cooler air comes down to fill
the vacuum. This process of vertical heating of the atmosphere is known as convection.
The convective transfer of energy is confined only to the troposphere.om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

Figure 3 – (a) processes of heating and cooling of atmosphere and (b) per cent share of
processes in heating up of atmosphere
4. Advection: The transfer of heat through horizontal movement of air is called advection.
These winds take the characteristics of their source of origin with them. The temperature of
a place will rise if it lies on the path of winds coming from warmer regions. The
temperature will fall if the place lies on the path of the winds blowing from cold regions.
Horizontal movement of the air is relatively more important than the vertical movement. In
summer seasons, ‘Loo’ of north India is a hot wind and ‘Sirocco’ is also a hot wind carries
heat of Sahara desert to Mediterranean regions. In middle latitudes, most of diurnal (day
and night) variation in daily weather is caused by advection alone.

2. Heat Budget
The average temperature of the earth overall does not change in spite of continuous supply of
sun rays. This is possible only when an equal amount of energy is sent back to space by the
earth’s system. In the way there is balance between incoming solar radiation and outgoing

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


162 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

terrestrial radiations. This balance is known as the heat budget of the earth. Figure 4 depicts
the heat budget of the planet earth. Consider that the insolation received at the top of the
atmosphere is 100 per cent. While passing through the atmosphere some amount of energy is
reflected, scattered and absorbed. Only the remaining part reaches the earth surface.
Roughly 35 units are reflected back to space even before reaching the earth’s surface. The
details of this reflected radiation are as under:
• Reflected from the top of clouds - 27 units
• Reflected by ice-fields on earth - 02 units
• Reflected by the atmosphere - 06 units
Total - 35 units
The reflected amount of radiation is called the albedo of the earth. The above given radiation
does neither heat the atmosphere nor the earth’s surface.
The remaining 65 units are absorbed as:
• Absorbed by the atmosphere - 14 units
• Absorbed by the earth - 51 units (Scattered + direct radiation)
Total - 65 units

om
l.c
ai
tm
ho

Figure 4 – Heat Budget of the Earth


t@
sp

Scattering takes place by gas molecules and dust particles. This takes place in all directions,
h.
es

some of it earthwards and some towards space. In overall, earth receives 51 units of radiation
ur

which in turn radiates back in the form of terrestrial radiation. The details of this reflected
ay
m

radiation are as under:


• Radiated to space directly - 17 units
• Radiated to atmosphere - 34 units
The details of 34 units radiation absorbed by atmosphere from terrestrial radiations are as
under
• Absorbed directly - 06 units
• Absorbed through convection and turbulence - 09 units
• Absorbed through Latent heat of condensation 5
- 19 units
Total - 34 units
Total units absorbed by the atmosphere are 48 (14 units insolation + 34 units Terrestrial
radiation). These are radiated back into space. Thus, the total radiation returning from the earth
and the atmosphere respectively is:
• Radiated back by earth - 17 units
• Radiated back by atmosphere - 48 units
Total - 65 units

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


163 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

These returning 65 units balance the total of 65 units received from the sun. This account of
incoming and outgoing radiation always maintains the balance of heat on the surface of the
earth. This is termed the heat budget or heat balance of the earth.

Figure 5 – heat energy budget by latitudes


om

2.1. Latitudinal Heat Balance


l.c
ai

Although the earth as a whole maintains balance between incoming solar radiation and
tm
ho

outgoing terrestrial radiation. But this is not true when we observe at different latitudes. Heat
t@

budget at latitudinal level is non-zero. As previously discussed, the amount of insolation


sp
h.

received is directly related to latitudes. Some part of the earth has surplus radiation balance
es

while the other part has deficit.


ur
ay
m

Figure 5 depicts the latitudinal variation in the net radiation balance of the earth — the
atmosphere system. The figure shows that there is a surplus of net radiation balance between
400 N & S degrees and the regions near the poles have a deficit. This in theory should mean that
tropical areas should get steadily warmers, and the Arctic and Antarctic even colder. But such is
not the case. The surplus heat energy from the tropics is redistributed pole wards and as a
result the tropics do not get progressively heated up due to the accumulation of excess heat or
the high latitudes get permanently frozen due to excess deficit. This transfer of surplus heat
from tropics to polar region is being performed by atmospheric and oceanic circulations such as
winds and ocean currents. According to one estimate, about 75 per cent of heat transfer is
carried out by atmospheric circulation and the remaining 25 per cent by the ocean currents. In
fact, winds and ocean currents are produced due to imbalance of heat.

3. Temperature
The temperature is the measurement in degrees of how hot (or cold) a thing (or a place) is. The
temperature of the atmosphere is not same across the Earth. It varies in spatial and temporal
dimensions. The temperature of a place depends largely on the insolation received by that

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


164 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

place. The interaction of insolation with the atmosphere and the earth’s surface creates heat
which is measured in terms of temperature. It is important to know about the temperature
distribution over the surface of the earth to understand the weather, climate, vegetation zones,
animal and human life etc. following factors determine the temperature of air at any place.
1. The latitude of the place: Intensity of insolation depends on the latitude. The amount of
insolation depends on the inclination of sun rays, which is further depends upon the
latitude of the place. At the equator sun’s rays fall directly overhead throughout the year.
Away from the equator towards poles, the inclination of the Sun’s rays increases. In
conclusion, if other things remain the same, the temperature of air goes on decreasing
from the equator towards poles.
2. The altitude of the place: the atmosphere is largely heated indirectly by re-radiated
terrestrial radiation from the earth’s surface. Therefore, the lower layers of the
atmosphere are comparatively warmer than the upper layers, even in the same latitudes.
For example, Ambala (30 21’ N) and Shimla (31 6’) are almost at the same latitude. But the
average temperature of Shimla is much lower than the Ambala. It is because Ambala is
located in plain at an altitude of 272 m above sea level whereas Shimla is located at an
altitude of 2202 m above sea level. In other words, the temperature generally decreases
with increasing height (figure 6(a)). The rate of decrease of temperature with height is
termed as the normal lapse rate. It is 6.5°C per 1,000 m. That’s why, the mountains, even in
the equatorial region, have snow covered peaks, like Mt. Kilimanjaro, Africa.
3. Distance from the Sea: the land surface is heated at a faster rate than the water surface.
Thus the temperature of the air over land and water surfaces is not the same at a given
time. In summers, the sea water is cooler than the land and in winters, land is much colder
than the sea water. The coastal areas experience the sea breezes during the daytime and
the land breezes during the night time. This has a moderating influence on the temperature
of the coastal areas. Against this the places in the interior, far away from the sea, have
extreme climate. The daily range of temperature is less near the coastal area and it
increases with increase in distance from the sea coast (figure 6(b)). The low daily range of
om
l.c

temperature is the characteristic of marine climate. That’s why, the people of Mumbai have
ai

hardly any idea of extremes of temperature.


tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

(a) – effect of altitude (b) – maritime influence


Figure 6 – effect of altitude & distance from sea on temperature

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


165 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Figure 7 – (a) effect of ocean currents & (b) effect of slope on temperature
4. Ocean Currents: the effect of warm ocean currents and the cold ocean currents is limited to
the adjoining coastal areas. The warm ocean currents flow along the eastern coast of
tropical and sub-tropical regions and western coast of higher latitudes. On the other hand,
cold ocean currents flow along the eastern coast of higher latitude and along the western
coast of tropical and sub-tropical areas. The North Atlantic drift, an extension of Gulf
Stream, warm the coastal districts of Western Europe (such as Norway) and British Isles
keeping their ports ice-free (figure 7(a)).
5. Air-mass circulation: air masses in form of winds helps in the redistribution of temperature.
The places, which come under the influence of warm air-masses experience higher
temperature and the places that come under the influence of cold air masses experience
low temperature. The effect of these winds is, however, limited to the period during which
they blow. Local winds like cold Mistral of France considerably lower the temperature and
Sirocco, a hot wind that blows from Sahara desert raises the temperature of Italy, Malta etc.
The temperature rises at the time of arrival of temperate cyclones, while it falls sharply
om

after their passage. Sometimes, local winds can cause sudden change in temperature. In
l.c
ai

northern India, ‘Loo’, a local hot wind, raise the temperature to such an extent that heat
tm
ho

waves prolong for several days in continuation and many people die of sunstroke.
t@

6. Slope, Shelter and aspect: slopes of a mountain facing the Sun experiences high
sp
h.

temperature than the slopes on the leeward side due to more insolation (figure 7(b)). A
es
ur

steep slope experiences a more rapid change in temperature than a gentle one. Mountain
ay

ranges that have an east-west alignment like the Alps show a higher temperature on the
m

south-facing ‘sunny slope’ than the north facing ‘sheltered slope’. Consequently, there are
more settlements in southern side and it is better utilized for agricultural and other
purposes.
The mountain ranges at certain places stop the cold winds and prevent the temperature
from going down. This is found in areas where mountains lie in the direction facing the
winds as in the case of Himalayas. In the absence of Himalayas, winters of India would
have been very different.
7. Nature of ground surface: the nature of surface in terms of colour, vegetation, soil, land
use, snow cover etc. affects the temperature of a place. In the tropical and subtropical
deserts, the sandy surface record high temperature because they absorb most of the solar
radiations. Snow has very high albedo6 and thus, reflects much of the insolation without
absorption. Thick vegetation (such as Amazon forest) cuts off much of the in-coming
insolation and in many places sunlight never reaches the ground. It is cool in the jungle and
its shade temperature is a few degrees lower than that of open spaces in corresponding

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


166 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

latitudes. Light soils reflect more heat than darker soils. Dry soils like sands are very
sensitive to temperature changes, whereas wet soils, like clay retain much moisture and
warm up more slowly. Urban areas have relatively higher temperature than the
surrounding.

3.1. Distribution of Temperature


The global distribution of temperature can well be understood by studying the isotherms. The
Isotherms are lines joining places having equal temperature. As already discussed, latitudes
have pronounced effect on the temperature, the isotherms are generally parallel to the
latitude. The deviation from this general trend is more pronounced in January than in July,
especially in the northern hemisphere. Figure 8 and 9 show the distribution of surface air
temperature in the month of January and July. In the northern hemisphere the land surface
area is much larger than in the southern hemisphere. Hence, the effects of land mass and the
ocean currents are well pronounced. Following are the chief features of isotherms:

om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

Figure 8 – isotherms in the month of January


• The isotherms are generally parallel to equator. They show successive temperature
decrease towards the poles.
• The rate of change of temperature is indicated by the spacing between isotherms. Closely
drawn isotherms indicate rapid change in temperature and vice-versa.
• The isotherms deviate to the north over the ocean and to the south over the continent in
January. It is for two reasons – warm and cold ocean currents and difference between the
temperature of land and water. For example, the presence of warm ocean currents, Gulf
Stream and North Atlantic drift, make the Northern Atlantic Ocean warmer and the
isotherms bend towards the north. Over the land the temperature decreases sharply and
the isotherms bend towards south in Europe. The mean January temperature along 60° E
longitude is minus 20° C both at 80° N and 50° N latitudes.
• In the southern hemisphere, the isotherms are more or less parallel to the latitudes due to
less landmass and the variation in temperature is more gradual than in the northern

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


167 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

hemisphere. The isotherm of 20° C, 10° C, and 0° C runs parallel to 35° S, 45° S and 60° S
latitudes respectively.
• In July the isotherms generally run parallel to the latitude.

Figure 9 – isotherms in the month of July

3.2. Temperature Anomaly


om

The difference between the mean temperature of any place and the mean temperature of its
l.c

parallels is known as temperature anomaly. On the map the lines joining the places of equal
ai
tm

temperature anomaly are known as Isothermal anomaly lines.


ho
t@

Temperature anomaly could be positive or negative. Due to uneven distribution of land and
sp

water the maximum temperature anomalies are found in the Northern Hemisphere and
h.
es

minimum in the Southern Hemisphere.


ur
ay

3.3. Temperature Inversion


m

As already discussed, temperature decreases with increase in altitude. In normal conditions, as


we go up, temperature decreases with normal lapse rate. It is 6.5°C per 1,000 m. Against this
normal rule sometimes, instead of decreasing, temperature may rise with the height gained.
The cooler air is nearer the earth and the warmer air is aloft. This rise of temperature with
height is known as Temperature inversion. Temperature inversion takes place under certain
specific conditions. These are discussed below:
• Long winter nights: if in winters the sky is clear during long nights, the terrestrial radiation
is accelerated. The reason is that the land surface gets cooled fairly quickly. The bottom
layer of atmosphere in contact with the ground is also cooled and the upper layer remains
relatively warm.
• Cloudless clear sky: The clouds obstruct the terrestrial radiation. But this radiation does not
face any obstacles for being reflected into space when the sky is clear. Therefore the ground
is cooled quickly and so is the air in contact with it cooled.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


168 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Figure 10 – temperature inversion


• Dry air: humid air absorbs the terrestrial radiation but dry air is no obstruction to terrestrial
radiation and allows the radiation to escape into space.
• Calm atmosphere: the blowing of winds bring warm and cold air into contact. Under
conditions of calm atmosphere the cold air stays put near the ground.
• Ice covered surface: in ice covered areas due to high albedo less insolation is received.
During night due to terrestrial radiation most of the heat is lost to atmosphere and the
surface is cooled. The air in contact with it is also cooled but the upper layer remains warm.
The stability of the night time temperature inversion is usually destroyed soon after sunrise as
the sun's energy warms the ground, which warms the air in the inversion layer. The warmer, less
dense air then rises, destroying the stability that characterizes the nightly inversion. The
phenomenon of inversion of temperature is especially observed in valleys. During winters the
om

mountain slopes cool very rapidly due to the quick radiation of heat. The air resting above them
l.c
ai

also becomes cold and its density increases. Hence, it moves down the slopes and settles down
tm
ho

in the valleys. This air pushes the comparatively warmer air of valleys upwards and leads to the
t@

phenomenon of inversion of temperature. That is why, apple orchids in Himalayan region, tea
sp

garden of Darjeeling are found in upper slopes of the valleys.


h.
es
ur

Effect on Humans
ay
m

• In cities, impurities present in the atmosphere such as smoke, dust particles and other
pollutants do not go up in the air due to temperature inversion. They form dense fog near
the earth’s surface, especially in winters. It causes problems in breathing. Frost formed may
be harmful for crops in fields.
• At some places, people lit fire or use big blowers to mix hot and cold air in order to drain off
the area of the adverse conditions created by temperature inversion.
• In valleys people make terraced fields in the upper slopes and also settle down there.

3.4. Temperature Ranges


Temperature of a place varies within a day and also differs in different seasons. Range of
temperature is the difference between maximum and minimum temperatures. There are two
terms which are used to consider temperature ranges.
1. Diurnal range of temperature: the daily pattern of temperature change that we normally
experience illustrates energy changes on a small time scale. On a calm day with little cloud,
air temperatures usually reach their minimum just before sunrise, because the ground has

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


169 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

been giving off long-wave radiation all through the night, gradually becoming colder and
cooling the air above by conduction. With sunrise, temperature of the ground begins to
rise. Maximum insolation receives at midday. But the peak of air temperature is usually
about 2:00 PM. After sun-set, the air initially remains fairly warm as it is still being heated
by long-wave radiation from the ground, but this gradually expires. Desert areas typically
have the greatest diurnal temperature variations while Low lying, humid areas typically
have the least range.
2. Annual average range of temperature: it is the monthly range of temperature or the
difference between the average temperature of hottest month and average temperature
of the coldest month of the year. The annual range is lower in low latitudes and higher in
high latitudes. In the same latitudes, it is higher over the continents and lower over the
oceans and coastal regions. The highest annual range of temperature is more than 60° C
over the north-eastern part of Eurasian continent. This is due to continentality. The least
range of temperature, 3°C, is found between 20° S and 15° N.

4. Atmospheric Circulation
Varying amount of insolation received by the earth causes differential heating of the earth and
its atmosphere. Temperature difference thus produced account for the density differences in
the air. Air expands when heated and gets compressed when cooled. This results in variations in
the atmospheric pressure. The result is that it causes the movement of air from high pressure
to low pressure, setting the air in three-dimensional motion on global scale. Air in horizontal
motion is wind. Atmospheric pressure also determines when the air will rise or sink. The wind
redistributes the heat and moisture across the planet, thereby, maintaining a constant
temperature for the planet as a whole. The vertical rising of moist air cools it down to form the
clouds and bring precipitation. There is, in fact, an intimate relationship between winds and
pressure, and knowledge of pressure variations is a prerequisite to understanding air motion.

4.1. Atmospheric Pressure


om
l.c

The atmosphere is held on the earth by the gravitational pull of the earth. A column of air
ai

exerts weight in terms of pressure on the surface of the earth. The weight of a column of air
tm
ho

contained in a unit area from the mean sea level to the top of the atmosphere is called the
t@

atmospheric pressure. Pressure is normally measured in millibars or pascals and spatial


sp
h.

variations of pressure are depicted on maps by means of isobars, which are lines connecting
es

places having the same barometric pressure. The actual pressure at a given place and at a
ur
ay

given time fluctuates and it generally ranges between 950 and 1050 millibars. Air pressure is
m

measured with the help of a mercury barometer or the aneroid barometer.


The gradual change of pressure between different areas is known as the barometric slope or
pressure gradient. The closer the isobars are together, the greater the pressure gradient; for
example, widely spaced isobars indicate a weak pressure gradient.

4.2. Pressure Variations


In the lower atmosphere the pressure decreases rapidly with height with decrease in density of
air. It does not always decrease at the same rate. But to make calculations simple, a decrease of
about 1 mb for each 10 m increase in elevation is taken into consideration (figure 11). In spite of
high vertical pressure gradient, we do not experience strong vertical air currents. This is
possible because of equal and opposite gravitation force acting upon air.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


170 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Figure 11 - vertical pressure variation Figure 12 - Isobars, High pressure and Low pressure system
The effects of low pressure are more clearly experienced by the people living in the hilly areas
as compared to those who live in plains. In high mountainous areas rice takes more time to
cook because low pressure reduces the boiling point of water. Breathing problem such as
faintness and nose bleedings are also faced by many trekkers from outside in such areas
because of low pressure conditions in which the air is thin and it has low amount of oxygen
content.
Unlike vertical high pressure gradient, small horizontal pressure gradients are highly significant
in terms of the wind direction and velocity. In order to eliminate the effect of altitude on
om

pressure, it is measured at any station after being reduced to sea level for purposes of
l.c

comparison. Figure 12 shows the patterns of isobars corresponding to pressure systems. Low
ai
tm

pressure system is enclosed by one or more isobars with the lowest pressure in the centre.
ho
t@

High-pressure system is also enclosed by one or more isobars with the highest pressure in the
sp

centre. The terms ‘high pressure’ and ‘low pressure’ do not usually signify any particular
h.
es

absolute values, but are used relatively.


ur
ay

Sea-level pressure conditions over the globe for both January (figure 13) and July (figure 14)
m

show some marked differences between the two hemispheres. The northern hemisphere tends
to have the greater seasonal contrasts in its pressure distributions and the southern
hemisphere exhibits much simpler average pressure patterns overall. These differences are
largely related to the unequal distribution of land and sea between the two hemispheres.
Ocean areas, which dominate the southern hemisphere, tend to be much more equable than
continents in both temperature and pressure variations.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


171 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Figure 13 – Distribution of pressure (in mb) for January month

om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay

Figure 14 – Distribution of pressure (in mb) for July month


m

4.3. Forces Governing Air Movement


We know that the air pressure is unevenly distributed in the atmosphere and air attempts to
balance this unevenness. Hence, it moves from high pressure areas to low pressure areas.
Horizontal movement of air in response to difference in pressure is termed as wind while
vertical or nearly vertical moving air is called air current. Both winds and air currents form the
system of circulation in the atmosphere.
4.3.1. Pressure Gradient
The existence of pressure differentials in the atmosphere is the immediate primary force
causing air movement. The rate of change of pressure with respect to distance is the pressure
gradient. The pressure gradient force always acts down the pressure gradient, attempting to
cause the general movement of air away from high-pressure towards low pressure areas. The
force exerted is proportional to the steepness of the gradient (figure 15(a)). The gentler the
pressure gradient slower is the speed of the wind and vice-versa.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


172 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

If alone this force is exerted to the air, wind would have direction perpendicular to the isobars.
However, there are other forces also which, in fact, make wind to flow more nearly parallel to
the isobars.
4.3.2. Coriolis Force
Winds do not cross the isobars at right angles as the pressure gradient directs them. They get
deflected from their original paths. One of the most potent influences on wind direction is the
deflection caused by the earth’s rotation on its axis. This deflection is always to the right of the
direction of motion in the northern hemisphere and to the left in the southern hemisphere
(figure 15(b)). This influence is known as Coriolis force.

om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

(a) Relationship between pressure (b) Coriolis force under action gradient and speed of winds
Figure 15 – forces governing air movement
The degree of the deflecting force varies with the speed of the moving air and with latitude.
The faster the wind, the greater the effect of rotation can be. Similarly, the rate of deflection
increases with the increasing distance from the Equator because the Coriolis force is zero at the
Equator and maximum at Poles. It must be noted that it is an apparent or relative deflection. If
viewed from outer space, objects moving across the face of the earth would not in fact appear
to be deflected. In relation to star positions, they would travel in a straight line, while the earth

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


173 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

rotates beneath them. The phenomenon affects all freely moving objects – air, ocean currents,
rockets and projectiles etc. Thus, it is not actually any force. But it is simplest to accept that
deflection is caused by a force.
4.3.3. Centripetal Force
This force applies when the isobars are curved, as within cyclones. The fact that air is following
a curved path means that in addition to the pressure gradient and the Coriolis force, a third
force is acting centripetally, pulling air inwards. Wind which is in balance with these three forces
is known as the gradient wind.
4.3.4. Frictional Force
It lessens the speed of the wind. It is greatest at the surface and its influence generally extends
upto an elevation of 1 - 3 km. Over the sea surface the friction is minimal. By reducing speed of
wind, it weakens the Coriolis force. This allows the pressure gradient to assert its greater
strength by causing the air to flow more towards low pressure. Thus, the usual situation is that
surface winds flow at a slight angle to the isobars (figure 16(b)).

4.4. Geostrophic Wind


The velocity and direction of the wind are the net result of the wind generating forces. The
winds in the upper atmosphere, 2 - 3 km above the surface, are free from frictional effect of the
surface and are controlled by the pressure gradient and the Coriolis force. At such height in the
free atmosphere, winds generally blow at right angles to the pressure gradient: this indicate
that the pressure gradient force is exactly balanced by the Coriolis force acting in a diametrically
opposite direction. This sort of air motion is known as the geostrophic wind (figure 16(a)).
om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

Figure 16 – forces governing air movement: (a) geostrophic balance between pressure
gradient and Coriolis force; (b) the additional effect of frictional force on surface wind
Not all winds are exactly geostrophic. As pressure pattern change, the balance is upset, but the
wind always strives to readjust itself until it obtains the new geostrophic speed.

4.5. Distribution of Pressure Belts


The horizontal distribution of air pressure across the latitudes is characterized by high or low
pressure belts (figure 17(a)). These pressure belts are:
• Equatorial low pressure belt: This belt extends from equator to 100N and 100S latitudes.
This belt is thermally produced due to heating by Sun.. Due to excessive heating horizontal
movement of air is absent here and only vertical currents are experienced in this belt.
Therefore, this belt is called doldrums (the zone of calm). . This belt is also known as-Inter
Tropical Convergence Zone (ITCZ) because the trade winds flowing from sub tropical high
pressure belts converge here.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


174 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

• Sub-tropical high pressure belt: these extend roughly between 250 and 350 latitudes in
both the Hemispheres. The existence of these pressure belts is due to the fact that the up
rising air of the equatorial region is deflected towards poles due to the earth’s rotation.
After becoming cold and heavy, it descends in these regions and get piled up. This results in
high pressure. Calm conditions with feeble and variable winds are found here.. In southern
hemisphere, this belt is broken by small low-pressure areas in summer over Australia and
South Africa. In northern hemisphere, the belt is more discontinuous by the presence of
land masses, and high pressure occurs only over the ocean areas as discrete cells; these are
termed the Azores and Hawaiian cells in the Atlantic and Pacific areas respectively.
These belts are also called Horse latitudes. In older days, vessels with cargo of horses
passing through these belts found difficult in sailing under these calm conditions. They
used to throw the horses in the sea in order to make the vessels lighter. In the upper
atmosphere over this belt the upper level westerlies and anti-trade winds converge and set
up descending currents in the atmosphere.
• Sub-polar low pressure belt: it extends along 600 latitudes (550-650) in both the
hemisphere. These belts are not thermally induced instead the winds coming from the sub-
tropics and the polar regions converge in this belt and rise upward. The great temperature
contrast between the subtropical and the polar regions, gives rise to cyclonic storms in this
belt. In Southern hemisphere, this low pressure belt is more pronounced due to vast
presence of ocean and also referred as the sub-antarctic low. But in the northern
hemisphere, there are large land masses along 600 latitudes which are very cold. Therefore,
the pressures over these landmasses are increased. Thus, the continuity of the belt is
broken.
• Polar high pressure belt: Because of low temperature, air compresses and its density
increases. Hence, high pressure is found here throughout the year. This is more marked
over the land area of the Antarctic continent than over the ocean of the North Pole. In
northern hemisphere, high pressure is not centered at the pole, but it extends from
om

Greenland to Islands situated in the northern part of Canada.


l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

Figure 17 – (a) global pressure belts and (b) shifting of pressure belts

4.6. Shifting of Belts


Pressure belts are not fixed. The main cause of their formation is the uneven distribution of
temperature on the surface of earth. Consequently, the pressure belts swing either to the north
(in July) or the south (in December) of the equator by following the apparent annual migration
of the sun (figure 17(b)). Sun’s movement is recorded between tropic of Cancer and tropic of
Capricorn. During the month of July, low pressure equatorial belt extends upto the tropic of

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


175 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Cancer in Asian region. While in January, it extends to latitudes 100-150 S. Most profound effect
of shifting of belts is seen in the temperate region. Winds blowing from the Horse latitudes in
the form of westerlies create unique climatic conditions in the temperate parts of the world,
especially in the Mediterranean region.

4.7. General Circulation of the Atmosphere


As discussed earlier that wind is the result of pressure gradient which is largely caused by
differential heating of the earth. Winds in the atmosphere are neither unidirectional nor have a
same pattern as we go up in the atmosphere. In fact, winds may change their direction and
intensity multiple times within same day. Largely, wind movement in the atmosphere may be
classified into three broad categories:
• Primary circulation: it includes planetary wind systems which are related to the general
arrangement of pressure belts on the earth’s surface. The pattern of the movement of the
planetary winds is called the general circulation of the atmosphere. In fact, it is the primary
circulation patterns which prepare the broad framework for the other circulation patterns.
• Secondary circulation: it consists of cyclones and anti-cyclones, monsoon
• Tertiary circulation: it includes all the local winds which are produced by local causes such
as topographical features, sea influences etc. Their impact is visible only in a particular area.
4.7.1. Planetary Winds
Primary or planetary winds blow from high pressure belts to low pressure belts in the same
direction throughout the year. They blow over vast area of continents and oceans. Trade winds,
Westerlies and polar easterlies together form the planetary wind circulation (figure 18). These
are described below:
• The air at the Inter Tropical Convergence Zone (ITCZ) rises because of convection caused by
high insolation and a low pressure is created. The winds from the tropics converge at this
low pressure zone. The converged air rises along up. It reaches the top of the troposphere
om

up to an altitude of 14 km. and moves towards the poles. This causes accumulation of air
l.c
ai

at about 300 N and S. Part of the accumulated air sinks to the ground and forms a
tm

subtropical high. Another reason for sinking is the cooling of air when it reaches 300 N and S
ho
t@

latitudes. Down below near the land surface the air flows towards the equator as the
sp

easterlies1 or tropical easterlies or trade winds. Because of Coriolis force, their direction
h.
es

becomes north-east and south-east in northern and southern hemisphere respectively. The
ur

easterlies from either side of the equator converge in the Inter Tropical Convergence Zone
ay
m

(ITCZ). Thus, winds originated at ITCZ come back in a circular fashion. Such a cell in the
tropics is called Hadley Cell.
• In the middle latitudes (300-600) the circulation is that of sinking cold air that comes from
the poles and the rising warm air that blows from the subtropical high pressure belt. These
winds are deflected due to coriolis force and become westerly in both the hemisphere.
Deflected wind is called westerlies. These winds meet along the sub-polar low pressure belt
to raise high in the troposphere. From here, air moves away in both directions – towards
pole and equator. These winds start descending down above the sup-tropical high pressure
belt and polar high pressure belt to form cells. These cells are called Ferrel cell and Polar
cell respectively.

1
Wind direction is reported by the direction from which it originates. For example, a easterly wind blows
from the east to the west.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


176 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Figure 18 – Planetary winds


• The prevailing westerlies are relatively more variable than the trade winds both in direction
and intensity. There are more frequent invasions of polar air masses along with the
travelling cyclones and anti-cyclones. These moving cells of low and high pressures largely
affect the movement of westerlies. The westerlies are stronger in the cold. In the southern
hemisphere, westerlies are so powerful and persistent due to absence of land between 400-
600 S that these are called ‘roaring forties’, ‘furious fifties’ and ‘screaming sixties’ along 400
S, 500 S and 600 S latitudes.
• Winds move away from polar high pressure to sub-polar low pressure along the surface of
the earth in Polar cell. Their direction becomes easterlies due to coriolis force. These are
om

called polar easterlies.


l.c

• Winds coming from the sub-tropical and the polar high belts converge to produce cyclonic
ai
tm

storms or low pressure conditions. This zone of convergence is also known as polar front
ho
t@

(see fronts and cyclones).


sp

4.8. Local Winds


h.
es
ur

Besides major wind systems of the earth’s surface, there are certain types of winds which are
ay
m

produced by purely local factors and therefore, are called local winds. These local winds play a
significant role in the weather and climate of a particular locality. Following is a brief account of
some of the well-known local winds which are found in different parts of the world.
4.8.1. The Land and Sea Breezes
These winds are defined as the complete cycle of diurnal local winds occurring on sea coasts
due to differences in the surface temperature of sea and adjacent land (figure 19). There is
complete reversal of wind direction of these coastal winds. The land and sea breeze system is
very shallow with average depth of 1-2km. Over lakes, the height of circulation is much less.
Warm tropical areas, where intense solar heating persists throughout the year, experience
stronger and regular breezes compare to higher latitudes. Details of land and sea breezes are
given in table 2.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


177 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Figure 19 – Sea and Land Breezes


Sea Breeze Land Breeze
During the day the land heats up faster and In the night, the land cools up faster than the
becomes warmer than the sea. The heated air surrounding sea. This creates relatively high
rises giving rise to a low pressure area, pressure on land.
whereas the sea is relatively cool and the
pressure over sea is relatively high.
Pressure gradient is created from sea to land. Pressure gradient is created from land to sea.
the wind blows from the sea to the land as the the wind blows from the land to the sea as the
sea breeze land breeze
Reaches at maximum intensity in mid- Reaches at peak shortly before the sunrise
om

afternoon
l.c
ai

Helpful for fishermen in returning from sea In morning, fishermen enter into sea with the
tm
ho

after a good catch. help of land breeze and stays there till mid-
t@

afternoon.
sp

Table 2 – land and sea breezes


h.
es

4.8.2. The Mountain and Valley Breezes


ur
ay
m

Another combination of local winds that undergoes a daily reversal consists of the mountain
and valley breezes (figure 20). During the day the slopes get heated up more than the valleys.
Hence, the pressure is low over the slopes while it is comparatively high in the valleys below.
Air moves up from slope and to fill the resulting gap the air from the valley blows up the valley.
This wind is known as the valley breeze or anabatic wind. The valley breeze is sometimes
accompanied by the formation of cumulus cloud near mountain peaks to cause orographic
rainfall.
During the night the slopes get cooled and the dense air descends into the valley as the
mountain wind. The cool air, of the high plateaus and ice fields draining into the valley is called
mountain breeze or katabatic wind.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


178 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Figure 20 – mountain and valley breezes


4.8.3. Hot Local Winds
Local winds that are hot are caused by the advection of hot air from a warm source region.
They may also be produced by dynamic heating of air as it descends from an elevated area to
lowland. Few famous hot winds are:
• ‘Loo’ is a hot and dry wind, which blows very strongly over the northern plains of India and
Pakistan in the months of May and June. Their direction is from west to east and they
are usually experienced in the afternoons. Their temperature varies between 45°C to
50°C.
• ‘Foehn’ is strong, dusty, dry and warm local wind which develops on the leeward side
of the Alps mountain ranges. Regional pressure gradient forces the air to ascend and cross
the barrier. Ascending air sometimes causes precipitation on the windward side of the
mountains. After crossing the mountain crest, the Foehn winds starts descending on the
leeward side or northern slopes of the mountain as warm and dry wind. The temperature
om

of the winds varies from 15°C to 20°C which help in melting snow. Thus making pasture
l.c

land ready for animal grazing and help the grapes to ripe early.
ai
tm

• ‘Chinook’ is the name of hot and dry local wind, which moves down the eastern slopes of
ho

the Rockies in U.S.A. and Canada. The literal meaning of chinook is ‘snow eater’ as they
t@
sp

help in melting the snow earlier. They keep the grasslands clear of snow. Hence, they are
h.

very helpful to ranchers.


es


ur

‘Sirocco’ is a hot, dry dusty wind, which originates in the Sahara desert. It is most frequent
ay

in spring and normally lasts for only a few days. After crossing the Mediterranean sea, the
m

Sirocco is slightly cooled by the moisture from the sea. Still it is harmful for vegetation,
crops in that region. Its other local names are Leveche in Spain, Khamsin in Egypt, Gharbi in
Aegean Sea area.
• Harmattan is a strong dry wind that blows over northwest Africa from the northeast.
Blowing directly from the Sahara desert, it is a hot, dry and dusty wind. It provides a
welcome relief from the moist heat and is beneficial to health of people hence also known
as ‘the doctor’. It is full of fine desert dust which makes the atmosphere hazy and causes
problems to the caravan traders. It may cause severe damage to the crops.
4.8.4. Cold Local Winds
There are certain local winds which originate in the snow-capped mountains during winter and
move down the slopes towards the valleys. Few of important these are:
• ‘Mistral’ originates on the Alps and move over France towards the Mediterranean Sea
through the Rhone valley. They are very cold, dry and high velocity winds. They bring down
temperature below freezing point in areas of their influence. As a protective measure,

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


179 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

many of the houses and orchards of the Rhone valley have thick rows of trees and hedges
planted to shield them from the Minstral.
• ‘Bora’ is a cold, dry north-easterly wind blowing down from the mountains in the Adriatic
Sea region. It is also caused by pressure difference between continental Europe and the
Mediterranean Sea. This is usually occurs in winter. It sometimes attain speeds of over 150
kmph.
• ‘Blizzard’ is a violent and extremely cold wind laden with dry snow. Such blizzards are of
common occurrence in the Antarctic. Wind velocity sometimes reaches 160 kmph and
temperature is as low as -70C.

om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.

4.9. Upper Air Circulation


es
ur
ay

It is now realized that the causes of weather on the ground are intricately bound up with what
m

happens at higher levels in the atmosphere. This applies especially to the development of anti-
cyclones and depressions and to the general circulation of winds around the globe. Such
phenomena can only be appreciated by understanding air circulation in the upper layers.
Broadly speaking, wind speed tend to increase with altitude because of lower air density, lower
frictional force etc. Direction of wind also is not same. For instance, during the month of July,
surface wind(monsoonal) blow from south-west direction in India while at the height of 10km
there are swift winds blowing from east to west.
On a global scale, pressure patterns higher up tend to be much simpler than those at the
surface level, largely because of the diminished thermal and mechanical effects of land masses.
There is a falling pressure gradient from the sub-tropical areas towards the poles. The gradient
is strongest in winter, when the temperature contrasts between the respective polar areas and
the equator are most marked.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


180 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Figure 21 – different vertical temperature gradients in the two columns create an increasing
pressure gradient.
4.9.1. Jet Streams
Changes in pressure distribution with height are largely related to changes of temperatures. We
can see how this can be so with references to two adjacent columns of air in the troposphere
depicted in figure 21. At ground level the pressure exerted by the two is the same, but
important changes ensue if we assume that column A is warmer, and therefore less dense
throughout than column B. This means that for any level higher up in the two columns, for
instance at 2km, there is a greater pressure of air still above this level of column A than in
column B. Therefore, a pressure gradient from A to B gradually develops and intensifies with
height, where none existed at the surface. Now, it can be visualized that a gradual change of
velocity of the wind with height, the wind at the top of the air layers being very much stronger
than that lower down.
om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

Figure 22 – jet streams: (a) maximum speed at centre; (b) Polar and subtropical jetstreams in
both hemispheres; (c) cross-sectional view of jet streams

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


181 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Applying this on a global scale by associating poles with cold air column and equator with warm
air column, the gradual poleward decrease of temperature in the atmosphere from the equator
should result in a large westerly component in the upper winds. It was found in 1940s during
Second World War that high-flying aircraft encountered upper winds of very great velocity.
These are known to be concentrated bands of rapid air movement, which are termed jet
streams. Few of the features of jet streams are:
• These are narrow belts at the high altitude near the top of the troposphere.
• Their speed varies from about 110 km per hour (kmph) in the summer season to more than
180 kmph in the winter season.
• Their shape is circular. Speed in the jet streams decreases radially outwards (figure 22(a)).
One way of visualizing this is to consider a river. The river's current is generally the strongest
in the center with decreasing strength as one approaches the river's bank. It can be said
that jet streams are "rivers of air".
• They are several hundred kilometers wide and about 2 km to 5km deep.
• The flow of jet streams is not in form of straight line. Their circulation path is wavy and
meandering. These meandering winds are called Rossby waves
• They dip and rise in altitude/latitude, splitting at times and forming eddies, and even
disappearing altogether to appear somewhere else.
• Jet streams also "follow the sun" in that as the sun's elevation increases each day in the
spring, the average latitude of the jet stream shifts poleward. (By Summer in the Northern
Hemisphere, it is typically found near the U.S. Canadian border.) As autumn approaches and
the sun's elevation decreases, the jet stream's average latitude moves toward the equator.
• On occasions the jet stream breaks through the tropopause and enters into the lower
stratosphere. Certain amount of water vapour manages to reach in lower stratosphere with
jet streams and this layer exhibits occasional cirus clouds. At times, the jet stream effect
extends down to an altitude of about 3 km from the earth’s surface.
• There is a well marked longitudinal variation in the strength of the jet stream. In winter, the
om

highest wind velocities of the jet stream are found near the east coast of Asia and weakest
l.c

over the eastern Atlantic and Pacific Oceans. In summer, strongest jet is positioned along
ai
tm

the Canadian border and Mediterranean region.


ho
t@

Two permanent jet stream zones occur in each hemisphere. One is sub-tropical jet stream and
sp

another is polar front jet stream. There is another jet stream which moves seasonally near
h.
es

equator. Description of these three streams is give below:


ur
ay

The polar front jet stream


m

• It is originated because of temperature difference.


• It is associated with the polar front zone7 in each hemisphere (figure 23).
• It runs at a more meandering path than the Sub Tropical Jet Stream
• It extends between 40 and 60 latitudes in both Hemispheres.
• It is found at a height between 6km and 9km in the atmosphere.
• It swings towards poles in summers and towards equator in winter. When swinging to south
it takes very cold air with it to subtropical region.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


182 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Figure 23 – origin of the Polar front Jet stream at polar front zone
Sub-tropical jet stream
• It runs between 250 and 300 latitudes in both the hemispheres.
• It blows constantly
• Its speed is comparatively lower than polar jet streams
• The air currents arising near about the equator descend at 300 N and S latitudes. A part of
these air currents takes the form of Sub Tropical Jet streams.
• It swings to the north of Himalayas in summer in North India.
Eastern Tropical Jet Stream
• It is a seasonal Jet Stream.
• It blows between equator and 200N latitude at the time of South-West Monsoon in summer
over south-east Asia, India and Africa.
• Its direction is opposite to that of other two jet streams. It runs in eastern direction.
• It is located comparatively at higher height between 14km and 16km
• Its speed is around 180 km per hour.
om

Consequence of Jet Stream


l.c
ai

• They affect weather conditions


tm
ho

• They substantially contribute to originating cyclones, anticyclones, storms and depressions


t@

and influence their behaviour.


sp


h.

The bursting of monsoon in India is said to be closely related to Eastern Tropical Jet
es

streams.
ur
ay

• If the weather is not disturbed the aeroplanes running in their parallel directions gain great
m

speed and considerably save fuel.


• Sometimes aeroplanes cannot be flown in opposite direction.
• These jet streams are still being investigated with respect to their effect on weather
conditions.

5. Air Mass
When the air remains over a homogenous area for a sufficiently longer time, it acquires the
characteristics of the area. Such homogenous areas have uniform characteristics in terms of
temperature, pressure and moisture. The air with distinctive characteristics in terms of
temperature and humidity is called an air mass. It is defined as a large body of air having little
horizontal variation in temperature and moisture. The homogenous surfaces, over which air
masses form, are called the source regions. There are five major source regions. These are:
1. Warm tropical and subtropical oceans
2. The subtropical hot deserts

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


183 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

3. The relatively cold high latitude oceans


4. The very cold snow covered continents in high latitudes
5. Permanently ice covered continents in the Arctic and Antarctica
The air masses are classified according to the source regions. Air masses originated from
tropical region are warm while those originated from polar region are cold. Air masses
originated from these regions are called primary air masses. Accordingly, following types of
airmasses are recognised:

Figure 25 – Airmasses
1. Maritime tropical (mT)
2. Continental tropical (cT)
3. Maritime polar (mP)
4. Continental polar (cP)
5. Continental arctic (cA).
Where ‘m’ stands for Maritime; ‘c’ stands for continental; ‘T’ stands for tropical; ‘P’ stands for
polar and ‘A’ stands for arctic region.
om
l.c

As these air masses move around the earth they can begin to acquire additional attributes. For
ai
tm

example, in winter an arctic air mass (very cold and dry air) can move over the ocean, picking
ho

up some warmth and moisture from the warmer ocean and becoming a maritime polar air
t@
sp

mass (mP) - one that is still fairly cold but contains moisture. If that same polar air mass moves
h.

south from Canada into the southern U.S. it will pick up some of the warmth of the ground, but
es
ur

due to lack of moisture it remains very dry. Another way of changes is internal modification in
ay

the airmasses. The resultant air mass by these processes is termed as secondary air mass. Air
m

masses can control the weather for a relatively long time period: from a period of days, to
months. Most weather occurs along the periphery of these air masses at boundaries called
fronts.

6. Fronts
When two different air masses with distinct properties (temperature, moisture, density,
pressure etc.) meet, the boundary zone between them is called a front. These air masses are
brought together by converging movements in the general atmospheric circulation. The process
of formation of the fronts is known as frontogenesis while Frontolysis is the end stage of a
front (table 3). The fronts do not mix readily. In fact, they come in contact with one another
along sloping boundaries. These sloping boundaries are actually a transition zone across which
a sharp contrast in weather condition occurs. The air masses are of vast size covering tens of
thousands of square kilometers. Therefore, frontal zones of discontinuity about 15 to 200 kms
wide are relatively narrow. So on the weather map they are represented by only a thick line. A
front can be recognized with following observations:

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


184 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

• Sharp temperature changes over a relatively short distance. Sometimes change of 100 to
200 C may be observed.
• Change in moisture content
• Rapid shifts in wind direction
• Pressure changes
• Clouds and precipitation patterns
Frontogenesis Frontolysis
creation of altogether new fronts destruction or dying of a front
Only after the process of frontogenesis have been in Process of frontolysis must continue
operation for quite some time, front do come into for some time in order to destroy an
existence existing front.
is likely to occur when the wind blow in such a way likely to occur when fronts move into
that the isotherms become packed along the leading regions of divergent air flow on
edge of the intruding air mass crossing the sub-tropical high pressure
regions, the fronts generally disappear
Convergence of the wind toward a point or divergence of the wind from a point is
contraction towards a line augments the process of helpful to the process of frontolysis
Frontogenesis.
Cyclonic wind shear witnesses the creation of fronts.
Contrarily, the areas of anti-cyclonic wind shear do
not allow the formation of fronts. Even the pre-
existing fronts degenerate in such areas.
Table 3 – difference between frontogenesis and frontolysis
As a result of the observations of atmospheric conditions at the surface and aloft, the following
types of fronts are identified:

6.1. Warm Front


om
l.c

When a warmer and lighter air mass moves against an existing cold and dense airmass, it rises
ai
tm

over the coldet and denser air mass. This type of front is known as warm front. (figure 26a). As
ho
t@

the warm air gradually ascends the gently sloping surface of the wedge of cold air lying ahead,
sp

it cools. This cooling leads to the cloudy condensation and precipitation. Unlike the cold front,
h.
es

the changes in temperature and wind direction are gradual.


ur
ay
m

Figure 26 – Fronts: (a) Warm front; (b) Cold front

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


185 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

6.2. Cold Front


When a cold and dense airmass forces its way under warm and lighter airmass it makes the
warm and lighter airmass to ride over it. This type of front is called cold front. The effect of
friction retards the air motion near the ground, while the free air aloft has a higher velocity.
This causes the cold front to become much steeper than the warm front.

6.3. Stationary Front


A stationary front forms when a cold front or warm front stops moving. This happens when two
masses of air are pushing against each other but neither is powerful enough to move the other.
Winds blowing parallel to the front instead of perpendicular can help it stay in place.

6.4. Occluded Front


Sometimes a cold front follows right behind a warm front. A warm air mass pushes into a colder
air mass (the warm front) and then another cold air mass pushes into the warm air mass
(the cold front). Because cold fronts move faster, the cold front is likely to overtake the warm
front. This is known as an occluded front.
At an occluded front, the cold air mass from the cold front meets the cool air that was ahead of
the warm front. The warm air rises as these air masses come together. Occluded fronts usually
form around areas of low atmospheric pressure. The fronts occur in middle latitudes and are
characterised by steep gradient in temperature and pressure. They bring abrupt changes in
temperature and cause the air to rise to form clouds and cause precipitation
There are two types of occlusion namely, cold front occlusion and war front occlusion (figure
27). The differences are given below in table 6.
om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es

Figure 27- cold front occlusion and warm front occlusion Figure 28 – symbols used for Fronts
ur
ay

Cold front occlusion Warm front occlusion


m

Occurs when the cold air which overtakes the Occurs when the retreating cold air mass is
warm air is colder than the retreating cold air colder than the advancing cold air mass
In the initial stage, weather system of the
warm front persists. At the later stages the
weather conditions resemble those of the cold
front.
Overtaking cold airmass plows under both air Advancing cold air being relatively less dense
masses overrides the retreating cold air mass
Table 6 – Occluded fronts – difference between cold front occlusion and warm front occlusion

7. Cyclones
The atmospheric disturbances which involve a closed circulation about a low pressure centre,
anticlockwise in the northern atmosphere and clockwise in the southern hemisphere are called
cyclones. They fall into the following two broad categories: (a) Extra-tropical and (b) tropical
cyclones.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


186 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

7.1. Extra-Tropical Cyclones


Extra-tropical cyclones are the weather disturbances in the mid and high latitude, beyond the
tropics. These latitudes are an area of convergence where contrasting air masses generally
meet to form polar fronts. The stages of development of extra-tropical cyclone are described
below with diagram.
• Initially, the front is stationary (figure 29-1).
• In the northern hemisphere, warm air blows from the south and cold air from the north of
the front. When the pressure drops along the front, the warm air moves northwards and
the cold air move towards, south setting in motion an anticlockwise cyclonic
circulation(figure 29-2).
• The cyclonic circulation leads to a well developed extra tropical cyclone, with a warm front
and a cold front (figure 29-3).
• The warm air glides over the cold air and a sequence of clouds appear over the sky ahead of
the warm front and cause precipitation (figure 29-4).
• The cold front approaches the warm air from behind and pushes the warm air up (figure
29-5). As a result, cumulus clouds develop along the cold front.
• The cold front moves faster than the warm front ultimately overtaking the warm front. The
warm air is completely lifted up and the front is occluded and the cyclone dissipates (figure
29-6).
om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

Figure 29 – life cycle of a extra-tropical cyclone

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


187 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

There is great degree of variation in shape and size of extra-tropical cyclones. Generally, the
isobars are almost circular or elliptical. However, in certain depressions, the isobars take the
shape of the letter ‘V’. Such storms are called V-shaped depression. At times, the cyclones
become so broad and shallow that they are referred to as troughs of low pressure.

Figure 30 – world: pathways of cyclones (Numbers indicate average frequency of cyclones)


Paths and movement of extra-tropical cyclone – the general direction of movement of
temperate cyclones is from west to east with frequent trends towards the southeast to
northeast (figure 30). They are subject to the general westerly flow of atmosphere in temperate
zone. The heavy concentration of storms tracks in the vicinity of the Aleutian(Islands west to
the Alaska Peninsula) and Icelandic lows is the most important feature of the distribution of
extra-tropical cyclones. During winter months, the opposing air masses have greater contrasts
in their properties. So the winter cyclones are greater in number and are more intense. On an
om

average cyclone may cover a distance of about 1000 km per day. Cyclones invariably move
l.c

towards higher latitudes.


ai
tm
ho

Secondary cyclones – under the normal conditions, in the later stages of occlusion the cyclone
t@

weakens and ultimately dissipates. But sometimes, during the late maturing stage of a cyclone,
sp

a new low develops on the equatorward margin of the original cyclone. Thus, a secondary
h.
es

cyclone is formed which passes through different stages of its life cycle and matures very
ur
ay

rapidly. It may follow the tract of primary cyclone or may move along new path.
m

Cyclone families – It is found that an extra-tropical cyclone never appears alone. It is usually
followed by three or four cyclones forming a series. The primary or the leading cyclone gets
occluded, while the new ones originate on the trailing front and are in an incipient stage. In the
rear of the last member of the cyclone family there is an outbreak of polar air which builds up
an anti-cyclone. Original cyclone would be in high latitudes and each secondary cyclone would
follow progressively a more southerly path. Cyclone families frequent the oceans in a larger
number.
Extra-tropical cyclone and Jet stream – there is a close relationship between the flow aloft and
the cyclonic storm at the surface. Rossby waves produced at the top of troposphere helps in
transporting large bodies of polar air to the lower latitudes and tropical air masses are carried
to the higher latitudes. This results in the intensity of surface cyclonic activity. There are
instances when extra-tropical cyclones form without the prior existence of a polar front. These
depressions are actually initiated by a trough in the upper-air westerlies. Once such storms
originate in the lower atmosphere they attract different air masses together which leads to the
generation of fronts.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


188 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

7.2. Tropical Cyclones


The tropical cyclone develops from the ‘warm core’ of extremely low pressure area in the
tropical oceanic areas. They are energized from the condensation process in the towering
cumulonimbus clouds, surrounding the centre of the storm. The arrangement of isobars is
almost circular. With continuous supply of moisture from the sea, the storm is further
strengthened. On reaching the land the moisture supply is cut off and the storm dissipates. The
place where a tropical cyclone crosses the coast is called the landfall of the cyclone. The
conditions favourable for the formation and intensification of tropical storms are:
• Large sea surface with temperature higher than 27° C
• Presence of the Coriolis force
• Small variations in the vertical wind speed
• A pre-existing weak low-pressure area or low-level-cyclonic circulation -
• Upper divergence above the sea level system.
Large and continuous supply of warm and moist air from the ocean provides necessary energy
in the form of latent heat of condensation. Coriolis force causes cyclonic circulation. At the
equator, the Coriolis force is zero and the wind blows perpendicular to the isobars. The low
pressure gets filled instead of getting intensified. That is the reason why tropical cyclones are
not formed near the equator.
Because of small variations in the vertical wind speed or wind shear, cyclone formation
processes are limited to latitudes equatorword of the sub-tropical jet stream. It is the pre-
existing low pressure area which intensifies and develops as cyclone. It must be pointed out
that only a few of these disturbances develop into true tropical cyclones. Upper divergence
helps in ascending air currents to be pumped out to maintain the low pressure at the centre of
the cyclone.
Tropical cyclone shown in figure 31 has following features:
om

• Eye – it is the centre of cyclone around which strong spirally winds circulate in a mature
l.c
ai

tropical cyclone. It is a region of calm with subsiding air.


tm


ho

Eye Wall – there is a strong spiraling ascent of air to greater height reaching the
t@

tropopause. The wind reaches maximum velocity in this region, reaching as high as 250 km
sp

per hour. Torrential rain occurs here. From the eye wall rain bands may radiate and trains of
h.
es

cumulus and cumulonimbus clouds may drift into the outer region.
ur


ay

The diameter of the circulating system can vary between 150 and 250 km.
m

• The diameter of the storm over the Bay of Bengal, Arabian Sea and Indian Ocean is
between 600 - 1200 km. The system moves slowly about 300 - 500 km per day.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


189 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Figure 31 – tropical cyclone Figure 32 – different names of tropical cyclone


Impact on humans
• This is one of the most devastating natural calamities. They move over to the coastal areas
bringing about large scale destruction caused by violent winds, very heavy rainfall and
storm surges.
om

• The cyclones, which cross 20oN latitude generally, re-curve and they are more destructive.
l.c

• Trees are uprooted and broken and the loose objects swept away.
ai
tm

• A particular location on the land surface encounters opposite winds twice from the circular
ho
t@

fashion of the cyclone. These winds create more damage to objects.


sp

• Torrential rains that occur in the towering cumulonimbus clouds inundate the low-lying
h.
es

areas, cause floods and landslides resulting in great loss of life and property damage.
ur

• Strom waves of great heights are great hazard to shipping. These are called storm surge
ay
m

whose height may go up to 20 meters. If cyclone wave combines with the spring tide, the
result is disastrous.

Naming of tropical cyclones - In the beginning, storms(tropical cyclone) were named arbitrarily.
Then the mid -1900's saw the start of the practice of using feminine names for storms. In the
pursuit of a more organized and efficient naming system, meteorologists later decided to
identify storms using names from a list arranged alphabetically.
There is a strict procedure to determine a list of tropical cyclone names in an ocean
basin(s) by the Tropical Cyclone Regional Body responsible for that basin(s) at its
annual/biennial meeting. There are five tropical cyclones regional bodies. The Regional
Specialized Meteorological Centre (RSMC) – Tropical cyclones is responsible for monitoring and
prediction of tropical cyclones over their respective regions. They are also responsible to name
the cyclones.
In general, tropical cyclones are named according to the rules at a regional level. The
WMO/ESCAP Panel on Tropical Cyclones at its twenty-seventh Session held in 2000 in Muscat,

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


190 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Sultanate of Oman agreed in principal to assign names to the tropical cyclones in the Bay of
Bengal and Arabian Sea. After long deliberations among the member countries, the
naming of the tropical cyclones over north Indian Ocean commenced from September
2004. The list of names India has added to the database includes Agni, Akash, Bijli, Jal (cyclones
which have all occurred since 2004). The Indian names in the queue are Leher, Megh, Sagar and
Vayu, while those suggested by Pakistan include Nilofar, Titli and Bulbul.
If public wants to suggest the name of a cyclone to be included in the list , the
proposed name must meet some fundamental criteria. The name should be short and
readily understood when broadcast. Further the names must not be culturally sensitive and not
convey some unintended and potentially inflammatory meaning. A storm causes so much
death and destruction that its name is considered for retirement and hence is not used
repeatedly. Names are usually assigned to tropical cyclones with one-, three-, or ten-minute
sustained wind speeds of more than 65 km/h depending on which area it originates.
Importance for naming tropical cyclones:
• It would help identify each individual tropical cyclone.
• It helps the public to become fully aware of its development.
• Local and international media become focused to the tropical cyclone.
• It does not confuse the public when there is more than one tropical cyclone in the same
area.
• The name of the tropical cyclone is well remembered by million of people as it is
unforgettable event whose name will long be remembered.
• Warnings reach a much wider audience very rapidly.
• It heightens interest in warnings and increases community preparedness.

Difference between extra-tropical cyclone and tropical cyclone is given in table 7 below:
Extra-tropical cyclone Tropical cyclone
om

have a clear frontal system and get energy Fronts are not present and get energy from
l.c
ai

from the horizontal temperature contrasts warm and moist air of ocean
tm

that exist in the atmosphere


ho
t@

Large size (1500-3000km) Relatively small in size


sp

can originate over the land and sea originate only over the seas
h.
es

Travel both on oceans and land on reaching the land they dissipate.
ur
ay

Affects a much larger area as compared to the


m

tropical cyclone.
Wind velocity in a tropical cyclone is much
higher and it is more destructive.
move from west to east move from east to west
Table 7 – comparison between tropical and extra-tropical cyclone

7.3. Thunderstorms and Tornadoes


Unlike Tropical Cyclones, thunderstorms and tornadoes are highly localized weather
phenomenon. They are of short duration, occurring over a small area but are violent. They are
so small and short lived as to make their prediction very difficult.
A storm accompanied by thunder and lightning is called thunderstorm. It is associated with the
cumulonimbus clouds.. Thunderstorms are caused by intense convection on moist hot days.
When the clouds extend to heights where sub-zero temperature prevails, hails are formed and
they come down as hailstorm. If there is insufficient moisture, a thunderstorm can generate

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


191 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

dust storms. Stages in the development of thunderstorm are described below and shown in
figure 33.
1. Cumulus stage: Warm, moist air rises in a buoyant plume or in a series of convective
updrafts. As this occurs the air begins to condense into a cumulus cloud. As the warm air
within the cloud continues to rise, it eventually cools and condenses. The condensation
releases heat into the cloud, warming the air. This, in turn, causes it to rise
adiabatically. The convective cloud continues to grow upward, eventually growing above
the freezing level where super-cooled water droplets and ice crystals coexist Precipitation
begins once the air rises above the freezing level.
2. Mature stage: it is characterized by the presence of both updrafts and downdrafts within
the cloud. The downdrafts are initiated by the downward drag of falling precipitation. Cold
descending air in the downdraft will often reach the ground before the precipitation. As the
mature-stage thunderstorm develops, the cumulus cloud continues to increase in size,
height and width. Cloud to ground lightning usually begins when the precipitation first falls
from the cloud base. During this phase of the life cycle, the top of the resulting
cumulonimbus cloud will start to flatten out, forming an anvil shape often at the top of the
troposphere.

om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

Figure 33 – three stages in the development of a thunderstorm: (a) cumulus stage; (b) Mature
stage; (c) Dissipating stage
3. Dissipating stage: It is characterized by downdrafts throughout the entire cloud. Decay often
begins when the super-cooled cloud droplets freeze and the cloud becomes glaciated, which
means that it contains ice crystals. The cloud begins to collapse because no additional latent
heat is released after the cloud droplets freeze, and because the shadow of the cloud and rain
cooled downdrafts reduce the temperature below the cloud.
7.3.1. What Causes Lightning and Thunder
The rising air in a thunderstorm cloud causes various types of frozen precipitation to form
within the cloud. Included in these precipitation types are very small ice crystals and much
larger pellets of snow and ice. The smaller ice crystals are carried upward toward the top of the
clouds by the rising air while the heavier and denser pellets are either suspended by the rising
air or start falling toward the ground. Collisions occur between the ice crystals and the pellets,
and these collisions serve as the charging mechanism of the thunderstorm. The small ice

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


192 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

crystals become positively charged while the pellets become negatively charged. As a result, the
top of the cloud becomes positively charged and the middle to lower part of the storm
becomes negatively charged. When the strength of the charge overpowers the insulating
properties of the atmosphere, lightning happens.
At the same time, the ground underneath the cloud becomes charged oppositely of the charges
directly overhead. When the charge difference between the ground and the cloud becomes too
large, a conductive channel of air develops between the cloud and the ground, and a small
amount of charge (step leader) starts moving toward the ground. When it nears the ground, an
upward leader of opposite charge connects with the step leader. At the instant this connection
is made, a powerful discharge occurs between the cloud.
The channel of air through which lightning passes can be heated to 50,000°F—hotter than the
surface of the sun! The rapid heating and cooling of the air near the lightning channel causes a
shock wave that results in the sound we know as “thunder.”

7.3.2. Why Thunders are Cause of Concern


Each year, many people are killed or seriously injured by severe thunderstorms despite the
advance warning. While severe thunderstorms are most common in the spring and summer,
they can occur at just about any time of the year. Cloud-to-ground lightning, Hail, Tornadoes
om

and waterspouts, Flash flood and Downburst are some of the hazards associated with
l.c

thunderstorm.
ai
tm

There is no safe place outside during a thunderstorm but building constructed according to
ho
t@

current guidance could provide safe seltor and avoid injury or death.
sp
h.

Tornado – From severe thunderstorms sometimes spiraling wind descends like a trunk of an
es
ur

elephant with great force, with very low pressure at the centre causing massive destruction on
ay

its way. Such a phenomenon is called a tornado. Excessive instability and steep lapse rate in the
m

atmosphere are necessary pre-requisite for the development of a tornado. Tornadoes generally
occur in middle latitudes. The tornado over the sea is called water sprouts. Chief features of
tornadoes are:
• Tornado’s funnel can have size of 90-460m in diameter.
• Tornadoes generally occur in middle latitudes.
• Tornadoes are the most violent of all the storms.
• They are very small in size and of short duration which makes weather prediction difficult.
• The velocity of winds revolving tightly around the core reaches more than 300 km per hour.
• It causes massive destruction on its way.
• When looked at from the ground, the funnel appears dark because of the presence of
condensed moisture and the dust and debris picked up from the ground by the whirling
tornado.
• Tornadoes may be found to be moving singly or in families of several individual tornadoes.
• These generally move in straight paths.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


193 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

These violent storms are the manifestation of the atmosphere’s adjustments to varying energy
distribution. The potential and heat energies are converted into kinetic energy in these storms
and the restless atmosphere again returns to its stable state.

References:
1. Since sunspots are darker than the surrounding photosphere it might be expected that
more sunspots would lead to less solar radiation and a decreased solar constant. However,
om
l.c

the surrounding margins of sunspots are brighter than the average, and so are hotter;
ai

overall, more sunspots increase the Sun's solar constant or brightness.


tm
ho

2. Electromagnetic radiation is a term used to describe all the different kinds of energies
t@

released into space by stars such as the Sun.


sp
h.

3. A photon is an elementary particle, the quantum of light and all other forms
es

of electromagnetic radiation
ur
ay

4. Conductor of heat - Ability to transfer heat to adjacent molecules.


m

5. The latent heat of condensation for water is defined as the heat released when one mole
of the substance condenses to form liquid droplets from water vapour. The temperature
does not change during this process, so heat released goes directly into changing the state
of the substance. The heat of condensation of water is equal to 40.8 kJ/mol. The heat of
condensation is numerically exactly equal to the heat vaporization, but has the opposite
sign.
6. Albedo: it is reflectivity or reflecting power of a surface. It is defined as the ratio of
reflected radiation from the surface to incident radiation upon it. Albedos of typical
materials in visible light range from up to 0.9 for fresh snow to about 0.04 for charcoal, one
of the darkest substances.
7. The polar front is the boundary between the polar cell and the Ferrel cell in
each hemisphere. At this boundary a sharp gradient in temperature occurs between these
two air masses, each at very different temperatures.
8. An adiabatic process is a process that occurs without the transfer of heat or matter
between a system and its surroundings.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


194 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

UPSC Previous Years’ Mains Questions


1. The recent cyclone on east coast of India was called 'Phailin'. How are the tropical cyclones
named across the world? Elaborate. (100 words)(UPSC 2013/5 marks)
2. What do you understand by the phenomenon of 'temperature inversion' in meteorology?
How does it affect weather and the habitants of the place? (100 words) (UPSC 2013/5
marks)
3. List the significant local storms of the hot-weather season in the country and bring out their
socio-economic impact. (UPSC 2010/12 Marks)
4. Write about Nor’westers in 20 words. (UPSC 2008/15 Marks)

om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

Copyright © by Vision IAS


All rights are reserved. No part of this document may be reproduced, stored in a retrieval system or
transmitted in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording or
otherwise, without prior permission of Vision IAS.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


195 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

PRECIPITATION AND RELATED PHENOMENA


Contents
1. Introduction ........................................................................................................................... 197
2. Water vapour ......................................................................................................................... 197
2.1. Importance of Water Vapour .......................................................................................... 197
3. The Water Cycle ..................................................................................................................... 197
4. Humidity ................................................................................................................................. 198
4.1. Absolute Humidity .......................................................................................................... 198
4.2. Specific Humidity ............................................................................................................ 198
4.3. Relative Humidity ............................................................................................................ 198
4.3.1. Significance of Relative Humidity ............................................................................. 199
4.3.2. The Horizontal Distribution of Relative Humidity .................................................... 199
5. Evaporation ............................................................................................................................ 199
6. Condensation ......................................................................................................................... 200
6.1. Latent Heat ...................................................................................................................... 200
6.2. Saturated Air ................................................................................................................... 200
6.3. Hygroscopic Nuclei .......................................................................................................... 200
6.4. Dew point ........................................................................................................................ 200
7. Dew ........................................................................................................................................ 200
8. Frost ....................................................................................................................................... 201
9. Fog .......................................................................................................................................... 201
9.1. Impact of Fog .................................................................................................................. 201
10. Mist ...................................................................................................................................... 202
11. Smog..................................................................................................................................... 202
12. Haze...................................................................................................................................... 203
13. Atmospheric Brown Cloud (ABC)/Asian Brown Cloud.......................................................... 203
om

14. Clouds................................................................................................................................... 203


l.c
ai

15. Types of Clouds .................................................................................................................... 204


tm

15.1. Cirrus (Curl of Hair) Clouds............................................................................................ 204


ho
t@

15.2. Cumulus (Heap) Clouds ................................................................................................. 204


sp

15.3. Stratus (Layer) Clouds ................................................................................................... 204


h.
es

16. International Classification of Clouds................................................................................... 205


ur

17. Precipitation ......................................................................................................................... 206


ay
m

18. Necessary Conditions for RAINFALL ..................................................................................... 207


19. Types of Rainfall ................................................................................................................... 207
19.1. Convectional Rainfall ..................................................................................................... 207
19.2. Orographic Rain............................................................................................................. 208
19.3. Cyclonic or Frontal Rainfall ............................................................................................ 208
20. Distribution of Precipitation ................................................................................................. 209
20.1. Seasonal Distribution of Rainfall ................................................................................... 210
21. Prelims Questions ................................................................................................................ 211

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


196 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

1. Introduction
Precipitation is vital for life on Earth, but it can also be an inconvenience. Precipitation is any
product of the condensation of atmospheric water vapour that falls under gravity. The main
forms of precipitation include drizzle, rain, sleet, snow, graupel and hail. Let us first discuss
some basic concepts

2. Water vapour
Water is present in the atmosphere in three forms namely – gaseous, liquid and solid.. The
water vapour constitute about 2 per cent of the total composition of the atmosphere. This
percentage varies from zero per cent in cold dry air of the Arctic regions during the winter
season to as much as 5 per cent of the volume in warm humid equatorial regions.
The temperature of the atmosphere is the most important factor, as the capacity of the warm
air to hold water vapour is more than that of the cold air. About half of the total moisture
present in the atmosphere is concentrated in the lower layer of the atmosphere up to a height
of about 2 kilometres.

2.1. Importance of Water Vapour


The water vapour present in the atmosphere is an important factor for the weather conditions
in a particular region. The amount of water vapour present in the atmosphere influences the
nature and amount of precipitation, the amount of loss of heat through radiation from the
earth’s surface, the surface temperature, the latent heat of the atmosphere, the stability and
instability of the air masses. Necessary energy for the development of storms (cyclones,
hurricanes etc.) is provided by the water vapour in the form of latent heat energy.

3. The Water Cycle


There is a constant and continuous circulation of water from the Earth’s surface to the
om

atmosphere and back to the Earth’s surface. This circulation of water is called the water cycle or
l.c

the hydrological cycle. The water cycle has no beginning or end, rather it is an intricate
ai
tm

combination of evaporation, transpiration, air mass movement, condensation, precipitation,


ho
t@

run-off and groundwater movement.


sp
h.

The Sun's heat provides energy to evaporate water from the Earth's surface (oceans, lakes,
es

etc.). Plants also lose water to the air (this is called transpiration). The water vapor eventually
ur
ay

condenses, forming tiny droplets in clouds. When the clouds meet cool air over land,
m

precipitation (rain, sleet, or snow) is triggered, and water returns to the land (or sea). Some of
the precipitation soaks into the ground. Some of the underground water is trapped between
rock or clay layers; this is called groundwater. But most of the water flows downhill as runoff
(above ground or underground), eventually returning to the seas as slightly salty water.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


197 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

4. Humidity
Humidity refers to the amount of water vapour present in the atmosphere at a particular time
and place. Humidity in the air is due to the various processes of evaporation from the land and
water surfaces of the Earth. It can be expressed as an absolute, specific or a relative value.

4.1. Absolute Humidity


om

The Absolute Humidity is the weight of actual amount of water vapour present in a unit volume
l.c

of air. Generally it is expressed as grams per cubic meter of air. The absolute humidity varies
ai
tm

from place-to-place and from time-to-time. It decreases from the equator towards the poles. .
ho

Generally, the absolute humidity changes as air temperature or pressure changes. However, if
t@

temperature increases but there is no excess water for evaporation then absolute humidity will
sp
h.

not change.
es
ur

4.2. Specific Humidity


ay
m

The Absolute Humidity is the weight of actual amount of water vapour present in a unit weight
of air. Generally it is expressed as grams per kilogram of air.

4.3. Relative Humidity


Relative humidity is a better way of expressing the level of humidity in the air. It is the ratio of
actual amount of water vapour present in air at a given temperature to the amount of water
vapour air can hold at the same temperature. The Relative Humidity is expressed in
percentages.

𝑅𝑒𝑙𝑎𝑡𝑖𝑣𝑒 𝐻𝑢𝑚𝑖𝑑𝑖𝑡𝑦
𝐴𝑏𝑠𝑜𝑙𝑢𝑡𝑒 𝐻𝑢𝑚𝑖𝑑𝑖𝑡𝑦
(𝐴𝑐𝑡𝑢𝑎𝑙 𝑎𝑚𝑜𝑢𝑛𝑡 𝑜𝑓 𝑤𝑎𝑡𝑒𝑟 𝑣𝑎𝑝𝑜𝑢𝑟 𝑝𝑟𝑒𝑠𝑒𝑛𝑡 𝑖𝑛 𝑡ℎ𝑒 𝑎𝑖𝑟 𝑎𝑡 𝑎 𝑔𝑖𝑣𝑒𝑛 𝑡𝑒𝑚𝑝𝑒𝑟𝑎𝑡𝑢𝑟𝑒)
=
𝐻𝑢𝑚𝑖𝑑𝑖𝑡𝑦 𝑅𝑒𝑡𝑒𝑛𝑡𝑖𝑣𝑒 𝑐𝑎𝑝𝑎𝑐𝑖𝑡𝑦
(𝐴𝑚𝑜𝑢𝑛𝑡 𝑜𝑓 𝑤𝑎𝑡𝑒𝑟 𝑣𝑎𝑝𝑜𝑢𝑟 𝑡ℎ𝑎𝑡 𝑐𝑎𝑛 𝑏𝑒 ℎ𝑒𝑙𝑑 𝑏𝑦 𝑡ℎ𝑒 𝑠𝑎𝑚𝑒 𝑎𝑡 𝑡ℎ𝑒 𝑠𝑎𝑚𝑒 𝑡𝑒𝑚𝑝𝑒𝑟𝑎𝑡𝑢𝑟𝑒)

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


198 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Generally capacity to hold water vapour increases with increase in temperature and decreases
with decrease in temperature. Thus, the relative humidity of the air decreases with increase in
temperature and vice versa Changes in the Relative Humidity of Air1

Changes in Relative Humidity can occur in the following three ways:


I. The temperature remaining the same and amount of water vapour in air increases. Its
relative humidity will also increase.
II. When the temperature of air rises its humidity retentive capacity also rises
correspondingly and the Relative Humidity decreases.
III. If the temperature of air decreases its humidity retentive capacity also decreases and
Relative Humidity increases.
4.3.1. Significance of Relative Humidity
The absolute humidity determines the amount of precipitation while the relative humidity tells
us about the possibility of precipitation. The high and low relative humidity indicates the
possibility of wet and dry conditions respectively. Evaporation decreases when there is high
relative humidity and vice versa. Relative humidity is directly related to human health. That is
why, the equatorial region with high temperature and high relative humidity, and the tropical
hot deserts with very low relative humidity are unfavourable for human health.

Absolute Humidity Relative Humidity

It helps us to know the actual amount of It shows the ratio of water vapour actually
water vapour present in air. present in the air at a given temperature to the
retentive capacity of humidity of the same parcel
of air at the same temperature.

It does not take temperature into account. It takes temperature into account.
om

It is expressed in grams per cubic metre. It is expressed in percentages.


l.c
ai
tm

It Is not a useful measure of humidity It is a useful measure of humidity because it can


ho

because it does not tell us the amount of show how far the air is humid.
t@
sp

water vapour required for the air to become


h.

saturated.
es
ur
ay

4.3.2. The Horizontal Distribution of Relative Humidity


m

The equatorial region is characterized by the highest relative humidity. Relative humidity
gradually decreases towards the Tropical high pressure belts (between 25°—35° latitudes) .
After this, the relative humidity again increases polewards. The zones of high and low relative
humidity shift northward and southward with the apparent migration of the Sun, during the
summer and winter solstices respectively. Relative humidity is maximum in the mornings and
minimum in the evenings.

5. Evaporation
The process of transformation of liquid (water) into gaseous form (water vapour) is called
evaporation. The amount and rate of evaporation at a particular place depend upon the aridity

1
If any question based on change of a property(say temperature) is asked consider other factors (say
moisture) as constant unless otherwise specified.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


199 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

(vapour pressure), temperature and the movement of air. Evaporation is faster in dry air than in
the wet air. There is more evaporation from the ocean than from the land. A special case of
evaporation is transpiration which entails loss of water from the leaves and stems of the plants.

6. Condensation
The process of transforming of water vapour into water (liquid) and ice (solid) is called
condensation. Condensation takes place due to the loss of heat and can occur in one of the
following ways: a. When the warm moist air rises upwards and expands. b. When the warm
moist air comes in contact with the cold surface. c. When the warm moist air mixes with the air
coming from the colder regions.

6.1. Latent Heat


At the time of evaporation, heat is absorbed and conserved in water vapour (This is why
Evaporation leads to cooling). It is known as latent heat. It is this same heat which is released
when water vapour again changes into water through the process of condensation. Latent heat
is essential for development of typhoons (storms, cyclones).

6.2. Saturated Air


If at any given temperature the humidity retentive capacity of air equals its absolute humidity
the air is said to be saturated. In other words the same parcel of air can no longer absorb or
accept any further amount of water vapour at the same temperature. 100 per cent humid air is
called saturated air.

6.3. Hygroscopic Nuclei


Condensation always takes place around some particles present in air. These may be dust
particles, smoke, oceanic salts or carbon dioxide which act as nuclei to hold water. They are
thus called condensation nuclei or hygroscopic nuclei.
om

6.4. Dew point


l.c
ai
tm

Condensation of water vapour in the atmosphere begins when the saturated air mass reaches
ho

the dew point. This is level at which the air is not in a position to take up any more moisture.
t@
sp

Any further fall in temperature, beyond the dew point, would cause the condensation of the
h.

moisture present in the air. In the atmosphere, the nuclei for the condensation of the moisture
es
ur

is provided by the smoke and the dust particles.


ay
m

Once the condensation of water vapour in the atmosphere has taken place, the moisture
present in the atmosphere may take one of the following forms— dew, frost, fog, mist, clouds,
etc. This will be according to the conditions prevalent in the atmosphere.

7. Dew
When the relative humidity of the air is low, even a drop in temperature during the winter
nights fails to saturate the air. Hence condensation does not take place in free air but on some
solid objects like leaves, flowers, grass blades, pieces of rocks, etc., which become
comparatively cool due to the quick radiation at night. When the cool air comes in contact with
these objects, the dew point is reached and condensation takes place. The deposition of water
droplets on these objects is called dew.
Some favourable conditions for the formation of dew are the following:
1) Long Nights: During long nights earth’s surface is cooled. With the coming into contact of
humid air with this surface, condensation occurs.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


200 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

2) Cloudless Clear Sky: On account of cloudless and clear sky there is more heating during the
day. Hence evaporation will also be more and also rapid cooling of surface at night due to
terrestrial radiation.
3) Calm Air: Calm air remains in contact with the surface for longer duration. It is a favourable
condition for condensation.
4) Relative Humidity: High relative humidity promotes more condensation. That is why
condensation can be more in the months of August -September in India.

8. Frost
Frost is actually frozen dew. It is formed when temperature of dew point fall below freezing
point. Under such conditions droplets of condensation near or on the ground are frozen.
Generally for formation of dew and frost the conditions are similar. Only temperature should
fall below freezing point for the formation of frost

Dew Frost

It can be seen as droplets of water on leaves of It can be found on solid surfaces of earth’s
small plants or blades of grass. crust as ice or snow crystal.

It Is formed when temperature of dew point is It is formed when temperature is below


above freezing point. freezing point.

It is useful for plants. It is harmful for plant growth.

9. Fog
Fog is a special type of thin cloud consisting of very small water droplets which remain
suspended in air close to the surface of the Earth. Fog is formed due to condensation of water
droplets suspended in the atmosphere in the vicinity of the earth’s surface under certain
om

conditions, such as low temperature and high relative humidity.. During the winter season,
l.c

excessive radiation at night results in the fall of air temperature. The condensation of water
ai
tm

vapour takes place around the dust and smoke particles that remain suspended in the air. It is
ho

called fog. The formation of fog near the surface of the Earth does not involve ascent and
t@
sp

consequent expansion of air. The visibility is greatly reduced (less than one km).
h.
es

Fog is of three types:


ur
ay

1) Radiation Fog: The surface is cooled at night due to terrestrialradiation and the air which
m

come into contact with it also gets cooled. Consequently tiny droplets forming the clouds
are called radiation fog. It is not very thick and this thickness varies from 10 to 30 metres.
2) Advection Fog: It is formed when there is fall in temperature of warm moist air moving
horizontally over a cold surface. It is cooled by contact and sometimes by mixing with cold
air prevailing over cold surfaces.
3) Frontal or Precipitation Fog: The dividing line separating cold and warm air masses are
known as fronts. At these fronts convergence of warm and cold air takes place and fog is
formed. The warm air in the frontal area is light and rises above the cold air mass. It then
begins to cool and when the temperature reaches dew point, frontal fog is formed.

9.1. Impact of Fog


Fog hinders travel by land, air and sea. When the fog is polluted it becomes poisonous and
causes serious health hazards. Agriculture sector is also affected since fog adversely hits late-
sowing crops. Fog is beneficial to the tea and coffee plants as it protects them from the
scorching sunlight on the hill slopes.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


201 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

10. Mist
It is also a type of fog but is relatively less dense. The only difference between mist and fog is
density and its effect on visibility. A cloud that reduces visibility to less than 1 km is called fog,
whereas it's called mist if visibility range is between 1 and 2 km. Mists are frequent over
mountains as the rising warm air up the slopes meets a cold surface. Fogs are drier than mist
and they are prevalent where warm currents of air come in contact with cold currents. Mist can
occur as part of natural weather or volcanic activity or could be created artificially.

11. Smog
It refers to a mixture of smoke and fog. It also results from sun’s effect on certain pollutants in
the air, notably those from automobile exhaust. There are two main types of smog—
photochemical and industrial.
The photochemical smog is a mixture of primary and secondary pollutants. The primary
pollutants are hydrocarbons and nitrogen oxides and their main source is the motor vehicles.
The secondary pollutants are formed when sunlight acts upon motor vehicle exhaust gases to
form harmful substances such as ozone (O3), aldehydes and peroxyacetylnitrate (PAN).
Photochemical smog formation requires (1)a still, sunny day and (2)temperature inversion
(pollutants accumulate in the lower inversion layer). The photochemical smog directly affect
lungs and eyes, causing irritation in these organs.
om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

The industrial smog is a mixture of sulphur dioxide and a variety of solid and liquid particles
suspended in air.It comes from the stationary sources, such as furnaces, power plants, etc.,
than from motor vehicles. Sulphur dioxide in combination with water and oxygen can turn into

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


202 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

sulphuric acid in the atmosphere and falls on the earth as acid rain. It can dissolve marble and
eat away iron and steel. In human it can affect the respiratory system.

Photochemical smog
Industrial smog
Name: (Los Angeles smog, Denver smog, brown
(New York smog, gray smog)
smog)
Weather: cool, damp sunny
Content: particulates, sulfur oxides NOx, ozone, hydrocarbons, PAN
Sources: coal, etc. gasoline(Petrol), combustion.

12. Haze
is traditionally an atmospheric phenomenon where dust, smoke and other dry particles obscure
the clarity of the sky. The World Meteorological Organization manual of codes includes a
classification of horizontal obscuration into categories of fog, ice fog, steam fog, mist, haze,
smoke, volcanic ash, dust, sand and snow. Sources for haze particles include farming (ploughing
in dry weather), traffic, industry, and wildfires. One way to distinguish between smog and
naturally-occurring haze is by color. Natural haze is typically white, gray or even blue. Smog is
almost always yellowish or brown in color.
The international definition of fog is a visibility of less than 1 kilometre; mist is a visibility of
between 1 kilometre and 2 kilometres and haze from 2 kilometres to 5 kilometres . Fog and
mist are generally assumed to be composed principally of water droplets, haze and smoke can
be of smaller particle size.

13. Atmospheric Brown Cloud (ABC)/Asian Brown Cloud


om
l.c

The ABC originally referred to the enormous blanket of pollution spreading across Asia,
ai
tm

distorting normal weather patterns in the region and threatening to devastate many countries’
ho

economies. It was called the ‘Asian Brown Cloud’ in 2002, when a UN report first warned of this
t@

layer of pollution comprising ash, acids and aerosols. At that time, the two-mile thick haze
sp
h.

extended ominously across the most densely populated areas of the world: southern, south-
es
ur

eastern, and eastern Asia. Subsequently, however, similar patterns were detected elsewhere in
ay

the world and it was renamed ‘Atmospheric Brown Cloud’.


m

Asia is particularly vulnerable as the ABC causes changes in the winter monsoon season, sharply
reducing rain over northwestern parts of the continent and increasing rain along the eastern
coast. However, India's scientific community have said the atmospheric brown clouds over Asia
are a seasonal, temporary phenomena which may look bad, but have none of the catastrophic
implications mentioned in the UN report.

14. Clouds
When the moist air ascends, it expands, loses temperature, becomes cool, and gets saturated.
With further decrease in temperature beyond the dew point, condensation of the moisture
takes place high up in the air and it results in the formation of clouds. Clouds are droplets of
water or tiny ice crystals which collect around the dust particles present in the atmosphere.
The water droplets and tiny ice crystals that remain suspended in the air can be disturbed by
the slightest movement of the air. All forms of precipitation occur from the clouds. It should
be noted that not all clouds yield precipitation but no precipitation is possible without the

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


203 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

clouds. The clouds play a major role in the heat budget of the Earth and the atmosphere, as
they reflect, absorb and diffuse some part of the incoming solar radiation. They also absorb a
part of the outgoing terrestrial radiation and then re-radiate it back to the Earth’s surface.
Whenever there are clouds in the sky, some sort of precipitation always occurs, although we do
not feel it on the Earth. Much of it is re-evaporated during its descent through the warm and
dry air. Clouds are more common on the windward slopes of the mountains than on the
leeward slopes. Clouds are more frequent during the cyclones than during the anticyclones.

15. Types of Clouds


Luke Howard, an English biologist, was the first to classify clouds in 1803. He used Latin names
which are still in vogue. Clouds are usually classified on the basis of altitude, shape, expanse,
density, colour, transparency, opaqueness, moisture content, etc. They exist at various
elevations from the sea level to about 20 km above the sea level. There are three basic groups
depending upon the height and shape of clouds. These are the cirrus clouds, the cumulus
clouds and the stratus clouds.

15.1. Cirrus (Curl of Hair) Clouds


Cirrus clouds are formed at high altitudes (8,000 - 12,000m). Being at considerable height these
clouds are formed of ice crystals and therefore are white and thin. They are detached, fibrous,
feathery, often with silky sheen in direct sunlight.

15.2. Cumulus (Heap) Clouds


Cumulus clouds look like cotton wool. They are generally formed at a height of 4,000 -7,000 m.
They exist in patches and can be seen scattered here and there. With a flat base on rising they
appear like domes at the top. Their appearance and structure is like that of a Cauliflower.

15.3. Stratus (Layer) Clouds


om

As their name implies, these are layered clouds covering large portions of the sky. These clouds
l.c

are generally formed either due to loss of heat or the mixing of air masses with different
ai
tm

temperatures.
ho
t@

The rain bearing clouds are generally the low level clouds and are given the prefix or suffix-
sp

‘nimbus’, a Latin word meaning a rainy cloud.


h.
es
ur

Note: Whichever clouds you see in the sky these might be one or more of their types or their
ay
m

combinations or even in changed appearances.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


204 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

16. International Classification of Clouds


The World Meteorological Organisation presented a detailed International Atlas of Clouds
mentioning three main groups and ten main types of clouds.

Cloud Height in Cloud Types


Group meters

High Clouds 6000- 1. Cirrus High-level clouds form above 6,000


= Cirrus 12000 2. Cirrostratus2 meters and since the temperatures
3. Cirrocumulus are so cold at such high elevations,
these clouds are primarily composed
of ice crystals. High-level clouds are
typically thin and white in
appearance, but can appear in a
magnificent array of colors when the
sun is low on the horizon.

Middle 2000- 4. Altostratus The bases of mid-level clouds


Clouds 6000 5. Altocumulus typically appear between 2,000 to
= Alto 6,000 meters. Because of their lower
altitudes, they are composed
primarily of water droplets, however,
they can also be composed of ice
crystals when temperatures are cold
enough.

Low Clouds below 6. Stratus Low clouds are of mostly composed


= Stratus 2000 7. Stratocumulus of water droplets since their bases
om

8. Nimbostratus generally lie below 2,000 meters.


l.c
ai

However, when temperatures are


tm

cold enough, these clouds may also


ho
t@

contain ice particles and snow.


sp
h.

Clouds with 9. Cumulus Probably the most familiar of the classified clouds is
es
ur

Vertical 10. Cumulonimbus the cumulus cloud. Generated most commonly


ay

Growth through either thermal convection or frontal lifting,


m

these clouds can grow to heights in excess of 12,000


meters, releasing incredible amounts of energy
through the condensation of water vapor within the
cloud itself.

Special Mammatus
Clouds Lenticular
Fog
Contrails

2
Sun’s Halo is produced by the ice crystals in cirrostratus clouds high (5–10 km) in the upper
troposphere.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


205 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

17. Precipitation
om

The process of continuous condensation in free air helps the condensed particles to grow in size. When
l.c
ai

the resistance of the air fails to hold them against the force of gravity, they fall on to the earth’s surface.
tm

So after the condensation of water vapour, the release of moisture is known as precipitation.
ho
t@

This may take place in liquid or solid form. The precipitation in the form of water is called rainfall,
sp

when the temperature is lower than the 00C, precipitation takes place in the form of fine flakes of snow
h.
es

and is called snowfall. Moisture is released in the form of hexagonal crystals. These crystals form
ur

flakes of snow. Usually the amount of snowfall is included in the rainfall figures. Besides rain and
ay
m

snow, other forms of precipitation are sleet and hail, though the latter are limited in occurrence and are
sporadic in both time and space.
Sleet: Snow is not frozen rain. The term sleet is used for the frozen raindrops and the re-frozen
melted snow water in the cold layer of the air near the Earth’s surface. Sleet also refers to a
mixture of snow and rain.
Hailstones: Sometimes, drops of rain after being released by the clouds become solidified into
small rounded solid pieces of ice and which reach the surface of the earth are called hailstones.
Hailstone mostly in the cumulo-nimbus clouds. Small droplets of water are formed in the lower
part of the clouds due to condensation. Many of these small droplets join together to form
large ones. The strong rising convection current carries these raindrops to the higher levels,
which causes freezing and gives rise to small ice pellets. The strength of the vertical current is
highly variable. Thus the ice pellets are not taken up continuously. They fall for some distance,
slightly melt at the lower levels and are carried up again. This happens several times until the
weight of the ice pellets becomes so heavy that they cannot be carried up by the current.
Ultimately these ice pellets fall as hailstones on the Earth. Hailstones have several concentric

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


206 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

layers of ice one over the other. The size of the halistones depends upon the amount of ice it
collects during its ascent and descent in the atmosphere by the convection current.
Hailstones occur widely in the world, except in the polar regions, the hot deserts and the
equatorial region. The occurrence of hailstones is common during the spring and the early
summer in the sub tropical and the temperate regions.

18. Necessary Conditions for RAINFALL


(a) there should be sufficient amount of evaporation from the water bodies (airmass must be
saturated with water vapour)
(b) there should be wind to carry the water vapour from one place to another, and
(c) there should be some way of decreasing the temperature of the moist air.
The rainfall does not occur unless these cloud droplets become so large that the air is not able
to hold them in suspension. Rainfall occurs only when the cloud droplets change to raindrops.
The diameter of a raindrop is about 5 mm and one raindrop contains about 8 million cloud
droplets.

19. Types of Rainfall


According to the way, the cooling of the warm moist airmass takes place, the rainfall can be of
the following three types: -

19.1. Convectional Rainfall


As it rises, it expands and loses heat and consequently, condensation takes place and cumulous
clouds are formed. With thunder and lightening, heavy rainfall takes place but this does not last
long. Such rain is common in the summer or in the hotter part of the day. It is very common in
the equatorial regions and interior parts of the continents, particularly in the northern
hemisphere.
om

In the equatorial regions convectional rainfall is received almost daily in the afternoons. In
l.c
ai

these regions ground starts heating up early morning and by afternoon convectional currents
tm

start rising. The whole sky soon is overcast with clouds. Late in the afternoon thunderstorms
ho
t@

and lightning occur. It generally happens regularly at 4 P.M. throughout the year. For this reason
sp

it is also called 4’O clock rainfall.


h.
es
ur
ay
m

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


207 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

19.2. Orographic Rain


It is also known as the relief rain. When the saturated air mass comes across a mountain, it is
forced to ascend and as it rises, it expands; the temperature falls, and the moisture is
condensed. The chief characteristic of this sort of rain is that the windward slopes receive
greater rainfall. After giving rain on the windward side, when these winds reach the other slope,
they descend, and their temperature rises. Then their capacity to take in moisture increases
and hence, these leeward slopes remain rainless and dry. The area situated on the leeward side,
which gets less rainfall is known as the rain-shadow area. For example, Mahabaleshwar lying
on the windwardside of Western Ghats receives annual rainfall of about 622 cm as against
Pune on the leeward side only 70 km away from Mahabaleshwar receives only 66 cm annual
rainfall.
The windward slope of a mountain, at the time of rainfall, has cumulus clouds while the
leeward slope has stratus clouds. The orographic rainfall may occur in any season. It is longer
duration. The orographic rainfall is supported by convectional and cyclonic processes of
condensation. Most of the precipitation in the world is orographic in nature.
In India, Cherrapunji in Meghalaya plateau, the Western Ghats and the entire Himalayan region
receive Orographic Rainfall.

om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@

19.3. Cyclonic or Frontal Rainfall


sp
h.

Cyclones have low pressure at the centre, surrounded by high pressure. When wind from all
es
ur

directions blow towards centre, air masses of different characteristics meet creating fronts. The
ay
m

warm air being the lighter, rises above the cold air. The rising warm air cools and condensation
takes place, causing rainfall.
This type of rainfall is associated with temperate and tropical cyclones. Since the lifting of warm
air along the warm front of the temperate cyclone is slow and gradual, the condensation is also
slow and gradual. Thus the precipitation occurs in the form of drizzle3, It is widespread and
continues for a longer duration. Most of the rainfall in the temperate region is received through
frontal or cyclonic rains.
The tropical cyclone, regionally known as typhoons, hurricanes, tornadoes, etc., yield heavy
downpour in China, Japan, Southeast Asia, India, USA, etc.

3
When the drops of rain are very small, it is called drizzle.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


208 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

20. Distribution of Precipitation


The mean annual rainfall on Earth is about 100 cm but different places on the earth’s surface
receive different amounts of rainfall in a year and that too in different seasons. Factors
controlling the distribution of rainfall over the earth's surface are the belts of converging-
ascending air flow (doldrums; polar front etc.), air temperature, moisture-bearing winds, ocean
currents, distance inland from the coast, and mountain ranges. In general, as we proceed from
the equator towards the poles, rainfall goes on decreasing steadily. The coastal areas of the
world receive greater amounts of rainfall than the interior of the continents. The rainfall is more
over the oceans than on the landmasses of the world because of being great sources of water.
Between the latitudes 350 and 400 N and S of the equator, the rain is heavier on the eastern
coasts and goes on decreasing towards the west. But, between 450 and 650 N and S of
equator, due to the westerlies, the rainfall is first received on the western margins of the
continents and it goes on decreasing towards the east. Wherever mountains run parallel to the
coast, the rain is greater on the coastal plain, on the windward side and it decreases towards
the leeward side.
om

On the basis of the total amount of annual precipitation, major precipitation regimes of the
l.c

world are identified as follows.


ai
tm

Areas of Heavy Rainfall: The regions receiving more than 200 cm of annual precipitation are
ho
t@

included in this belt. The main areas are the equatorial belt, the mountain slopes along the
sp

western coasts in the cool temperate zone and the coastal areas of the monsoon lands.
h.
es
ur

Areas of Moderate Rainfall: The regions receiving 100 cm to 200 cm of annual precipitation are
ay

included in this belt. The main areas lie adjacent to the regions of heavy rainfall. The coastal
m

areas in the warm temperate zone also receive moderate precipitation.


Areas of Low Rainfall: The regions receiving 50 cm to 100 cm of annual precipitation are
included in this belt. The main areas lie in the central part of the tropical lands and in the
eastern and the interior parts of the temperate lands.
Areas of Scanty Rainfall: The regions receiving less than 50 cm of annual precipitation are
included in this belt. The main areas are the rain shadow areas on the leeward slopes of the
mountain ranges, the interior of the continents, the lands in the high latitudes, western margins
of the continents in the tropical areas and the arid deserts.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


209 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

20.1. Seasonal Distribution of Rainfall


The conditions, which can cause precipitation, do not exist in the same combination throughout
the year. This leads to the variations in the seasonal distribution of rainfall. However, most of
the areas in the world receive a major part of the precipitation during the summer season.
The main characteristics of the seasonal distribution of rainfall
• Heavy rainfall occurs throughout the year in the equatorial region.
• A few degrees north or south of the equator have wet summers and dry winters.

om

The monsoon circulation brings more seasonal contrasts resulting in wet summers, as the
l.c

wind blows onshore, and dry winters as the wind blows offshore.
ai


tm

Seasonal variation, due to the monsoons, is well-developed in the Indian Subcontinent and
ho

in Southeast Asia.
t@


sp

Most of the western coastal areas in the mid- latitudes have dry summers and wet winters
h.

due to the presence of the sub-tropical high pressure belts.


es
ur

• In the temperate region the precipitation is cyclonic in nature and the cyclones are more
ay

common in the winter season. Thus heavy rainfall occurs in winters and not in summers.
m

The monthly distribution of precipitation throughout the year is often more significant than the
average annual precipitation because rainfall is important for the various human activities,
especially agriculture. The dependence on rainfall is a matter of great concern to farmers in the
sub-humid and semi-arid lands where any departure from the normal regime may result in crop
failure.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


210 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

21. Prelims Questions


Clouds
1. Which one of the following statements is correct?
(a) Circus clouds are composed office crystals
(b) Cirrus clouds exhibit a flat base and have the appearance of rising domes
(c) Cumulus clouds are white and thin and form delicate patches and give a fibrous and
feathery appearance
(d) Cumulus clouds are classified as high clouds. (2004)
2. Sun’s halo is produced by the refraction of light in
(a) Water vapour in Stratus clouds
(b) Ice crystals in Cirro-Cumulus clouds
(c) Ice crystals in Cirrus clouds
(d) Dust particles in Stratus clouds (2004)
Precipitation: Distribution
3. "Assertion (A): Bangalore received much higher average rainfall than that of
Mangalore.
Reason (R): Bangalore has the benefit of receiving rainfall both from south – west and
north – east monsoons." (2004)
4. "Assertion (A): The eastern coast of India produces more rice than the western coast.
Reason (R): The eastern coast receives more rainfall than the western coast." (2003)
om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

Copyright © by Vision IAS


All rights are reserved. No part of this document may be reproduced, stored in a retrieval system or
transmitted in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording or
otherwise, without prior permission of Vision IAS.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


211 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

OCEAN BASICS AND OCEAN RESOURCES


Contents
1. Ocean Basics........................................................................................................................... 214

1.1. Relief of the Ocean Floor ................................................................................................ 214

1.1.1. Continental Shelf ...................................................................................................... 214

1.1.2. Continental Slope ..................................................................................................... 214

1.1.3. Continental Rise ....................................................................................................... 214

1.1.4. Deep Sea Plain.......................................................................................................... 215

1.1.5. Oceanic deeps or Trenches ...................................................................................... 215

1.2. Minor Relief Features of the Ocean Floor ....................................................................... 215

1.3. The Oceanic Deposits of the Ocean Floor ....................................................................... 216

1.4. Temperature .................................................................................................................... 216

1.4.1. Factors Affecting Temperature Distribution ............................................................. 216

1.4.2. Vertical Distribution of Temperature ....................................................................... 217


om

1.4.3. Horizontal Distribution of Temperature ................................................................... 218


l.c
ai
tm

1.5. Salinity ............................................................................................................................. 219


ho
t@

1.5.1. Factors Affecting Ocean Salinity ............................................................................... 219


sp
h.
es

1.5.2. Vertical Distribution of Salinity ................................................................................ 219


ur
ay
m

1.5.3. Horizontal Distribution of Salinity ............................................................................ 219

2. Movements of Ocean Water .................................................................................................. 220

2.1. Waves .............................................................................................................................. 220

2.1.1. Characteristics of Waves .......................................................................................... 220

2.1.2. Wave Motion ............................................................................................................ 221

2.2. Tides ................................................................................................................................ 221

2.2.1. Causes of Tides ......................................................................................................... 221

2.2.2. Types of Tides ........................................................................................................... 222

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


212 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

2.2.3. Tides Based on Rrequency ....................................................................................... 222

2.2.4. Tides Based on Height .............................................................................................. 222

2.2.5. Characteristics of Tides ............................................................................................ 223

2.2.6. Importance of Tides ................................................................................................. 223

2.3. Ocean Currents ............................................................................................................... 224

2.3.1. Causes of Ocean Currents ........................................................................................ 224

2.3.2. Types of Ocean Currents .......................................................................................... 224

2.3.3. Currents Based on Depth ......................................................................................... 224

2.3.4. Currents Based on Temperature .............................................................................. 224

2.3.5. Characteristics of Ocean Currents ............................................................................ 225

2.3.6. Currents of the Atlantic Ocean ................................................................................. 225

2.3.7. Currents of the Pacific Ocean ................................................................................... 227

2.3.8. Currents of the Indian Ocean ................................................................................... 229

2.3.9. Effects of Ocean Currents ......................................................................................... 230

3. Ocean Resources .................................................................................................................... 230


om
l.c

3.1. Fishing ............................................................................................................................. 230


ai
tm
ho

3.1.1. Major Fishing Grounds ............................................................................................. 230


t@
sp

3.2. Climate Buffer ................................................................................................................. 231


h.
es
ur

3.3. Phytoplankton ................................................................................................................. 231


ay
m

3.4. Mining ............................................................................................................................. 231

3.4.1. Deep Sea Mining ...................................................................................................... 231

3.4.2. Major Deep Sea Minerals ......................................................................................... 232

3.4.3. Constraints in Deep Sea mining ............................................................................... 233

4. UPSC Questions Related to Above Topics .............................................................................. 234

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


213 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

1. Ocean Basics
Water is an essential component of all life forms. The earth fortunately has an abundant supply
of water on its surface. Hence, our planet is called the Blue Planet. About 97 per cent of the
planetary water is found in the oceans. Oceans account for more than 70 per cent or 140
million square miles of the earth's surface.
Oceanography, the science of the oceans, has become such an important subject in recent
years and many researches into the deep seas have been conducted. The oceans, unlike the
continents, merge so naturally into one another that it is hard to demarcate them. The
geographers have divided the oceanic part of the earth into four oceans, namely the Pacific,
the Atlantic, the Indian and the Arctic.

1.1. Relief of the Ocean Floor


Ocean Floor refers to the land under the waters of the oceans. The ocean floor exhibits
complex and varied features similar to those observed over the land. The floors of the oceans
are rugged with the world’s largest mountain ranges, deepest trenches and the largest plains.
These features are formed, like those of the continents, by the factors of tectonic, volcanic and
depositional processes.
The ocean floors can be divided into following four major divisions:
1.1.1. Continental Shelf
The continental shelf is the extended margin of each continent occupied by relatively shallow
seas. It is the shallowest part of the ocean showing an average gradient of1° or even less. The
shelf typically ends at a very steep slope, called the shelf break.
The widths of the continental shelves vary from one ocean to another. The average width of
continental shelves is about 80 km. The shelves are almost absent or very narrow along some of
the margins like the coasts of Chile, the west coast of Sumatra, etc. On the contrary, the
om

Siberian shelf in the Arctic Ocean, the largest in the world, stretches to 1,500 km in width. The
l.c
ai

depth of the shelves also varies. It may be as shallow as 30 m in some areas while in some areas
tm
ho

it is as deep as 600 m.
t@

The continental shelves are covered with variable thicknesses of sediments brought down by
sp
h.

rivers, glaciers, wind, from the land and distributed by waves and currents. Massive
es
ur

sedimentary deposits received over a long time by the continental shelves, become the source
ay

of fossil fuels.
m

1.1.2. Continental Slope


The continental slope connects the continental shelf and the ocean basins (bottom of the
ocean). It begins where the bottom of the continental shelf sharply drops off into a steep slope.
The gradient of the slope region varies between 2-5°. The depth of the slope region varies
between 200 and 3,000m. The slope boundary indicates the end of the continents. Canyons
and trenches (discussed later in minor relief features of ocean floor) are observed in this region.
1.1.3. Continental Rise
Where the continental slope ends, the gently sloping continental rise begins. Its general relief is
low and with increasing depth, the continental rise becomes virtually flat to merge with the
deep sea plains.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


214 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

1.1.4. Deep Sea Plain


Deep sea plains are gently sloping areas of the ocean basins. These are the flattest and
smoothest regions of the world. The depths vary between 3,000 and 6,000m. These plains are
covered with fine-grained sediments like clay and silt.
Deep sea plains cover two-thirds of the ocean floor and are also known as abyssal plains. They
also contain features like ridges, guyots and oceanic islands that sometimes rise above the sea
level in the midst of oceans.
1.1.5. Oceanic deeps or Trenches
These areas are the deepest parts of the oceans. The trenches are relatively steep sided,
narrow basins. They are some 3-5 km deeper than the surrounding ocean floor. They occur at
the bases of continental slopes and along island arcs and are associated with active volcanoes
and strong earthquakes. That is why they are very significant in the study of plate movements.
As many as 57 deeps have been explored so far; of which 32 are in the Pacific Ocean; 19 in the
Atlantic Ocean and 6 in the Indian Ocean. The greatest known ocean deep is the Mariana
Trench near Guam Island, which is more than 36,000 feet deep.
Figure 1. Major relief features of the ocean floor.

om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp

1.2. Minor Relief Features of the Ocean Floor


h.
es
ur

Apart from the above mentioned major relief features of the ocean floor, following minor but
ay

significant features predominate in different parts of the oceans:


m

1. Mid-oceanic ridges: A mid-oceanic ridge is composed of chains of mountains separated by


a large depression. Oceanic ridge is also known as an oceanic spreading center, which is
responsible for seafloor spreading. The uplifted sea floor results from convection currents
which rise in the mantle as magma at a linear weakness in the oceanic crust, and emerge
as lava, creating new crust upon cooling. A mid-ocean ridge demarcates the boundary
between two tectonic plates, and consequently is termed a divergent plate boundary.
The mountain ranges can have peaks as high as 2,500 m and some even reach above the
ocean’s surface. Iceland, a part of the mid-Atlantic Ridge, is an example.
2. Seamount: It is a mountain with pointed summits, rising from the seafloor that does not
reach the surface of the ocean. Seamounts are volcanic in origin. These can be 3,000-4,500
m tall. The Emperor seamount, an extension of the Hawaiian Islands in the Pacific Ocean, is
a good example.
3. Submarine canyons: These are deep valleys, found cutting across the continental shelves
and slopes, extending from the mouths of large rivers. The Hudson Canyon is the best
known submarine canyon in the world.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


215 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Figure 2. Minor Relief features of the ocean floor.

4. Guyots: It is a flat topped seamount. They show evidences of gradual subsidence through
stages to become flat topped submerged mountains. It is estimated that more than 10,000
seamounts and guyots exist in the Pacific Ocean alone.
5. Atoll: These are low islands found in the tropical oceans consisting of coral reefs
surrounding a central depression. It may be a part of the sea (lagoon), or sometimes form
enclosing a body of fresh, brackish or highly saline water.

1.3. The Oceanic Deposits of the Ocean Floor


Materials eroded from the earth which are not deposited by rivers or at the coast are
eventually dropped on the ocean floor. The dominant process is slow sedimentation where the
eroded particles very slowly filter through the ocean water and settle upon one another in
layers. All oceanic deposits can be classified as follows:
1. Muds: These are terrigenous deposits because they are derived from land and are mainly
deposited on the continental shelves. The muds are referred to as blue, green or red muds;
their colouring depends upon their chemical content.
om
l.c

2. Oozes: These are pelagic deposits because they are derived from the oceans. They are
ai

made of the shelly and skeletal remains of marine microorganisms with calcareous or
tm
ho

siliceous parts. Oozes have a very fine, flour-like texture and either occur as accumulated
t@

deposits or float about in suspension.


sp
h.

3. Clays: These occur mainly as red clays in the deeper parts of the ocean basins, and are
es

particularly abundant in the Pacific Ocean. Red clay is believed to be an accumulation of


ur
ay

volcanic dust blown out from volcanoes during volcanic eruptions.


m

1.4. Temperature
Like land masses, ocean water varies in temperature from place to place both at the surface
and at great depths. Ocean water gets heated by solar energy just as land. The process of
heating and cooling of the oceanic water is slower than land. This is due to higher specific heat
of water as compared to land as a result of which greater amount of energy is required to raise
the temperature of water as compared to land.
1.4.1. Factors Affecting Temperature Distribution
The factors which affect the distribution of temperature of ocean water are:
1. Latitude: The temperature of surface water decreases from the equator towards the poles
because the amount of insolation decreases poleward.
2. Unequal distribution of land and water: The oceans in the northern hemisphere receive
more heat due to their contact with larger extent of land than the oceans in the southern
hemisphere.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


216 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

3. Prevailing winds: The winds blowing from the land towards the oceans drive warm surface
water away from the coast resulting in the upwelling of cold water from below. It results
into the longitudinal variation in the temperature. Contrary to this, the onshore winds pile
up warm water near the coast and this raises the temperature.
4. Ocean currents: Warm ocean currents raise the temperature in cold areas while the cold
currents decrease the temperature in warm ocean areas.
All these factors influence the temperature of the ocean currents locally. The enclosed seas in
the low latitudes record relatively higher temperature than the open seas; whereas the
enclosed seas in the high latitudes have lower temperature than the open seas.
1.4.2. Vertical Distribution of Temperature
It is a well-known fact that the maximum temperature of the oceans is always at their surfaces
because they directly receive the heat from the sun and the heat is transmitted to the lower
sections of the oceans through the process of convection. It results into decrease of
temperature with the increasing depth, but the rate of decrease is not uniform throughout.
The temperature falls very rapidly up to the depth of 200 m and thereafter, the rate of decrease
of temperature is slowed down. The temperature profile of oceans shows a boundary region
between the surface waters of the ocean and the deeper layers. The boundary usually begins
around 100-400m below the sea surface and extends several hundred of metres downward.
This boundary region, from where there is a rapid decrease of temperature, is called the
thermocline. About 90 per cent of the total volume of water is found below the thermoclinein
the deep ocean. In this zone, temperatures approach 0°C.
Figure 3. Variation of temperature with depth in oceans
om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


217 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

The temperature structure of oceans over middle and low latitudes can be described asa
three-layer system from surface to the bottom:
• The first layer represents the top layer of warm oceanic water and it is about 500m thick
with temperatures ranging between 20° and25° C. This layer, within the tropical region, is
present throughout the year but in mid-latitudes it develops only during summer.
• The second layer called the thermocline layer lies below the first layer and is characterized
by rapid decrease in temperature with increasing depth. The thermocline is 500 -1,000 m
thick.
• The third layer is very cold and extends up to the deep ocean floor. Here the temperatures
are close to 0° C.
In the Arctic and Antarctic circles, surface water temperatures are close to 0° C and so the
temperature change with the depth is very slight. Here, only one layer of cold water exists,
which extends from surface to deep ocean floor.
1.4.3. Horizontal Distribution of Temperature
The average temperature of surface water of the oceans is about 27°C and it gradually
decreases from the equator towards the poles. The rate of decrease of temperature with
increasing latitude is generally 0.5°C per latitude. The average temperature is around22°C at 20°
latitudes, 14° C at 40° latitudes and 0° C near poles.
The oceans in the northern hemisphere record relatively higher temperature than in the
southern hemisphere. The highest temperature is not recorded at the equator but slightly
towards north of it. The average annual temperatures for the northern and southern
hemisphere are around 19° C and 16°C respectively. This variation is due to the unequal
distribution of land and water in the northern and southern hemispheres.
om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

Figure 4. Horizontal Distribution of temperature of oceans around the world

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


218 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

1.5. Salinity
Salinity is used to define the total content of dissolved salts in sea water. It is calculated as the
amount of salt (in gm) dissolved in 1,000 gm (1 kg) of seawater. It is usually expressed as parts
per thousand or ppt. Salinity is an important property of sea water. Salinity of 24.7 ppt has been
considered as the upper limit to demarcate brackish water(saltier than fresh water, but not as
salty as seawater).
1.5.1. Factors Affecting Ocean Salinity
Major factors are as mentioned below:
• The salinity of water in the surface layer of oceans depends mainly on evaporation and
precipitation.
• Surface salinity is greatly influenced in coastal regions by the fresh water flow from rivers,
and in polar-regions by the processes of freezing and thawing of ice.
• Wind also influences salinity of an area by transferring water to other areas.
• The ocean currents contribute to the salinity variations.
Salinity, temperature and density of water are interrelated. Hence, any change in the
temperature or density influences the salinity of water in an area.
1.5.2. Vertical Distribution of Salinity
Salinity changes with depth but the way it changes depends upon the location of the sea.
Salinity at the surface increases by loss of water to ice or evaporation, or decreases by the input
of fresh water, such as from the rivers. Salinity at depth is very much fixed, because there is no
way that water is lost, or the salt is added.
There is a marked difference in the salinity between the surface zones and the deep zones of
the oceans. The lower salinity water rests above the higher salinity dense water. Salinity,
generally, increases with depth and there is a distinct zone called the halocline, where salinity
om

increases sharply. Other factors being constant, increasing salinity of seawater causes its
l.c
ai

density to increase. High salinity seawater, generally, sinks below the lower salinity water. This
tm

leads to stratification by salinity.


ho
t@

1.5.3. Horizontal Distribution of Salinity


sp
h.
es

The salinity for normal open ocean ranges between 33 ppt and 37 ppt. In the land locked Red
ur

sea, it is as high as 41 ppt, while in the estuaries and the Arctic, the salinity fluctuates from 0 –
ay
m

35 ppt, seasonally. In hot and dry regions, where evaporation is high, the salinity sometimes
reaches to 70 ppt.
The salinity variation in the Pacific Ocean is mainly due to its shape and larger areal extent.
Salinity decreases from 35 ppt - 31 ppt on the western parts of the northern hemisphere
because of the influx of melted water from the Arctic region. In the same way, after 15° - 20°
south, it decreases to 33 ppt
The average salinity of the Atlantic Ocean is around 36 ppt. The highest salinity is recorded
between 15° and 20° latitudes. Maximum salinity (37 ppt) is observed between20° N and 30° N
and 20° W - 60° W. It gradually decreases towards the north. The North Sea, in spite of its
location in higher latitudes, records higher salinity due to more saline water brought by the
North Atlantic Drift. Baltic Sea records low salinity due to influx of river waters in large quantity.
The Mediterranean Sea records higher salinity due to high evaporation. Salinity is, however,
very low in Black Sea due to enormous fresh water influx by rivers.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


219 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

The average salinity of the Indian Ocean is 35 ppt. The low salinity trend is observed in the Bay
of Bengal due to large influx of river water. On the contrary, the Arabian Sea shows higher
salinity due to high evaporation and low influx of fresh water.

Figure 5. Surface salinity of World Oceans.

2. Movements of Ocean Water


Ocean water is dynamic. The horizontal motion refers to the ocean currents and waves. The
vertical motion refers to tides. The upwelling of cold water from subsurface and the sinking of
surface water are also forms of vertical motion of ocean water.
om

2.1. Waves
l.c
ai
tm

Waves are actually the energy, not the water as such, which moves across the ocean surface.
ho
t@

Water particles only travel in a small circle as a wave passes. Wind provides energy to the
sp

waves. Wind causes waves to travel in the ocean and the energy is released on shorelines.
h.
es

The motion of the surface water seldom affects the stagnant deep bottom water of the oceans.
ur
ay

As a wave approaches the beach, it slows down. This is due to the friction occurring between
m

the dynamic water and the sea floor and when the depth of water is less than half the
wavelength of the wave, the wave breaks. The largest waves are found in the open oceans.
Waves continue to grow larger as they move and absorb energy from the wind.
A wave’s size and shape reveal its origin. Steep waves are fairly young ones and are probably
formed by local wind. Slow and steady waves originate from faraway places, possibly from
another hemisphere. The maximum wave height is determined by the strength of the wind, i.e.
how long it blows and the area over which it blows in a single direction.
2.1.1. Characteristics of Waves
Important terms associated with waves are:
• Wave crest and trough: The highest and lowest points of a wave are called the crest and
trough respectively.
• Wave height: It is the vertical distance from the bottom of a trough to the top of a crest of a
wave.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


220 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

• Wave amplitude: It is one-half of the wave height.


• Wave period: It is the time interval between two successive wave crests or troughs as they
pass a fixed point.
• Wavelength: It is the horizontal distance between two successive crests.
• Wave speed: It is the rate at which the wave moves through the water, and is measured in
knots.
• Wave frequency: It is the number of waves passing a given point during a one second time
interval.
2.1.2. Wave Motion
Waves travel because wind pushes the water body in its course while gravity pulls the crests of
the waves downward. The falling water pushes the former troughs upward, and the wave
moves to a new position. The actual motion of the water beneath the waves is circular. It
indicates that things are carried up and forward as the wave approaches, and down and back as
it passes.

Figure 6. Motion of waves and water molecules


om

2.2. Tides
l.c
ai
tm

The periodical rise and fall of the sea level, once or twice a day, mainly due to the attraction of
ho

sun and the moon, is called a tide. Movement of water caused by meteorological effects (winds
t@

and atmospheric pressure changes) are called surges. Surges are not regular like tides. The
sp
h.

study of tides is very complex, spatially and temporally, as it has great variations in frequency,
es

magnitude and height.


ur
ay
m

2.2.1. Causes of Tides


The moon’s gravitational pull to a great extent and to a lesser extent the sun’s gravitational
pull, are the major causes for the occurrence of tides. Another factor is centrifugal force, which
is the force that acts to counterbalance the gravity. Together, the gravitational pull and the
centrifugal force are responsible for creating the two major tidal bulges on the earth.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


221 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Figure 7. Relation between gravitational forces and centrifugal forces


The ‘tide-generating’ force is the difference between the gravitational attraction of the moon
and the centrifugal force. On the surface of the earth, nearest the moon, pull or the attractive
force of the moon is greater than the centrifugal force, and so there is a net force causing a
bulge towards the moon.
On the opposite side of the earth, the attractive force is less, as it is farther away from the
om

moon, the centrifugal force is dominant. Hence, there is a net force away from the moon. It
l.c

creates the second bulge away from the moon.


ai
tm

2.2.2. Types of Tides


ho
t@
sp

Tides vary in their frequency, direction and movement from place to place and also from time
h.

to time. Tides may be grouped into various types based on their frequency of occurrence in one
es
ur

day or based on their height.


ay
m

2.2.3. Tides Based on Rrequency


1. Semi-diurnal tide: The most common tidal pattern, featuring two high tides and two low
tides each day. The successive high or low tides are approximately of the same height.
2. Diurnal tide: There is only one high tide and one low tide during each day. The successive
high or low tides are approximately of the same height.
3. Mixed tide: Tides having variations in height are known as mixed tides. These tides
generally occur along the west coast of North America and on many islands of the Pacific
Ocean.
2.2.4. Tides Based on Height
The height of rising water (high tide) varies appreciably depending upon the position of sun and
moon with respect to the earth:
1. Spring tides: On full moon and new moon days, the Sun, the Moon and the Earth are almost
in the same line. On these days, the Sun and the Moon exert their combined gravitational
force on the Earth. Thus on these two days the high tides are the highest and are known as

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


222 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

spring tides. The height of a spring tide is about 20 per cent more than the normal high
tide. They occur twice every month.
2. Neap tides: On half Moon days (i.e. first and last quarter phases of the Moon), the Sun and
the Moon are at right angles to the centre of the Earth. The tide producing forces of the
Moon and the Sun, work in opposite directions and they partly cancel each other's force. In
such cases, the high tide is lower than the normal and low tide is higher than the normal.
The difference is about 20 per cent. This is known as the neap tide.
2.2.5. Characteristics of Tides
• Tidal range: The difference between the high tide water and the low tide water is called the
tidal range. The time between the high tide and low tide, when the water level is falling, is
called the ebb. The time between the low tide and high tide, when the tide is rising, is
called the flow or flood.
Once in a month, when the moon’s orbit is closest to the earth (perigee), unusually high
and low tides occur. During this time the tidal range is greater than normal. Two weeks
later, when the moon is farthest from earth (apogee),the moon’s gravitation force is limited
and the tidal ranges are less than their average heights.
When the earth is closest to the sun (perihelion), around 3rd January each year, tidal ranges
are also much greater, with unusually high and unusually low tides. When the earth is
farthest from the sun (aphelion), around 4th July each year, tidal ranges are much less than
average.
• Tidal current: Tidal currents (a horizontal motion) are a result of the rise and fall of the
water level due to tides (a vertical motion). The effects of tidal currents on the movement
of water in and out of bays and harbours can be substantial.
The tidal bulges on wide continental shelves, have greater height. When tidal bulge shit the
mid-oceanic islands they become low. The shape of bays and estuaries along a coastline can
also magnify the intensity of tides. Funnel-shaped bays greatly change tidal magnitudes.
om
l.c

The highest tides in the world occur in the Bay of Fundy in Nova Scotia, Canada. The tidal
ai

bulge is 15 - 16 m.
tm
ho

• Tidal bore: When the tide enters the narrow and shallow estuary of a river, the front of the
t@

tidal wave appears to be vertical due to the piling up of the river water against the tidal
sp
h.

wave and the friction of the river bed. It looks as if a vertical wall of water is moving
es

upstream. This is called a tidal bore. In India tidal bores are common in the Hugli River.
ur
ay

2.2.6. Importance of Tides


m

Since tides are caused by the earth-moon-sun positions which are known accurately, the tides
can be predicted well in advance. This helps the navigators and fishermen plan their activities.
Some of the important activities associated with tides are:
1. Tidal flows are of great importance in navigation. Tidal heights are very important,
especially harbours near rivers and within estuaries having shallow ‘bars’ at the entrance,
which prevent ships and boats from entering into the harbour. Large ships enter the
harbour of a shallow sea during high tide and they go back also at the time of high tide.
London and I have become important ports due to the tidal nature of the mouths of the
Thames and Hugli rivers respectively.
2. The river mouths and estuaries are kept clean of sedimentation due to the action of tidal
currents. The force of the outgoing tide and the river current carries the silt away to the
open sea. This helps in navigation.
3. The tidal force can also be used as a source for generating electricity. A 3 MW tidal power
project at Durgaduani in Sunderbans of West Bengal is under way.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


223 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

4. The inflow of the salty tidal water, especially along the coast of cold countries, retards the
process of freezing and prevents the harbours from becoming ice-bound.
5. The fishing industry is helped by the rhythm of high and low tides. The fishermen mostly
sail out to the open sea during low tides and return to the coast at high tides.

2.3. Ocean Currents


Ocean currents are like river flow in oceans. They represent a regular volume of water in a
definite path and direction.
2.3.1. Causes of Ocean Currents
Ocean currents are influenced by two types of forces namely:
• Primary forces that initiate the movement of water.
• Secondary forces that influence the currents to flow.
The forces that influence the currents are:
1. Heating by solar energy causes water to expand. That is why, near the equator the ocean
water is about 8 cm higher in level than in the middle latitudes. This causes a very slight
gradient and water tends to flow down the slope.
There is much difference in the temperature of ocean waters at the equator and at the
poles. As warm water is lighter and rises, and cold water is denser and sinks, warm
equatorial waters move slowly along the surface polewards, while the heavier cold waters
of the polar regions creep slowly along the bottom of the sea equatorwards.
2. Wind blowing on the surface of the ocean pushes the water to move. Friction between the
wind and the water surface affects the movement of the water body in its course. Most of
the ocean currents of the world follow the direction of the prevailing winds.
3. Coriolis force causes the water to move to the right in the northern hemisphere and to the
left in the southern hemisphere. These large accumulations of water and the flow around
them are called Gyres. These produce large circular currents in all the ocean basins.
om
l.c

4. Salinity of ocean water varies from place to place. Waters of high salinity are denser than
ai

waters of low salinity. Hence on the surface, waters of low salinity flow towards waters of
tm
ho

high salinity while at the bottom, waters of high salinity flow towards waters of low salinity.
t@

5. The configuration of the coastline serves as an obstruction for the natural flow of ocean
sp
h.

currents and succeeds in changing its direction. This is quite conspicuous in the equatorial
es

region where the landmasses deflect the current towards the north and the south.
ur
ay

2.3.2. Types of Ocean Currents


m

The ocean currents may be classified based on their depth or temperature.


2.3.3. Currents Based on Depth
1. Surface currents constitute about10 per cent of all the water in the ocean, these waters are
the upper 400 m of the ocean.
2. Deep water currents make up the other 90 per cent of the ocean water. Deep waters sink
into the deep ocean basins at high latitudes, where the temperatures are cold enough to
cause the density to increase.
2.3.4. Currents Based on Temperature
1. Cold currents bring coldwater into warm water areas. These currents are usually found on
the west coast of the continents in the low and middle latitudes (true in both hemispheres)
and on the east coast in the higher latitudes in the Northern Hemisphere.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


224 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

2. Warm currents bring warm water into cold water areas and are usually observed on the
east coast of continents in the low and middle latitudes (true in both hemispheres). In the
northern hemisphere they are found on the west coasts of continents in high latitudes.
2.3.5. Characteristics of Ocean Currents
The currents are strongest near the surface and may attain speeds over five knots. At depths,
currents are generally slow with speeds less than 0.5knots. The speed of a current is known as
its drift. Drift is measured in terms of knots. The strength of a current refers to the speed of the
current. A fast current is considered strong. A current is usually strongest at the surface and
decreases in strength (speed) with depth. Most currents have speeds less than or equal to 5
knots.
2.3.6. Currents of the Atlantic Ocean
Major currents of the Atlantic Ocean are:
North and South Equatorial Current
• To the north and south of the equator, there are two westward moving currents-the North
Equatorial Current and the South Equatorial Current.
• Due to the rotation of the Earth (Coriolis Effect), these currents move almost due west
along the equator.
• The North Equatorial Current moves northwards due to the presence of the South
American continent and the Coriolis force, and takes the north-west direction. It enters the
Gulf of Mexico to form the Gulf Stream.
• The South Equatorial Current originates from the western coast of Africa, from where it
moves towards South America.
• The east coast of Brazil obstructs the South Equatorial Current which then bifurcates into
two branches.
• The northward branch merges with the North
om

• Equatorial Current, while the second branch flows along the east coast of Brazil and is
l.c
ai

known as the Brazilian Current.


tm

• The North Equatorial Current and the South Equatorial Current are warm currents.
ho
t@

Gulf Stream
sp
h.


es

The Gulf Stream is one of the largest warm currents. It originates from the Gulf of Mexico
ur

(about 20° N) and moves in a north-easterly direction along the eastern coast of North
ay
m

America.
• The average speed is about 33 km per day and its average width is about 70 km.
• Under the impact of the Westerlies, this warm current reaches the western coast of Europe
(about 70° N latitude).
• The general direction of flow of the Gulf Stream, north of 30° N latitude, is northward.
• Near Newfoundland, its water mixes with the cold water of the Labrador Current, which
forms very dense fog. The foggy conditions around Newfoundland hamper the navigation of
ships.
• From here, the Gulf Stream moves northeastwards.
• This current gradually widens and its speed decreases. It becomes a prominent, slow-
moving current known as the North Atlantic Drift.
• Near Western Europe, it splits into two parts. One part moves northwards, past UK and
Norway, while the other part is deflected southwards as the cold Canary Current.
• The warm water of the Gulf Stream modifies the weather conditions off the eastern coast
of North America and the western coast of Europe.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


225 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

• On the western coast of Europe, the seaports remain open even in the severe winter
season due to the warm water of the Gulf Stream.
Labrador Current
• The cold Labrador Current of the North Atlantic Ocean, has its origin in the Arctic Ocean.
• This current flows from north to south between Greenland and the Baffin islands.
• The Labrador Current merges with the Gulf Stream near Newfoundland.
• This helps in the growth of plankton- a feed for fish. Thus the Grand Banks near
Newfoundland have become the ideal fishing ground in the world.
• The average speed of the Labrador Current is about 25 km per day.
• This current brings huge icebergs with it from the Arctic Ocean.
Canary Current
• The Canary Current is a cold current and flows along the western coast of Spain and
Portugal and the north-west coast of North Africa. .
• The average speed of this current is about 45 km per day.
• The relative coolness of the Canary Current reduces the relative humidity and thus causes
scanty rainfall in the greater parts of the Sahara Desert.
Brazil Current
• The Brazil Current is a warm current and flows southward along the east coast of South
America (about 40° S latitude).
• The average speed of the Brazil Current is about 30 km per day.
• From 40° S, it is deflected eastwards due to the Earth's rotation and flows in easterly
direction.
• It modifies the weather conditions along the eastern coasts of Brazil and Argentina.
Falkland Current
om

• The cold waters of the Antarctic Sea flow as Falkland Current from south to north along the
l.c
ai

eastern coast of South America up to Argentina.


tm


ho

The Falkland Current brings huge icebergs from the Antarctic region to the South American
t@

coast.
sp
h.

Benguela Current
es
ur


ay

The Benguela Current is a cold current which originates in the Antarctic region and flows
m

along the coast of south-west Africa.


• The Benguela Current helps in reducing the relative humidity of the eastward moving warm
and moist air masses.
• The Kalahari Desert is largely formed under the influence of this current.
• Further northwards, the Benguela Current merges with the South Equatorial Current.
South Atlantic Drift
• The eastward continuation of the Brazil Current is called the South Atlantic Drift or the West
Wind Drift.
• It develops at about 40° S latitude due to the impact of the Westerlies.
• The eastward movement is due to the Earth's rotation.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


226 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

2.3.7. Currents of the Pacific Ocean


Major currents of the Pacific Ocean are:
North Equatorial Current
• The North Equatorial Current is a warm current which originates off the western coast of
Mexico and flows in the westerly direction.
• It runs parallel to the equator and reaches the islands of Philippines after covering a
distance of about 12,000 km.
• Near Philippines, under the impact of Coriolis force, it turns northwards.
• One branch of the North Equatorial Current flows northward to join the Kuroshio Current,
while the southern branch turns eastwards to form the Counter Equatorial Current.
South Equatorial Current
• The South Equatorial Current is a warm current which originates due to the influence of
South-east Trade winds and flows from east to west.
• It bifurcates into northern and southern branches near New Guinea.
• The northern branch turns eastward and joins the Counter Equatorial Current, while the
southern branch flows along the north-eastern coast of Australia.
Kuroshio Current
• Kuroshio Current is an important warm current, which develops partly due to the Coriolis
force and partly due to the obstruction by the Philippines in the flow of the North
Equatorial Current.
• The average velocity is about 30 km per day and the average surface temperature is about
20°C.
• This current keeps the eastern coast of Japan warm even in the coldest month (January),
when it is snowing heavily in Honshu and Hokkaido.

om

A branch of Kuroshio Current enters the Sea of Japan as Tsushima Current and keeps the
l.c

western coast of Japan comparatively warm.


ai


tm

Around 35° N, the Kuroshio current comes under the impact of the Westerlies and flows in
ho

the north-east direction to reach the western coast of North America.


t@


sp

Further northwards, it is known as the Aleutian Current.


h.
es

Kurile or Oyashio Current


ur
ay

• The Kurile or Oyashio Current is a cold current which originates from the Bering Strait and
m

moves southwards along the coast of the Kamchatka peninsula to touch the island of Kurile.
• It carries with it the cold water and icebergs from the Arctic Ocean to the coast of eastern
Russia and Japan.
• Near 50° N latitude, it is bifurcated into two branches. One of them merges with Kuroshio
Current and creates dense fog which is hazardous to navigation, but ideal for abundant
growth of plankton.
• Thus the north-eastern coast of the Japanese islands is an important fishing ground in the
world.
• The second branch moves up to the Japanese coast.
• The Oyashio Current is comparable to the Labrador Current of the North Atlantic Ocean.
California Current
• The California Currents is a cold current which flows southwards along the Pacific coastline
of USA, and is comparable to the Canary Current of the Atlantic Ocean in most of its
characteristics.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


227 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

• After reaching the Mexican coast, it turns westward and merges with the North Equatorial
Current.
• Dense sea fogs are experienced off the coast of San Francisco.
Peru Current
• The Peru Current is a cold current, also known as the Humboldt Current, which flows along
the western coast of South America.
• It flows from south to north along the coast of Peru and is caused by the northward
deflection of the West Wind Drift.
• It affects the coastal climate of Chile and Peru.
East Australian Current
• The East Australian Current is a warm current which is the southern branch of the South
Equatorial Current, which flows from north to south along the eastern coast of Australia.
• New Zealand is surrounded by this current.
• It raises the temperature along the east Australian and the New Zealand coasts for
considerable distance southwards.
West Wind Drift
• It is a strong, cold current, flowing from between Tasmania and South American coast.
• It flows under the influence of the Westerlies and is largely confined between 40° Sand 50°
S latitudes.
• This current becomes very strong due to large volume of water and high velocity winds
(Roaring Forties).
• One of its branch enters the Atlantic Ocean through Cape Hom, and the other branch turns
northwards and joins the Peru Current.
om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

Figure 8. Major Ocean currents

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


228 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

2.3.8. Currents of the Indian Ocean


The ocean currents of the Indian Ocean are largely controlled and modified by the landmasses
and the Monsoon winds. The ocean currents of the North Indian Ocean flow under the
influence of the north-east and the south-west Monsoon winds. Thus the ocean currents
change the direction of flow twice a year.
The currents in the southern Indian Ocean follow the general pattern of other oceans and are
not affected by the seasonal changes in the direction of Monsoon winds.
Major currents of the Indian Ocean are:
North-east Monsoon Current
• In the winter season, the north-east Monsoon winds blow from land to ocean and from the
northeast to the south-west in the Northern Hemisphere.
• Under the influence of these winds, the ocean current also flows from the north-east to the
southwest.
South-west Monsoon Current
• There is a complete reversat in the direction of Monsoon winds during the summer season
and they blow from the south-west to the north-east in the Northern Hemisphere.
• This also reverses the direction of the ocean current. Now the direction of the ocean
current also changes from the south-west to the northeast.
• Two branches of the main current move in the Arabian Sea and the Bay of Bengal.
South Equatorial Current
• The warm South Equatorial Current flows from east to west between 10° Sand 15° S
latitudes from the western coast of Australia to the coast of Africa.
• After being obstructed by the Madagascar Island, this current is divided into many
branches.
om


l.c

One major branch flows towards the south as the Agulhas Current.
ai
tm

Agulhas Current
ho
t@

• The Agulhas Current is a warm current which is a branch of the South Equatorial Current
sp

which flows along the eastern coast of Madagascar.


h.
es

• It continues southwards up to about 30° S, where it merges with the Mozambique Current.
ur
ay

• Around 35° S latitude, it comes under the influence of the Westerlies and flows towards the
m

east.
Mozambique Current
• The Mozambique Current is a warm current which is the northern branch of the South
Equatorial Current which enters the Mozambique Channel around 10° S latitude.
• Moving southwards between Mozambique and Madagascar, it joins the Agulhas Current
around 30°S latitude.
West Wind Drift
• The West Australian Current is a cold current is in the southern part of the Indian Ocean
and moves from west to east around 40° S latitude.
• The West Wind Drift develops under the influence of the Westerlies (Roaring Forties).

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


229 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

West Australian Current


• The West Australian Current is a cold current which flows along the western coast of
Australia.
• This current turns towards west and north-west near the Tropic of Capricorn and finally
merges with the South Equatorial Current.
• The second branch flows to the south of Australia and finally merges with the West Wind
Drift in the Pacific Ocean.
2.3.9. Effects of Ocean Currents
• The oceanic circulation transports heat from one latitude belt to another in a manner
similar to the heat transported by the general circulation of the atmosphere. The cold
waters of the Arctic and Antarctic circles move towards warmer water in tropical and
equatorial regions, while the warm waters of the lower latitudes move polewards.
• West coasts of the continents in tropical and subtropical latitudes (except close to the
equator) are bordered by cool waters. Their average temperatures are relatively low with
narrow diurnal and annual ranges. There is fog, but generally the areas are arid.
• West coasts of the continents in the middle and higher latitudes are bordered by warm
waters which cause a distinct marine climate. They are characterised by cool summers and
relatively mild winters with a narrow annual range of temperatures.
• Warm currents flow parallel to the east coasts of the continents in tropical and subtropical
latitudes. This results in warm and rainy climates. These areas lie in the western margins of
the subtropical anti-cyclones.
• The mixing of warm and cold currents help to replenish the oxygen and favour the growth
of planktons, the primary food for fish population. The best fishing grounds of the world
exist mainly in these mixing zones.

3. Ocean Resources
om

The ocean is one of Earth's most valuable natural resources. It provides food in the form of fish
l.c
ai

and shellfish. It's used for transportation—both travel and shipping. It provides a treasured
tm

source of recreation for humans. It is mined for minerals and drilled for crude oil. We discuss all
ho
t@

these in greater detail below:


sp

3.1. Fishing
h.
es
ur

The oceans have been fished for thousands of years and are an integral part of human society.
ay
m

Fish have been important to the world economy for all of these years. Fisheries of today
provide about 16% of the total world's protein with higher percentages occurring in developing
nations. Marine fisheries are very important to the economy and well-being of coastal
communities, providing food security, job opportunities, income and livelihoods as well as
traditional cultural identity.
The word fisheries refers to all of the fishing activities in the ocean, whether they are to obtain
fish for the commercial fishing industry, for recreation or to obtain ornamental fish or fish oil.
Fishing activities resulting in fish not used for consumption are called industrial fisheries. Due
to the relative abundance of fish on the continental shelf, fisheries are usually marine and not
freshwater.
3.1.1. Major Fishing Grounds
The major commercial fishing grounds are located in the cool waters of the northern
hemisphere in comparatively high latitudes. Commercial fishing is little developed in the tropics
or in the southern hemisphere. The best fishing grounds are found above continental shelves

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


230 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

which are not more than 200 metres below the water surface, where plankton of all kinds are
most abundant.
The world's most extensive continental shelves are located in high or mid-latitudes in the
northern hemisphere, e.g., the banks of Newfoundland, the North Sea and the continental
shelf off north-western Europe, and the Sea of Japan.
Plankton are in plentiful supply in polar waters, at the meeting of cold and warm ocean currents
as on the Newfoundland 'banks' and the Sea of Japan, or where cold water from the ocean floor
wells up to the surface as it does off the west coast of South America. The continental shelves of
the tropics are relatively less rich in plankton because the water is warm.
The amount of fish available in the oceans is an ever-changing number due to the effects of
both natural causes and human developments. It will be necessary to manage ocean fisheries in
the coming years to make sure the number of fish caught never makes it to zero.

3.2. Climate Buffer


Water has a very high specific heat capacity. This means that a lot of energy is needed to
increase its temperature (energy is needed to overcome the hydrogen bonds). As the Earth is
71% water, energy from the sun causes only small changes in the planet's temperature. This
stops the Earth getting too hot or too cold and makes conditions possible for life. Heat is stored
by the ocean in summer and released back to the atmosphere in winter. Oceans, therefore,
moderate climate by reducing the temperature differences between seasons.
By far the largest carbon store on Earth is in sediments, both on land and in the oceans, and it is
held mainly as calcium carbonate. The second biggest store is the deep ocean where carbon
occurs mostly as dissolved carbonate and hydrogen carbonate ions. About a third of the carbon
dioxide from fossil fuel burning is stored in the oceans and it enters by both physical and
biological processes.

3.3. Phytoplankton
om
l.c
ai

Phytoplankton accounts for around 90% of the world's oxygen production because water covers
tm

about 70% of the Earth and phytoplankton are abundant in the photic zone of the surface
ho
t@

layers. Some of the oxygen produced by phytoplankton is absorbed by the ocean, but most
sp

flows into the atmosphere where it becomes available for oxygen dependent life forms.
h.
es

3.4. Mining
ur
ay
m

The oceans hold a veritable treasure trove of valuable resources. Sand and gravel, oil and gas
have been extracted from the sea for many years. In addition, minerals transported by erosion
from the continents to the coastal areas are mined from the shallow shelf and beach areas.
These include diamonds off the coasts of South Africa and Namibia as well as deposits of tin,
titanium and gold along the shores of Africa, Asia and South America.
Natural gas and oil have been extracted from the seas for decades, but the ores and mineral
deposits on the sea floor have attracted little interest. Yet as resource prices rise, so too does
the appeal of ocean mining.
3.4.1. Deep Sea Mining
Back in the early 1980s there was great commercial interest in marine mining. This initial
euphoria over marine mining led to the International Seabed Authority (ISA) being established
in Jamaica, and the United Nations Convention on the Law of the Sea (UNCLOS) being signed
in 1982 – the “constitution for the seas”. Since entering into force in 1994, this major
convention has formed the basis for signatories’ legal rights to use the marine resources on the

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


231 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

sea floor outside national territorial waters.


After that, however, the industrial countries lost interest in resources. For one thing, prices
dropped making it no longer profitable to retrieve the accretions from the deep sea and utilize
the metals they contained. Also, new onshore deposits were discovered, which were cheaper to
exploit.
The present resurgence of interest is due to:
• The sharp increase in resource prices and attendant rise in profitability of the exploration
business.
• Strong economic growth in countries like China and India which purchase large quantities of
metal on world markets. Even the latest economic crisis is not expected to slow this trend
for long.
• The industrial and emerging countries’ geopolitical interests in safeguarding their supplies
of resources also play a role. In light of the increasing demand for resources, those
countries which have no reserves of their own are seeking to assert extraterritorial claims in
the oceans.
3.4.2. Major Deep Sea Minerals
The major focus is on manganese nodules, which are usually located at depths below
4000 metres, gas hydrates (located between 350 and 5000 metres), and cobalt crusts along the
flanks of undersea mountain ranges (between 1000 and 3000 metres), as well as massive
sulphides and the sulphide muds that form in areas of volcanic activity near the plate
boundaries, at depths of 500 to 4000 metres.
Manganese Nodules
Manganese nodules are lumps of minerals covering huge areas of the deep sea with masses of
up to 75 kilograms per square metre. Manganese nodules are composed primarily of
manganese and iron. The elements of economic interest, including cobalt, copper and nickel, are
om

present in lower concentrations and make up a total of around 3.0 per cent by weight. In
l.c
ai

addition there are traces of other significant elements such as platinum or tellurium that are
tm
ho

important in industry for various high-tech products.


t@
sp

These chemical elements are precipitated from seawater or originate in the pore waters of the
h.

underlying sediments. The greatest densities of nodules occur off the west coast of Mexico, in
es
ur

the Peru Basin, and the Indian Ocean.


ay
m

Cobalt crusts
These crusts accumulate when manganese, iron and a wide array of trace metals dissolved in
the water (cobalt, copper, nickel, and platinum) are deposited on the volcanic substrates. The
cobalt crusts also contain relatively small amounts of the economically important resources.
Extracting cobalt from the ocean is of particular interest because it is found on land in only a
few countries (Congo, Zaire, Russia, Australia and China), some of which are politically unstable.
Cobalt crusts form at depths of 1000 to 3000 metres on the flanks of submarine volcanoes, and
therefore usually occur in regions with high volcanic activity such as the territorial waters
around the island states of the South Pacific.
Massive Sulphides
Sulphur deposits produced from underwater volcanic areas are known as black smokers. These
occurrences of massive sulphides form at submarine plate boundaries, where an exchange of
heat and elements occurs between rocks in the Earth’s crust and the ocean due to the
interaction of volcanic activity with seawater.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


232 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Cold seawater penetrates through cracks in the sea floor down to depths of several kilometres.
Near heat sources such as magma chambers, the seawater is heated to temperatures exceeding
400 degrees Celsius. Upon warming, the water rises rapidly again and is extruded back into the
sea. These hydrothermal solutions transport metals dissolved from the rocks and magma,
which are then deposited on the sea floor and accumulate in layers. This is how the massive
sulphides and the characteristic chimneys (black smokers) are produced.
So far only a few massive sulphide occurrences which are of economic interest due to their size
and composition are known. While the black smokers along the East Pacific Rise and in the
central Atlantic produce sulphides comprising predominantly ironrich sulphur compounds –
which are not worth considering for deep-sea mining – the occurrences in the southwest
Pacific contain greater amounts of copper, zinc and gold. The largest known sulphide occurrence
is located in the Red Sea Here, the sulphides are not associated with black smokers, but appear
in the form of iron rich ore muds.
Figure 9. Distribution of Deep Sea Minerals

om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

3.4.3. Constraints in Deep Sea mining


Major problems associated with deep sea mining are:
• The most limiting factors associated with deep-sea marine mining are the political and legal
aspects. Legal and political issues surrounding exploration, exploitation, and marketing of
sea floor minerals must be resolved.
• The excavation of marine minerals would considerably disturb parts of the seabed. Huge
amounts of sediment, water, and countless organisms would be dug up with the nodules,
and the destruction of the deep-sea habitat would be substantial. It is not yet known how,
or even whether, repopulation of the excavated areas would occur.
• Sea floor mining will only be able to compete with the substantial deposits presently
available on land if there is sufficient demand and metal prices are correspondingly high.
• The excavation technology has yet to be developed. There are serious technological
difficulties in separating the crusts from the substrate which combined with the problems
presented by the uneven sea floor surface further reduce the economic potential of the
marine mining.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


233 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

Despite the challenges, deep sea mining has some potential benefits over terrestrial mining:
• The minerals are often much closer to the surface, so operations have to dig and displace
less rock, meaning a smaller footprint and fewer carbon emissions.
• Seabed mining infrastructure is both moveable and reusable, unlike roads and buildings
often left behind at abandoned mines on land.
• And no residents will be directly displaced by mining.

4. UPSC Questions Related to Above Topics


1. ‘Temperature, salinity and density differences in ocean water are the prime causes of ocean
water circulation.’ Elaborate. (Geography Mains – 2011, 30 marks)
2. Write short notes on ocean deposits. (Geography Mains – 2010, 15 marks)
3. Write short notes on Ocean Currents of the North Atlantic Ocean.(Geography Mains- 2007,
200 words)
4. Present a concise account of bottom relief of the Indian Ocean. (Geography Mains 2003)
5. Give a reasoned account of the distribution of salinity in the oceans and partially enclosed
seas. (Geography Mains 1994)
6. Discuss the features of Gulf Stream. (IFoS-2011)
7. The major fishing grounds of the world are located in areas where cool and warm currents
converge. Discuss. (IFoS-2011)
8. Give an account of oceanic mineral resources. (IFoS-2010)
9. List the processes that initiate ocean currents and influence their speed and direction.
(IFoS-2009)
10. Distinguish between continental crust and continental rise. (IFoS – 2009)
11. What are ocean currents? State the uses of ocean currents. (IFoS – 2005)
om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

Copyright © by Vision IAS


All rights are reserved. No part of this document may be reproduced, stored in a retrieval system or
transmitted in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording or
otherwise, without prior permission of Vision IAS.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


234 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

CORAL REEFS AND INDIAN OCEAN


Contents
1. Coral Reefs.............................................................................................................................. 236

1.1. Corals............................................................................................................................... 236

1.1.1. Types of Corals ......................................................................................................... 236

1.2. Zooxanthellae .................................................................................................................. 236

1.3. Coral Formation and Types ............................................................................................. 236

2. Conditions Needed for Growth of Coral Reefs ....................................................................... 237

2.1. Location of Coral Reefs.................................................................................................... 237

2.2. Importance of Coral Ecosystems ..................................................................................... 238

2.3. Threats to Coral Reefs ..................................................................................................... 238

2.3.1. Climate Change ........................................................................................................ 238

2.3.2. Unsustainable Fishing .............................................................................................. 239

2.3.3. Pollution ................................................................................................................... 239


om

2.4. Coral Reefs in India .......................................................................................................... 239


l.c
ai
tm

3. Indian Ocean .......................................................................................................................... 240


ho
t@

3.1. Significance of Indian Ocean for India............................................................................. 241


sp
h.
es

4. UPSC Questions Related to Above Topics .............................................................................. 242


ur
ay
m

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


235 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

1. Coral Reefs
Coral reefs are some of the most diverse ecosystems in the world. Thousands of species rely on
reefs for survival. Thousands of communities all over the world also depend on coral reefs for
food, protection and jobs.
A reef is a strip or ridge of rocks, sand, or coral that rises to or near the surface of a body of
water. The best-known reefs are the coral reefs developed through biotic processes dominated
by corals and calcareous algae.

1.1. Corals
Corals are animals, even though they may exhibit some of the characteristics of plants and are
often mistaken for rocks. Corals can exist as individual polyps (a small sea animal that has a
body shaped like a tube), or in colonies and communities that contain hundreds to hundreds of
thousands of polyps. Corals are found throughout the oceans, from deep, cold waters to
shallow, tropical waters.
1.1.1. Types of Corals
Corals are classified as under:
1. Hard Corals: Hard corals, also known as stony corals, produce a rigid skeleton made of
calcium carbonate in crystal form called aragonite. Hard corals are the primary reef-
building corals. Hard corals consisting of hundreds to hundreds of thousands of individual
polyps are cemented together by the calcium carbonate 'skeletons' they secrete. Living
coral grow on top of the skeletons of their dead predecessors. Hard corals that form reefs
are called hermatypiccoral.
2. Soft Corals: Soft coral, also known ahermatypic coral, do not produce a rigid calcium
carbonate skeleton and do not form reefs, though they may be present in a reef ecosystem.
Soft corals are also mostly colonial i.e. what appears to be a single large organism is actually
om

a colony of individual polyps combined to form a larger structure. Soft coral colonies tend
l.c

to resemble trees, bushes, fans, whips, and grasses.


ai
tm

1.2. Zooxanthellae
ho
t@
sp

Most reef-building corals contain photosynthetic algae, called zooxanthellae, that live in their
h.

tissues. The corals and algae have a mutualistic relationship. The coral provides the algae with a
es
ur

protected environment and compounds they need for photosynthesis. In return, the algae
ay
m

produce oxygen and help the coral to remove wastes.


Zooxanthellae supply the coral with glucose, glycerol, and amino acids, which are the products
of photosynthesis. The coral uses these products to make proteins, fats, and carbohydrates, and
produce calcium carbonate. This is the driving force behind the growth and productivity of
coral reefs.
In addition to providing corals with essential nutrients, zooxanthellae are responsible for the
unique and beautiful colors of many stony corals. Sometimes when corals become physically
stressed, the polyps expel their algal cells and the colony takes on a stark white appearance.
This is commonly described as coral bleaching. If the polyps go for too long without
zooxanthellae, coral bleaching can result in the coral's death.

1.3. Coral Formation and Types


Coral reefs begin to form when free-swimming coral larvae attach to submerged rocks or other
hard surfaces along the edges of islands or continents. As the corals grow and expand, reefs
take on one of three major characteristic structures:

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


236 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

• Fringing reefs, which are the most common, project seaward directly from the shore,
forming borders along the shoreline and surrounding islands.
• Barrier reefs also border shorelines, but at a greater distance. They are separated from
their adjacent land mass by a lagoon of open, often deep water.
• An atoll forms if a fringing reef forms around a volcanic island that subsides completely
below sea level while the coral continues to grow upward. Atolls are usually circular or oval,
with a central lagoon.

om
l.c

Figure 1. Types of Coral Reefs


ai
tm
ho

2. Conditions Needed for Growth of Coral Reefs


t@
sp

Corals are found throughout the oceans, from deep, cold waters to shallow, tropical waters.
h.
es

Conditions favourable to growth of corals reefs can be discussed as under:


ur
ay

1. Shallow coral reefs grow best in warm water (70–85° F or 21–29° C). It is possible for soft
m

corals to grow in places with warmer or colder water, but growth rates in these types of
conditions are very slow.
2. Reef-building corals prefer clear and shallow water, where lots of sunlight filters through
to their symbiotic algae. The most prolific reefs occupy depths of 18–27 m.
3. Corals also need salt water to survive, so they also grow poorly near river openings with
fresh water runoff.
4. Other factors influencing coral distribution are availability of hard-bottom substrate and the
availability of food such as plankton.

2.1. Location of Coral Reefs


Coral reefs develop in shallow, warm water, usually near land, and mostly in the tropics. There
are coral reefs off the eastern coast of Africa, off the southern coast of India, in the Red Sea, and
off the coasts of northeast and northwest Australia and on to Polynesia. There are also coral
reefs off the coast of Florida, USA, to the Caribbean, and down to Brazil.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


237 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

The Great Barrier Reef (off the coast of NE Australia) is the largest coral reef in the world. It is
over 2000 km long.

Figure 2. Global distribution of Coral Reefs

2.2. Importance of Coral Ecosystems


• Coral reefs are some of the most diverse and valuable ecosystems on Earth. Coral reefs
support more species per unit area than any other marine environment, including about
4,000 species of fish, 800 species of hard corals and hundreds of other species. They are
often referred to as the Rainforests of the Sea.
• Healthy coral reefs have rough surfaces and complex structures that dissipate much of the
force of incoming waves. This buffers shorelines from currents, waves, and storms, helping
to prevent loss of life, property damage, and erosion. Reefs are also a source of sand in
natural beach replenishment.
om

• Being storehouses of immense biological wealth, reefs also provide economic and
l.c
ai

environmental services to millions of people. Healthy reefs contribute to local economies


tm
ho

through tourism. Diving tours, fishing trips, hotels, restaurants, and other businesses based
t@

near reef systems provide millions of jobs and contribute billions of dollars all over the
sp

world. Coral reefs serve as habitat for many commercially important species targeted for
h.
es

fishing.
ur


ay

Coral ecosystems have proven to be beneficial for humans through the identification of
m

potentially beneficial chemical compounds and through the development of medicines,


both derived from organisms found in coral ecosystems. Many drugs are now being
developed from coral reef animals and plants as possible cures for cancer, arthritis, human
bacterial infections, viruses, and other diseases.

2.3. Threats to Coral Reefs


An estimated 20 per cent of the world’s reefs are damaged beyond recovery and about half of
the remaining coral reefs are under risk of collapse. The top threats to coral reefs are:
2.3.1. Climate Change
Climate change impacts have been identified as one of the greatest global threats to coral reef
ecosystems. As temperature rise, mass bleaching, and infectious disease outbreaks are likely to
become more frequent. Additionally, carbon dioxide absorbed into the ocean from the
atmosphere has already begun to reduce calcification rates in reef-building and reef-associated
organisms by altering sea water chemistry through decreases in pH (ocean acidification).

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


238 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

In the long term, failure to address carbon emissions and the resultant impacts of rising
temperatures and ocean acidification could make many other coral ecosystem management
efforts futile.
2.3.2. Unsustainable Fishing
Coral reefs and associated habitats provide important commercial, recreational and subsistence
fishery resources. But coral reef fisheries, though often relatively small in scale, may have
disproportionately large impacts on the ecosystem if conducted unsustainably. Rapid human
population growth, demand for fishery resources, use of more efficient fishery technologies, and
inadequate management and enforcement have led to the depletion of key reef species and
habitat damage in many locations.
2.3.3. Pollution
Impacts from land-based sources of pollution (e.g. agriculture, deforestation, storm water,
coastal development, road construction, and oil and chemical spills) on coral reef ecosystems
include increased sedimentation, nutrients, toxins, and pathogen introduction. These pollutants
and related synergistic effects can cause disease and mortality in sensitive species, disrupt
critical ecological functions, cause trophic structure and dynamics changes (i.e. eutrophic
conditions), and impede growth, reproduction, and larval settlement.
These threats—combined with other threats like coral disease; tropical storms; tourism and
recreation; vessel damage; marine debris, and aquatic invasive species—compound upon each
other, making conservation efforts more difficult.

2.4. Coral Reefs in India


The coral reef ecosystems are found in four regions of India which are:
Region Type of Reef
Andaman & Nicobar Islands Fringing Reefs
om

Gulf of Mannar (Tamil Nadu) Fringing Reefs


l.c
ai

Gulf of Kutchh (Gujarat) Fringing Reefs


tm

Lakshadweep Islands Atolls


ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

Figure 3. Coral Reefs of India

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


239 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

There are no coral reefs on the central east and west coasts of India. The conditions here,
especially salinity and high sediment load, are not ideal for coral growth. Most major rivers of
India, like the Ganges, flow into the sea on the east coast, bringing in lots of sediments that
would not allow the corals to grow. On the west coast, the monsoon is intense from June to
August. The fresh water flow into the sea at this time reduces salinity to less than half of the
normal and the sea water becomes murky brownish with the sediments.
The Indian coral reefs are world famous but least explored, studied and utilised. On the other
hand, they are indiscriminately damaged by human exploitation mainly for the cement industry
(calcium carbide), road and building material in certain areas like the Gulf of Mannar and the
Gulf of Kutch. The other two regions, the Andaman and Nicobar Islands and the Lakshadweep,
because of their far-flung location from the mainland, are comparatively less affected by human
depredations.

3. Indian Ocean
The Indian Ocean is the third largest of the world's oceanic divisions, covering approximately
20% of the water on the Earth's surface. It is bounded by Asia—including India, after which the
ocean is named on the north, on the west by Africa, on the east by Australia, and on the south
by the Southern Ocean.
As one component of the World Ocean, the Indian Ocean is delineated from the Atlantic Ocean
by the 20° east meridian running south from Cape Agulhas (South Africa), and from the Pacific
Ocean by the meridian of 146°55' east. The northernmost extent of the Indian Ocean is
approximately 30° north in the Persian Gulf. The ocean is nearly 10000 km wide at the
southern tips of Africa and Australia, and its area is 73556000 km² including the Red Sea and
the Persian Gulf.
Island nations within the ocean are Madagascar, Comoros, Seychelles, Maldives, Mauritius, and
Sri Lanka. The archipelago of Indonesia borders the ocean on the east.
om
l.c
ai
tm
ho
t@
sp
h.
es
ur
ay
m

Figure 4. Geography of Indian Ocean

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


240 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

3.1. Significance of Indian Ocean for India


Significance of Indian Ocean for India can be discussed under following heads:
1. Geopolitical Significance: The Indian Ocean Region (IOR), comprising the ocean and its
littorals, is India’s regional or immediate geo-strategic environment. It exists on the fringes
of our boundaries and has a significant impact on the internal state of affairs.Indian Ocean
defines the Indian Navy’s primary Area of Maritime Interest, where it seek to address the
challenges having a bearing on national security and the nation’s overall socio-economic
development.
With substantial economic activity, including 90% trade by volume and bulk of our energy
imports, happening over the sea, maritime security is central to overall development of our
nation. Concurrently, India cannot hope to develop and grow peacefully with an unstable
and turbulent neighbourhood. Prevalence of peace in the Indian Ocean Region is therefore
a key national security imperative.
Riding on the benefits of globalisation, littorals of the IOR are now re-emerging to achieve
their original potential. The emergence of many regional countries, as economic
powerhouses, reflects this reality. Consequently, several regional economic groupings such
as ASEAN, BIMSTEC, SAARC, IOR-ARC, GCC and few others have evolved over time in the
IOR to harness the advantages of economic integration.
India’s geo-strategic location positions us right at the confluence of major arteries of world
trade. The Indian Navy is therefore viewed by some of the littorals as a suitable agency to
facilitate regional maritime security in the IOR as a net security provider. India’s standing as
a benign power provides credence to this perception, making us a preferred partner for
regional security.
Economic security is central to the comprehensive approach to security. In this globalised
world, the Indian economy is integrated with, and consequently interdependent on other
world economies. The prospect of disruption of trade at critical chokepoints, such as the
Strait of Hormuz or Malacca, can be catastrophic for the global economy. The downstream
om
l.c

effects of such economic upheaval are certainly disastrous for regional peace. Maintaining
ai

unimpeded flow of energy and other commodities over the sea is therefore a prime
tm
ho

concern for all nations, including ours.


t@

Maritime terrorism is another grave challenge. The events of 26/11 brought to fore the
sp
h.

porosity of our long coastline and its resultant vulnerability to terror attacks perpetrated
es

from the sea. Moreover, the prospect of terror attacks on off-shore infrastructure and sea-
ur
ay

borne traffic, close to the coast, puts a premium on ensuring coastal security. Consequent
m

to government directives, the Navy is now responsible for overall maritime security of the
country, including the coast.
The region’s natural bounties and maritime trade carried over its sea lanes drive the global
economy. The fact that two-thirds of the world’s oil shipments, one-third of its bulk cargo
and half of the container traffic transit over its sea lanes, and through its choke points, a
large part of which is meant for countries outside the region, underscores the Indian
Ocean’s importance for the world at large.
In conclusion, maintenance of a peaceful maritime environment is an imperative, for our
nation and the region, to sustain our growth trajectories and to achieve our national
aspirations. The oceans are vast, challenges too many, and resources limited, for any
individual state to assure security of the global commons. This, therefore, calls for a
cooperative approach. By virtue of India’s geo-strategic location in the Indian Ocean and
her maritime capabilities, the Indian Navy is deemed by many to be the net security
provider in the IOR.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


241 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834


Student Notes:

2. Economic Significance: Economic importance of the Indian Ocean is immense. It can be


discussed on the following points:
a. About 30% of world trade is handled in the ports of the Indian Ocean.
b. Half of the world’s container traffic passes through Indian Ocean.
c. Continental shelves cover about 4.2% of the total area of the Indian Ocean and are
reported to be very Rich in minerals including Tin, Gold, Uranium, Cobalt, Nickel,
Aluminium and Cadmium although these resources have been largely not exploited, so
far.
d. 40 out of 54 types of raw materials used by U.S. industry are supplied by the Indian
Ocean.
e. Several of the world’s top container ports, including Port Kelang and Singapore, are
located in Indian Ocean as well as some of the world’s fastest growing and busiest
ports.
f. Indian Ocean possesses some of the world’s largest fishing grounds, providing
approximately 15%of the total world’s fish catch (approximately 9 million tons per
annum).
g. 55% of known world oil reserves are present in Indian Ocean.
h. 40% of the world’s natural gas reserves are in Indian Ocean littoral states.

4. UPSC Questions Related to Above Topics


1. What is the importance of Indian Ocean for India? (UPSC 1999/15 Marks)
2. Mention the advantages which India enjoys being at the end of the Indian Ocean.
(UPSC 1996/15 Marks)
3. Describe the ideal conditions for coral reef formation. (Geography Mains 2008)
4. Write short note on formation of coral reefs. (Geography Mains 2001/200 words)
5. Write short note on coral reefs. (Geography Mains 1988/200 words)
6. Examine economic significance of the resources of the Continental Shelf of the Indian
Ocean. (Geography Mains 2009/30 marks)
om

7. Assess the geographical significance of Indian Ocean. (Geography Mains 2008/200 words)
l.c
ai

8. Analyse the role of India in the geo-politics of the Indian Ocean Region. (Geography Mains
tm
ho

2003,2000/200 words)
t@

9. Discuss the geopolitical importance of Indian Ocean area. (Geography Mains 1999/200
sp

words)
h.
es
ur
ay
m

Copyright © by Vision IAS


All rights are reserved. No part of this document may be reproduced, stored in a retrieval system or
transmitted in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording or
otherwise, without prior permission of Vision IAS.

DELHI JAIPUR PUNE HYDERABAD AHMEDABAD LUCKNOW


242 www.visionias.in # 8468022022 ©Vision IAS

DEEPAK PHOTOSTAT 9310521834

You might also like